1 \input texinfo @c -*- coding: utf-8 -*-
3 @setfilename ../../info/org.info
4 @settitle The Org Manual
7 @include org-version.inc
9 @c Version and Contact Info
10 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers web page}
11 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
12 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
13 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
14 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
19 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
21 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
22 @c =======================================
24 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
25 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
29 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
31 @c orgkey{key} A key item
32 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
33 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
34 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
35 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
36 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
37 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
38 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
39 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
40 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
41 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
43 @c a key but no command
55 @c one key with a command
56 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
57 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
62 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
65 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
74 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
75 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
76 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
81 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
84 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
93 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
94 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
95 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
99 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
102 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
110 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
111 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
112 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
117 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
120 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
129 @c two keys with one command
130 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
131 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
137 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
140 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
146 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
150 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
152 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
153 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
154 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
161 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
165 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
176 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
177 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
178 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
184 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
187 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
193 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
197 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
198 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
199 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
205 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
208 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
214 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
218 @c two keys with two commands
219 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
220 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
221 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
228 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
229 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
232 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
233 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
243 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
246 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
249 @c Subheadings inside a table.
250 @macro tsubheading{text}
252 @subsubheading \text\
260 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
262 Copyright @copyright{} 2004--2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
265 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
266 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
267 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
268 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
269 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
270 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
272 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
273 modify this GNU manual.''
277 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
279 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
283 @title The Org Manual
285 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
286 @author by Carsten Dominik
287 with contributions by Bastien Guerry, Nicolas Goaziou, Eric Schulte,
288 Jambunathan K, Dan Davison, Thomas Dye, David O'Toole, and Philip Rooke.
290 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
292 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
296 @c Output the short table of contents at the beginning.
299 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
304 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
311 * Introduction:: Getting started
312 * Document structure:: A tree works like your brain
313 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
314 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
315 * TODO items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
316 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
317 * Properties and columns:: Storing information about an entry
318 * Dates and times:: Making items useful for planning
319 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
320 * Agenda views:: Collecting information into views
321 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
322 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing notes
323 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
324 * Working with source code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
325 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
326 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
327 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
328 * History and acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
329 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
330 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
331 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
332 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
333 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
336 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
340 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
341 * Installation:: Installing Org
342 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
343 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
344 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
348 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
349 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
350 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
351 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
352 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
353 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
354 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
355 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
356 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
357 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
358 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
359 * Org syntax:: Formal description of Org's syntax
363 * Global and local cycling:: Cycling through various visibility states
364 * Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state
365 * Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts
369 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
370 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
371 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
372 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
373 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
374 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
378 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
379 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
380 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
381 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
382 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
383 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
384 * Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables
385 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
386 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
387 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
391 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
392 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
393 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
394 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
395 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
396 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
397 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
398 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
402 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
406 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
407 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
408 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
409 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
410 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
411 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
413 Extended use of TODO keywords
415 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
416 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
417 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
418 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
419 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
420 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
421 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
425 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
426 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
427 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
431 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
432 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
433 * Tag hierarchy:: Create a hierarchy of tags
434 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
436 Properties and columns
438 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
439 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
440 * Property searches:: Matching property values
441 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
442 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
443 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
447 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
448 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
449 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
453 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
454 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
458 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
459 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
460 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
461 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
462 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
463 * Timers:: Notes with a running timer
467 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
468 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
470 Deadlines and scheduling
472 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
473 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
477 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
478 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
479 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
481 Capture - Refile - Archive
483 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
484 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
485 * RSS feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
486 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
487 * Refile and copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another
488 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
492 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
493 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
494 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
498 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
499 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
500 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
504 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
505 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
509 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
510 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
511 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
512 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
513 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
514 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
515 * Exporting agenda views:: Writing a view to a file
516 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
518 The built-in agenda views
520 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
521 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
522 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
523 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
524 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
526 Presentation and sorting
528 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
529 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
530 * Sorting agenda items:: The order of things
531 * Filtering/limiting agenda items:: Dynamically narrow the agenda
535 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
536 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
537 * Setting options:: Changing the rules
539 Markup for rich export
541 * Paragraphs:: The basic unit of text
542 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
543 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
544 * Images and tables:: Images, tables and caption mechanism
545 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
546 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
547 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
548 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
552 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
553 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
554 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
558 * The export dispatcher:: The main interface
559 * Export settings:: Common export settings
560 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
561 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
562 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create templates
563 * Comment lines:: What will not be exported
564 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
565 * Beamer export:: Exporting as a Beamer presentation
566 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
567 * @LaTeX{} export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
568 * Markdown export:: Exporting to Markdown
569 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
570 * Org export:: Exporting to Org
571 * Texinfo export:: Exporting to Texinfo
572 * iCalendar export:: Exporting to iCalendar
573 * Other built-in back-ends:: Exporting to a man page
574 * Advanced configuration:: Fine-tuning the export output
575 * Export in foreign buffers:: Author tables and lists in Org syntax
579 * Beamer export commands:: For creating Beamer documents.
580 * Beamer specific export settings:: For customizing Beamer export.
581 * Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer:: For composing Beamer slides.
582 * Beamer specific syntax:: For using in Org documents.
583 * Editing support:: For using helper functions.
584 * A Beamer example:: A complete presentation.
588 * HTML Export commands:: Invoking HTML export
589 * HTML Specific export settings:: Settings for HTML export
590 * HTML doctypes:: Exporting various (X)HTML flavors
591 * HTML preamble and postamble:: Inserting preamble and postamble
592 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org files
593 * Links in HTML export:: Interpreting and formatting links
594 * Tables in HTML export:: Formatting and modifying tables
595 * Images in HTML export:: Inserting figures with HTML output
596 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Handling math equations
597 * Text areas in HTML export:: Showing an alternate approach, an example
598 * CSS support:: Styling HTML output
599 * JavaScript support:: Folding scripting in the web browser
603 * @LaTeX{} export commands:: For producing @LaTeX{} and PDF documents.
604 * @LaTeX{} specific export settings:: Unique to this @LaTeX{} back-end.
605 * @LaTeX{} header and sectioning:: For file structure.
606 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Directly in the Org document.
607 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to tables.
608 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to images.
609 * Plain lists in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to lists.
610 * Source blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to source code blocks.
611 * Example blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to example blocks.
612 * Special blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to special blocks.
613 * Horizontal rules in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to horizontal rules.
615 OpenDocument Text export
617 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: Required packages.
618 * ODT export commands:: Invoking export.
619 * ODT specific export settings:: Configuration options.
620 * Extending ODT export:: Producing @file{.doc}, @file{.pdf} files.
621 * Applying custom styles:: Styling the output.
622 * Links in ODT export:: Handling and formatting links.
623 * Tables in ODT export:: Org table conversions.
624 * Images in ODT export:: Inserting images.
625 * Math formatting in ODT export:: Formatting @LaTeX{} fragments.
626 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: Rendering objects.
627 * Literal examples in ODT export:: For source code and example blocks.
628 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: For power users.
630 Math formatting in ODT export
632 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: Embedding in @LaTeX{} format.
633 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: Embedding in native format.
635 Advanced topics in ODT export
637 * Configuring a document converter:: Registering a document converter.
638 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Exploring internals.
639 * Creating one-off styles:: Customizing styles, highlighting.
640 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: Defining table templates.
641 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: Debugging corrupted OpenDocument files.
645 * Texinfo export commands:: Invoking commands.
646 * Texinfo specific export settings:: Setting the environment.
647 * Texinfo file header:: Generating the header.
648 * Texinfo title and copyright page:: Creating preamble pages.
649 * Info directory file:: Installing a manual in Info file hierarchy.
650 * Headings and sectioning structure:: Building document structure.
651 * Indices:: Creating indices.
652 * Quoting Texinfo code:: Incorporating literal Texinfo code.
653 * Plain lists in Texinfo export:: List attributes.
654 * Tables in Texinfo export:: Table attributes.
655 * Images in Texinfo export:: Image attributes.
656 * Special blocks in Texinfo export:: Special block attributes.
657 * A Texinfo example:: Processing Org to Texinfo.
661 * Configuration:: Defining projects
662 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
663 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
664 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
668 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
669 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
670 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
671 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
672 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
673 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
674 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
675 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
679 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
680 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
682 Working with source code
684 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
685 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
686 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
687 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
688 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
689 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
690 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
691 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
692 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
693 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
694 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
695 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
699 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
700 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
702 Using header arguments
704 * System-wide header arguments:: Set globally, language-specific
705 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set in the Org file's headers
706 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set in the Org file
707 * Language-specific mode properties::
708 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most commonly used method
709 * Arguments in function calls:: The most specific level, takes highest priority
711 Specific header arguments
713 * var:: Pass arguments to @samp{src} code blocks
714 * results:: Specify results type; how to collect
715 * file:: Specify a path for output file
716 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
717 * file-ext:: Specify an extension for file output
718 * output-dir:: Specify a directory for output file
719 * dir:: Specify the default directory for code block execution
720 * exports:: Specify exporting code, results, both, none
721 * tangle:: Toggle tangling; or specify file name
722 * mkdirp:: Toggle for parent directory creation for target files during tangling
723 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled code files
724 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled code files
725 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb expansion during tangling
726 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
727 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
728 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
729 * noweb-sep:: String to separate noweb references
730 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
731 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
732 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
733 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
734 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
735 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
736 * tangle-mode:: Set permission of tangled files
737 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
738 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
739 * post:: Post processing of results of code block evaluation
740 * prologue:: Text to prepend to body of code block
741 * epilogue:: Text to append to body of code block
745 * Completion:: M-TAB guesses completions
746 * Easy templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
747 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
748 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
749 * Customization:: Adapting Org to changing tastes
750 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
751 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
752 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
753 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
754 * Interaction:: With other Emacs packages
755 * org-crypt:: Encrypting Org files
757 Interaction with other packages
759 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
760 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
764 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
765 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
766 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
767 * Adding export back-ends:: How to write new export back-ends
768 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
769 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
770 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
771 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
772 * Speeding up your agendas:: Tips on how to speed up your agendas
773 * Extracting agenda information:: Post-processing of agenda information
774 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
775 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
777 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
779 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
780 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
781 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
782 * Radio lists:: Sending and receiving lists
786 * Setting up the staging area:: For the mobile device
787 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
788 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
794 @chapter Introduction
798 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
799 * Installation:: Installing Org
800 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
801 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
802 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
809 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and project planning
810 with a fast and effective plain-text system. It also is an authoring system
811 with unique support for literate programming and reproducible research.
813 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep
814 the content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and structure
815 editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created with a
816 built-in table editor. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites,
817 emails, Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
819 Org develops organizational tasks around notes files that contain lists or
820 information about projects as plain text. Project planning and task
821 management makes use of metadata which is part of an outline node. Based on
822 this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and create dynamic
823 @i{agenda views} that also integrate the Emacs calendar and diary. Org can
824 be used to implement many different project planning schemes, such as David
827 Org files can serve as a single source authoring system with export to many
828 different formats such as HTML, @LaTeX{}, Open Document, and Markdown. New
829 export backends can be derived from existing ones, or defined from scratch.
831 Org files can include source code blocks, which makes Org uniquely suited for
832 authoring technical documents with code examples. Org source code blocks are
833 fully functional; they can be evaluated in place and their results can be
834 captured in the file. This makes it possible to create a single file
835 reproducible research compendium.
837 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should feel like a
838 straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not imposed, but a
839 large amount of functionality is available when needed. Org is a toolbox.
840 Many users actually run only a (very personal) fraction of Org's capabilities, and
841 know that there is more whenever they need it.
843 All of this is achieved with strictly plain text files, the most portable and
844 future-proof file format. Org runs in Emacs. Emacs is one of the most
845 widely ported programs, so that Org mode is available on every major
849 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
850 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
851 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
852 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
853 @cindex print edition
855 An earlier version (7.3) of this manual is available as a
856 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from
862 @section Installation
865 Org is part of recent distributions of GNU Emacs, so you normally don't need
866 to install it. If, for one reason or another, you want to install Org on top
867 of this pre-packaged version, there are three ways to do it:
870 @item By using Emacs package system.
871 @item By downloading Org as an archive.
872 @item By using Org's git repository.
875 We @b{strongly recommend} to stick to a single installation method.
877 @subsubheading Using Emacs packaging system
879 Recent Emacs distributions include a packaging system which lets you install
880 Elisp libraries. You can install Org with @kbd{M-x package-install RET org}.
882 @noindent @b{Important}: you need to do this in a session where no @code{.org} file has
883 been visited, i.e., where no Org built-in function have been loaded.
884 Otherwise autoload Org functions will mess up the installation.
886 Then, to make sure your Org configuration is taken into account, initialize
887 the package system with @code{(package-initialize)} in your Emacs init file
888 before setting any Org option. If you want to use Org's package repository,
889 check out the @uref{http://orgmode.org/elpa.html, Org ELPA page}.
891 @subsubheading Downloading Org as an archive
893 You can download Org latest release from @uref{http://orgmode.org/, Org's
894 website}. In this case, make sure you set the load-path correctly in your
898 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
901 The downloaded archive contains contributed libraries that are not included
902 in Emacs. If you want to use them, add the @file{contrib} directory to your
906 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
909 Optionally, you can compile the files and/or install them in your system.
910 Run @code{make help} to list compilation and installation options.
912 @subsubheading Using Org's git repository
914 You can clone Org's repository and install Org like this:
918 $ git clone git://orgmode.org/org-mode.git
922 Note that in this case, @code{make autoloads} is mandatory: it defines Org's
923 version in @file{org-version.el} and Org's autoloads in
924 @file{org-loaddefs.el}.
926 Remember to add the correct load-path as described in the method above.
928 You can also compile with @code{make}, generate the documentation with
929 @code{make doc}, create a local configuration with @code{make config} and
930 install Org with @code{make install}. Please run @code{make help} to get
931 the list of compilation/installation options.
933 For more detailed explanations on Org's build system, please check the Org
934 Build System page on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html,
942 @cindex global key bindings
943 @cindex key bindings, global
946 @findex org-store-link
949 Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on: this is the default in
950 Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer
951 with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
953 There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
954 packages, please take the time to check the list (@pxref{Conflicts}).
956 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
957 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
958 global keys (i.e., anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
959 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
962 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
963 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
964 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
965 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
968 @cindex Org mode, turning on
969 Files with the @file{.org} extension use Org mode by default. To turn on Org
970 mode in a file that does not have the extension @file{.org}, make the first
971 line of a file look like this:
974 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
977 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
978 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
979 the file's name is. See also the variable
980 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
982 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
983 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode} turned on, which is
984 the default. If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create
985 an active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
986 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
995 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
996 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
997 You can subscribe to the list
998 @uref{https://lists.gnu.org/mailman/listinfo/emacs-orgmode, on this web page}.
999 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
1000 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
1001 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
1002 moderators have to do.}.
1004 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1005 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1006 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1007 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1008 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1009 (@kbd{M-x org-version RET}), as well as the Org related setup in the Emacs
1010 init file. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1012 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report RET}
1014 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1015 that you only need to add your description. If you are not sending the Email
1016 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1018 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1019 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1020 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1021 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1022 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1025 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1028 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1029 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as
1030 @code{emacs -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as
1034 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest 'org-mode'
1036 ;; activate debugging
1037 (setq debug-on-error t
1041 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1042 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1043 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
1046 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1047 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1051 @item What exactly did you do?
1052 @item What did you expect to happen?
1053 @item What happened instead?
1055 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1057 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1059 @cindex backtrace of an error
1060 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1061 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1062 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1063 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1064 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1068 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1069 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1072 @kbd{C-u M-x org-reload RET}
1075 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1078 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}.
1080 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1081 document the steps you take.
1083 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1084 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1085 attach it to your bug report.
1089 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1091 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1093 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1094 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1099 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1103 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1104 meaning are written with all capitals.
1107 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1108 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1111 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1112 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_EXPORT html} to start
1113 a @code{HTML} environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to
1114 enhance its readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org file.
1116 @subsubheading Key bindings and commands
1122 The manual suggests a few global key bindings, in particular @kbd{C-c a} for
1123 @code{org-agenda} and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only
1124 suggestions, but the rest of the manual assumes that these key bindings are in
1125 place in order to list commands by key access.
1127 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1128 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1129 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1130 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1131 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1132 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1133 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1134 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1135 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1136 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1138 @node Document structure
1139 @chapter Document structure
1140 @cindex document structure
1141 @cindex structure of document
1143 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1144 edit the structure of the document.
1147 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1148 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1149 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1150 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1151 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1152 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1153 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1154 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1155 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1156 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1157 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1158 * Org syntax:: Formal description of Org's syntax
1164 @cindex Outline mode
1166 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1167 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1168 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1169 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1170 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1171 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1172 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1173 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1178 @cindex outline tree
1179 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1180 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1181 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1183 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1184 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1185 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1186 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1187 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1188 headings indented less than 30 stars.}. For example:
1191 * Top level headline
1198 * Another top level headline
1201 @vindex org-footnote-section
1202 @noindent Note that a headline named after @code{org-footnote-section},
1203 which defaults to @samp{Footnotes}, is considered as special. A subtree with
1204 this headline will be silently ignored by exporting functions.
1206 Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1207 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1208 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1210 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1211 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1212 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1213 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1214 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1215 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1217 @node Visibility cycling
1218 @section Visibility cycling
1219 @cindex cycling, visibility
1220 @cindex visibility cycling
1221 @cindex trees, visibility
1222 @cindex show hidden text
1226 * Global and local cycling:: Cycling through various visibility states
1227 * Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state
1228 * Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts
1231 @node Global and local cycling
1232 @subsection Global and local cycling
1234 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1235 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1236 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1238 @cindex subtree visibility states
1239 @cindex subtree cycling
1240 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1241 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1242 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1244 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1245 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1248 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1249 '-----------------------------------'
1252 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1253 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1254 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1255 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1256 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1257 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1258 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1259 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1261 @cindex global visibility states
1262 @cindex global cycling
1263 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1264 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1265 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1266 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1267 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1268 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1271 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1272 '--------------------------------------'
1275 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1276 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1277 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1279 @cindex set startup visibility, command
1280 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1281 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer (@pxref{Initial visibility}).
1282 @cindex show all, command
1283 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},outline-show-all}
1284 Show all, including drawers.
1285 @cindex revealing context
1286 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1287 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1288 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1289 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1290 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1291 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1292 entire subtree of the parent.
1293 @cindex show branches, command
1294 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,outline-show-branches}
1295 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1296 @cindex show children, command
1297 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},outline-show-children}
1298 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1299 expose all children down to level N@.
1300 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1301 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect buffer
1302 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual}) will contain the entire
1303 buffer, but will be narrowed to the current tree. Editing the indirect
1304 buffer will also change the original buffer, but without affecting visibility
1305 in that buffer.}. With a numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and
1306 then take that tree. If N is negative then go up that many levels. With a
1307 @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the previously used indirect buffer.
1308 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1309 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1312 @node Initial visibility
1313 @subsection Initial visibility
1315 @cindex visibility, initialize
1316 @vindex org-startup-folded
1317 @vindex org-agenda-inhibit-startup
1318 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1319 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1320 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1321 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1323 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to OVERVIEW,
1324 i.e., only the top level headlines are visible@footnote{When
1325 @code{org-agenda-inhibit-startup} is non-@code{nil}, Org will not honor the default
1326 visibility state when first opening a file for the agenda (@pxref{Speeding up
1327 your agendas}).}. This can be configured through the variable
1328 @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a per-file basis by adding one of the
1329 following lines anywhere in the buffer:
1335 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1338 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1340 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1341 and columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1342 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1346 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1347 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is
1348 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1352 @node Catching invisible edits
1353 @subsection Catching invisible edits
1355 @vindex org-catch-invisible-edits
1356 @cindex edits, catching invisible
1357 Sometimes you may inadvertently edit an invisible part of the buffer and be
1358 confused on what has been edited and how to undo the mistake. Setting
1359 @code{org-catch-invisible-edits} to non-@code{nil} will help prevent this. See the
1360 docstring of this option on how Org should catch invisible edits and process
1365 @cindex motion, between headlines
1366 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1367 @cindex headline navigation
1368 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1371 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,org-next-visible-heading}
1373 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,org-previous-visible-heading}
1375 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1376 Next heading same level.
1377 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1378 Previous heading same level.
1379 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1380 Backward to higher level heading.
1381 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1382 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1383 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1384 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1385 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1387 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1388 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1389 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1390 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1391 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1392 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1393 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1395 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1398 @vindex org-goto-interface
1400 See also the option @code{org-goto-interface}.
1403 @node Structure editing
1404 @section Structure editing
1405 @cindex structure editing
1406 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1407 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1408 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1409 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1410 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1411 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1412 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1413 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1414 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1417 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-meta-return}
1418 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1419 Insert a new heading, item or row.
1421 If the command is used at the @emph{beginning} of a line, and if there is
1422 a heading or a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}) at point, the new
1423 heading/item is created @emph{before} the current line. When used at the
1424 beginning of a regular line of text, turn that line into a heading.
1426 When this command is used in the middle of a line, the line is split and the
1427 rest of the line becomes the new item or headline. If you do not want the
1428 line to be split, customize @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.
1430 Calling the command with a @kbd{C-u} prefix unconditionally inserts a new
1431 heading at the end of the current subtree, thus preserving its contents.
1432 With a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, the new heading is created at the end of
1433 the parent subtree instead.
1434 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1435 Insert a new heading at the end of the current subtree.
1436 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1437 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1438 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1439 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1440 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1441 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1442 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1444 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1445 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1446 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1447 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1448 to the initial level.
1449 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1450 Promote current heading by one level.
1451 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1452 Demote current heading by one level.
1453 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1454 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1455 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1456 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1457 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1458 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1460 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1461 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1462 @orgcmd{M-h,org-mark-element}
1463 Mark the element at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent elements
1464 of the one just marked. E.g., hitting @key{M-h} on a paragraph will mark it,
1465 hitting @key{M-h} immediately again will mark the next one.
1466 @orgcmd{C-c @@,org-mark-subtree}
1467 Mark the subtree at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent subtrees
1468 of the same level than the marked subtree.
1469 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1470 Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1471 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1472 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1473 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1474 sequential subtrees.
1475 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1476 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1477 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1478 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1479 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1480 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1481 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1482 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1483 Depending on the options @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1484 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1485 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1486 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1487 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1488 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1489 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1490 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1491 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1493 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1494 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1495 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1496 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1497 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1498 more details, see the docstring of the command
1499 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1500 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1501 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refile and copy}.
1502 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1503 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1504 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1505 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1506 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1507 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1508 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1509 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1510 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1511 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1512 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1513 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1514 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1515 Narrow buffer to current block.
1516 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1517 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1518 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1519 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1520 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1521 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1522 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1523 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1524 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1527 @cindex region, active
1528 @cindex active region
1529 @cindex transient mark mode
1530 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1531 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1532 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1533 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1534 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1535 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1540 @section Sparse trees
1541 @cindex sparse trees
1542 @cindex trees, sparse
1543 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1544 @cindex occur, command
1546 @vindex org-show-context-detail
1547 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1548 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1549 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1550 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1551 variable @code{org-show-context-detail} to decide how much context is shown
1552 around each match.}. Just try it out and you will see immediately how it
1555 Org mode contains several commands for creating such trees, all these
1556 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1559 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1560 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1561 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / r,C-c / /,org-occur}
1562 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1563 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1564 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1565 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1566 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1567 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1568 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1569 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1570 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1571 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1572 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1573 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1574 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1575 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1576 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1580 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1581 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1582 use the option @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1583 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1584 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1588 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1589 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1592 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1593 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1595 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1596 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1599 @cindex printing sparse trees
1600 @cindex visible text, printing
1601 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1602 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts of the
1603 document. Or you can use @kbd{C-c C-e C-v} to export only the visible part
1604 of the document and print the resulting file.
1607 @section Plain lists
1609 @cindex lists, plain
1610 @cindex lists, ordered
1611 @cindex ordered lists
1613 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1614 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1615 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1616 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1618 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1621 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1622 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1623 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1624 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1625 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1626 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1629 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1630 @vindex org-list-allow-alphabetical
1631 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1632 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1633 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1634 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1635 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-list-allow-alphabetical}. To minimize
1636 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1637 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1638 list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the text of the item
1639 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1640 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1641 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1642 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1644 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1645 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1649 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1650 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1651 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1652 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1653 than its bullet/number.
1655 @vindex org-list-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1656 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1657 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1658 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-list-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}.
1659 In that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1663 ** Lord of the Rings
1664 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1665 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1666 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1667 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1668 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1669 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1671 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1672 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1673 Important actors in this film are:
1674 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1675 - @b{Sean Astin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1676 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1680 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1681 them correctly, and by exporting them properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since
1682 indentation is what governs the structure of these lists, many structural
1683 constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...} blocks can be indented to signal that they
1684 belong to a particular item.
1686 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1687 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1688 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1689 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1690 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1691 indentation between items and their sub-items, customize
1692 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1694 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1695 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1696 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1697 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1698 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1699 to disable them individually.
1702 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1703 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1704 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1705 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1706 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1707 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1708 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1709 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1710 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1711 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1712 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1713 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1714 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1715 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1716 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1717 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1718 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1719 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1720 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1721 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1722 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1723 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1728 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1730 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1731 @kindex S-@key{down}
1734 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1735 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1736 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1737 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1738 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1739 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1740 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1741 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1744 @kindex M-@key{down}
1747 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1748 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1749 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1751 @kindex M-@key{left}
1752 @kindex M-@key{right}
1755 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1756 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1757 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1758 @item M-S-@key{left}
1759 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1760 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1761 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1762 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1763 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1764 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1767 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1768 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1769 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1770 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1773 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1774 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1775 consistency in the whole list.
1777 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1779 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1780 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1781 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1782 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1783 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, all selected
1784 lines are converted to list items. With a prefix argument, selected text is
1785 changed into a single item. If the first line already was a list item, any
1786 item marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1787 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1790 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1791 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1794 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1795 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1797 @kindex S-@key{left}
1798 @kindex S-@key{right}
1800 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1801 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1802 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1803 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1805 @cindex sorting, of plain list
1807 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1808 numerically, alphabetically, by time, by checked status for check lists,
1809 or by a custom function.
1815 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1817 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1819 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1820 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}. They
1821 can contain anything but a headline and another drawer. Drawers look like
1825 ** This is a headline
1826 Still outside the drawer
1828 This is inside the drawer.
1833 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1834 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1835 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1836 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add
1837 a property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1838 keywords is also possible using @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}@footnote{Many desktops
1839 intercept @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to switch windows. Use @kbd{C-M-i} or
1840 @kbd{@key{ESC} @key{TAB}} instead for completion (@pxref{Completion}).}.
1842 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1843 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1844 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1845 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1846 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and columns}), and you can also arrange
1847 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1848 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1849 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state
1855 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1858 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
1859 @vindex org-export-with-properties
1860 You can select the name of the drawers which should be exported with
1861 @code{org-export-with-drawers}. In that case, drawer contents will appear in
1862 export output. Property drawers are not affected by this variable: configure
1863 @code{org-export-with-properties} instead.
1868 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1869 @cindex blocks, folding
1870 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1871 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1872 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1873 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1874 folded at startup by configuring the option @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1875 or on a per-file basis by using
1877 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1878 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1880 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1881 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1888 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes.
1890 A footnote is started by a footnote marker in square brackets in column 0, no
1891 indentation allowed. It ends at the next footnote definition, headline, or
1892 after two consecutive empty lines. The footnote reference is simply the
1893 marker in square brackets, inside text. Markers always start with
1894 @code{fn:}. For example:
1897 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1899 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1902 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1903 optional inline definition. Here are the valid references:
1907 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1908 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1909 @item [fn::This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1910 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1912 @item [fn:name:a definition]
1913 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1914 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1915 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1918 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1919 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1920 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1921 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1924 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1929 The footnote action command.
1931 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1932 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1934 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1935 @vindex org-footnote-section
1936 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1937 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the option
1938 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1939 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1940 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1941 separately into the location determined by the option
1942 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1944 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1947 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1948 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1949 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1950 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1951 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1952 @r{option @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1953 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1954 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the option}
1955 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1956 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1957 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1958 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1959 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers.}
1960 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1963 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1964 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1965 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1970 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1971 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1972 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1976 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1977 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1978 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1980 @vindex org-edit-footnote-reference
1984 Edit the footnote definition corresponding to the reference at point in
1985 a seperate window. The window can be closed by pressing @kbd{C-c '}.
1989 @node Orgstruct mode
1990 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1991 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1992 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1994 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1995 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1996 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1997 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode RET}, or
1998 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
2001 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
2002 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
2005 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
2006 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
2007 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
2008 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
2009 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows.
2011 When you use @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and
2012 autofill settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first
2015 @vindex orgstruct-heading-prefix-regexp
2016 You can also use Org structure editing to fold and unfold headlines in
2017 @emph{any} file, provided you defined @code{orgstruct-heading-prefix-regexp}:
2018 the regular expression must match the local prefix to use before Org's
2019 headlines. For example, if you set this variable to @code{";; "} in Emacs
2020 Lisp files, you will be able to fold and unfold headlines in Emacs Lisp
2021 commented lines. Some commands like @code{org-demote} are disabled when the
2022 prefix is set, but folding/unfolding will work correctly.
2028 A reference document providing a formal description of Org's syntax is
2029 available as @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-syntax.html, a draft on
2030 Worg}, written and maintained by Nicolas Goaziou. It defines Org's core
2031 internal concepts such as @code{headlines}, @code{sections}, @code{affiliated
2032 keywords}, @code{(greater) elements} and @code{objects}. Each part of an Org
2033 file falls into one of the categories above.
2035 To explore the abstract structure of an Org buffer, run this in a buffer:
2038 M-: (org-element-parse-buffer) RET
2041 It will output a list containing the buffer's content represented as an
2042 abstract structure. The export engine relies on the information stored in
2043 this list. Most interactive commands (e.g., for structure editing) also
2044 rely on the syntactic meaning of the surrounding context.
2046 @cindex syntax checker
2048 You can check syntax in your documents using @code{org-lint} command.
2053 @cindex editing tables
2055 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
2056 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
2057 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
2060 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
2061 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
2062 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2063 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2064 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2065 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2068 @node Built-in table editor
2069 @section The built-in table editor
2070 @cindex table editor, built-in
2072 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII@. Any line with @samp{|} as
2073 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2074 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2075 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2076 might look like this:
2079 | Name | Phone | Age |
2080 |-------+-------+-----|
2081 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2082 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2085 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2086 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2087 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2088 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2089 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2090 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2091 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2092 create the above table, you would only type
2099 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2100 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2101 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2103 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2104 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2105 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2106 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2107 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2108 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2109 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2110 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2111 unpredictable for you, configure the options
2112 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2115 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2116 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2117 Convert the active region to a table. If every line contains at least one
2118 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2119 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2120 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2121 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2122 C-u} forces TAB, @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} will prompt for a regular expression to
2123 match the separator, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2124 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2126 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2127 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2128 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2130 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2131 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2132 Re-align the table and don't move to another field.
2134 @orgcmd{C-c SPC,org-table-blank-field}
2135 Blank the field at point.
2137 @orgcmd{TAB,org-table-next-field}
2138 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2141 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2142 Re-align, move to previous field.
2144 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2145 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2146 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2147 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2149 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2150 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2151 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2152 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2154 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2155 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2156 Move the current column left/right.
2158 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2159 Kill the current column.
2161 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2162 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2164 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2165 Move the current row up/down.
2167 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2168 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2170 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2171 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2172 created below the current one.
2174 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2175 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2176 is created above the current line.
2178 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2179 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2182 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2183 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2184 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2185 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2186 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2187 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2188 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2189 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2190 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). You can sort in normal or
2191 reverse order. You can also supply your own key extraction and comparison
2192 functions. When called with a prefix argument, alphabetic sorting will be
2195 @tsubheading{Regions}
2196 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2197 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2198 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2199 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2201 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2202 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2203 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2205 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2206 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2207 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2208 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2209 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2212 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2213 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2214 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2215 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2216 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2217 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2218 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2221 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2222 @cindex formula, in tables
2223 @cindex calculations, in tables
2224 @cindex region, active
2225 @cindex active region
2226 @cindex transient mark mode
2227 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2228 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2229 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2230 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2232 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2233 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2234 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2235 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2236 Depending on the option @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2237 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2238 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2239 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2240 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2242 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2243 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2244 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2245 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2246 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2247 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2248 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2249 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2250 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2252 @item M-x org-table-import RET
2253 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2254 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2255 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2256 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2257 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2258 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2260 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2261 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2262 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2263 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2265 @item M-x org-table-export RET
2266 @findex org-table-export
2267 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2268 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2269 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2270 used to export the file can be configured in the option
2271 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2272 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2273 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2274 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2275 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2276 detailed description.
2279 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2280 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2284 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2287 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2288 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2290 @node Column width and alignment
2291 @section Column width and alignment
2292 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2293 @cindex alignment in tables
2295 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2296 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2297 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2299 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2300 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2301 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set the width of
2302 a column, one field anywhere in the column may contain just the string
2303 @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an integer specifying the width of the column in
2304 characters. The next re-align will then set the width of this column to this
2309 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2311 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2312 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2313 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2314 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2315 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2320 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2321 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2322 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2323 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2324 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the grave accent). This will
2325 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2328 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2329 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2330 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2331 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2332 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2333 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2334 on a per-file basis with:
2341 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2342 to the right and of string-rich columns to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2343 @samp{<c>}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2344 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2345 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<r10>}.
2347 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2348 automatically when exporting the document.
2351 @section Column groups
2352 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2354 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical lines because
2355 that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally however, vertical
2356 lines can be useful to structure a table into groups of columns, much like
2357 horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In order to specify column
2358 groups, you can use a special row where the first field contains only
2359 @samp{/}. The further fields can either contain @samp{<} to indicate that
2360 this column should start a group, @samp{>} to indicate the end of a group, or
2361 @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<} and @samp{>}) to make a column a group
2362 of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be marked with
2363 vertical lines. Here is an example:
2366 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | ~sqrt(n)~ | ~sqrt[4](N)~ |
2367 |---+-----+-----+-----+-----------+--------------|
2368 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2369 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2370 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2371 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2372 |---+-----+-----+-----+-----------+--------------|
2373 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2376 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2377 every vertical line you would like to have:
2380 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2381 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2386 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2388 @cindex minor mode for tables
2390 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2391 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2392 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2393 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode RET}. To turn it on by default, for
2394 example in Message mode, use
2397 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2400 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2401 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2402 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2403 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2404 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2406 @node The spreadsheet
2407 @section The spreadsheet
2408 @cindex calculations, in tables
2409 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2410 @cindex @file{calc} package
2412 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2413 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2414 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2415 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2416 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2417 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2418 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2419 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2420 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2423 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2424 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2425 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2426 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2427 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2428 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2429 * Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables
2430 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2431 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2432 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2436 @subsection References
2439 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2440 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2441 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2442 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2443 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2445 @subsubheading Field references
2446 @cindex field references
2447 @cindex references, to fields
2449 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2450 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2451 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2452 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2453 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2454 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2455 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the option
2456 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2457 representation that looks like this:
2459 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2462 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2463 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e., the
2464 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2465 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2466 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2467 column from the right.
2469 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2470 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2471 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2472 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2473 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2474 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2475 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2476 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2477 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2478 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2479 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2480 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2481 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2482 after the third hline in the table.
2484 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2485 i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2486 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2489 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2490 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2491 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2492 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2493 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2494 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2496 Here are a few examples:
2499 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2500 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2501 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2502 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2503 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2504 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2507 @subsubheading Range references
2508 @cindex range references
2509 @cindex references, to ranges
2511 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2512 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2513 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2514 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2515 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2516 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2519 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2520 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2521 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the last but one}
2522 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2523 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 fields in the row above, starting from 2 columns on the left}
2524 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2527 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2528 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally suppressed,
2529 so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields. For other options
2530 with the mode switches @samp{E}, @samp{N} and examples @pxref{Formula syntax
2533 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2534 @cindex field coordinates
2535 @cindex coordinates, of field
2536 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2537 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2539 One of the very first actions during evaluation of Calc formulas and Lisp
2540 formulas is to substitute @code{@@#} and @code{$#} in the formula with the
2541 row or column number of the field where the current result will go to. The
2542 traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline} and
2543 @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2546 @item if(@@# % 2, $#, string(""))
2547 Insert column number on odd rows, set field to empty on even rows.
2548 @item $2 = '(identity remote(FOO, @@@@#$1))
2549 Copy text or values of each row of column 1 of the table named @code{FOO}
2550 into column 2 of the current table.
2551 @item @@3 = 2 * remote(FOO, @@1$$#)
2552 Insert the doubled value of each column of row 1 of the table named
2553 @code{FOO} into row 3 of the current table.
2556 @noindent For the second/third example, the table named @code{FOO} must have
2557 at least as many rows/columns as the current table. Note that this is
2558 inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as O(N^2) because the table
2559 named @code{FOO} is parsed for each field to be read.} for large number of
2562 @subsubheading Named references
2563 @cindex named references
2564 @cindex references, named
2565 @cindex name, of column or field
2566 @cindex constants, in calculations
2569 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2570 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2571 constant. Constants are defined globally through the option
2572 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2576 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2580 @vindex constants-unit-system
2581 @pindex constants.el
2582 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and columns}) can be used as
2583 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2584 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2585 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2586 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2587 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2588 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2589 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2590 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2591 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2592 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2593 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2594 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2595 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2598 @subsubheading Remote references
2599 @cindex remote references
2600 @cindex references, remote
2601 @cindex references, to a different table
2602 @cindex name, of column or field
2603 @cindex constants, in calculations
2604 @cindex #+NAME, for table
2606 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2607 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2610 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2614 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2615 @code{#+NAME: Name} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2616 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2617 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2618 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2621 Indirection of NAME-OR-ID: When NAME-OR-ID has the format @code{@@ROW$COLUMN}
2622 it will be substituted with the name or ID found in this field of the current
2623 table. For example @code{remote($1, @@>$2)} => @code{remote(year_2013,
2624 @@>$1)}. The format @code{B3} is not supported because it can not be
2625 distinguished from a plain table name or ID.
2627 @node Formula syntax for Calc
2628 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2629 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2630 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2632 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs @file{Calc}
2633 package. Note that @file{calc} has the non-standard convention that @samp{/}
2634 has lower precedence than @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as
2635 @samp{a/(b*c)}. Before evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc
2636 from Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc,
2637 GNU Emacs Calc Manual}), variable substitution takes place according to the
2638 rules described above.
2639 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2640 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2641 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2643 @cindex format specifier
2644 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2645 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2646 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2647 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2648 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2649 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2650 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2651 compact. The default settings can be configured using the option
2652 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2654 @noindent List of modes:
2658 Set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits.
2659 @item @code{n3}, @code{s3}, @code{e2}, @code{f4}
2660 Normal, scientific, engineering or fixed format of the result of Calc passed
2661 back to Org. Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as long as the Calc
2662 calculation precision is greater.
2663 @item @code{D}, @code{R}
2664 Degree and radian angle modes of Calc.
2665 @item @code{F}, @code{S}
2666 Fraction and symbolic modes of Calc.
2667 @item @code{T}, @code{t}, @code{U}
2668 Duration computations in Calc or Lisp, @pxref{Durations and time values}.
2670 If and how to consider empty fields. Without @samp{E} empty fields in range
2671 references are suppressed so that the Calc vector or Lisp list contains only
2672 the non-empty fields. With @samp{E} the empty fields are kept. For empty
2673 fields in ranges or empty field references the value @samp{nan} (not a
2674 number) is used in Calc formulas and the empty string is used for Lisp
2675 formulas. Add @samp{N} to use 0 instead for both formula types. For the
2676 value of a field the mode @samp{N} has higher precedence than @samp{E}.
2678 Interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers. See the next section
2679 to see how this is essential for computations with Lisp formulas. In Calc
2680 formulas it is used only occasionally because there number strings are
2681 already interpreted as numbers without @samp{N}.
2683 Literal, for Lisp formulas only. See the next section.
2687 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation and
2688 -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2689 @samp{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2690 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2691 formatting@footnote{The @samp{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2692 because the value passed to it is converted into an @samp{integer} or
2693 @samp{double}. The @samp{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2694 signed value to 32 bits. The @samp{double} is limited in precision to 64
2695 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}. A
2699 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2700 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2701 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2702 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2703 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2704 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2705 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2706 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2707 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2710 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations, (@pxref{Logical
2711 Operations, , Logical Operations, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}). For example
2714 @item if($1 < 20, teen, string(""))
2715 "teen" if age $1 is less than 20, else the Org table result field is set to
2716 empty with the empty string.
2717 @item if("$1" == "nan" || "$2" == "nan", string(""), $1 + $2); E f-1
2718 Sum of the first two columns. When at least one of the input fields is empty
2719 the Org table result field is set to empty. @samp{E} is required to not
2720 convert empty fields to 0. @samp{f-1} is an optional Calc format string
2721 similar to @samp{%.1f} but leaves empty results empty.
2722 @item if(typeof(vmean($1..$7)) == 12, string(""), vmean($1..$7); E
2723 Mean value of a range unless there is any empty field. Every field in the
2724 range that is empty is replaced by @samp{nan} which lets @samp{vmean} result
2725 in @samp{nan}. Then @samp{typeof == 12} detects the @samp{nan} from
2726 @samp{vmean} and the Org table result field is set to empty. Use this when
2727 the sample set is expected to never have missing values.
2728 @item if("$1..$7" == "[]", string(""), vmean($1..$7))
2729 Mean value of a range with empty fields skipped. Every field in the range
2730 that is empty is skipped. When all fields in the range are empty the mean
2731 value is not defined and the Org table result field is set to empty. Use
2732 this when the sample set can have a variable size.
2733 @item vmean($1..$7); EN
2734 To complete the example before: Mean value of a range with empty fields
2735 counting as samples with value 0. Use this only when incomplete sample sets
2736 should be padded with 0 to the full size.
2739 You can add your own Calc functions defined in Emacs Lisp with @code{defmath}
2740 and use them in formula syntax for Calc.
2742 @node Formula syntax for Lisp
2743 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2744 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2746 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2747 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2750 If a formula starts with an apostrophe followed by an opening parenthesis,
2751 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2752 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2753 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2755 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2756 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2757 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2758 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2759 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2760 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2761 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2762 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2763 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2764 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2766 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2767 computations in Lisp:
2770 @item '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2771 Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1.
2773 Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}.
2774 @item '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2775 Compute the sum of columns 1 to 4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}.
2778 @node Durations and time values
2779 @subsection Durations and time values
2780 @cindex Duration, computing
2781 @cindex Time, computing
2782 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2784 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T}, @code{t}, or @code{U}
2785 flag, either in Calc formulas or Elisp formulas:
2789 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2790 |---------+----------+----------|
2791 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2792 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59 |
2793 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2794 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;U::@@4$3=$1+$2;t
2798 Input duration values must be of the form @code{HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2799 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2800 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{U} flag,
2801 seconds will be omitted so that the result will be only @code{HH:MM} (see
2802 second formula above). Zero-padding of the hours field will depend upon the
2803 value of the variable @code{org-table-duration-hour-zero-padding}.
2805 With the @code{t} flag, computed durations will be displayed according to the
2806 value of the option @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults
2807 to @code{'hours} and will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the
2808 third formula in the example above).
2810 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2811 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2813 @node Field and range formulas
2814 @subsection Field and range formulas
2815 @cindex field formula
2816 @cindex range formula
2817 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2818 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2820 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2821 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2822 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2823 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2824 current field will be replaced with the result.
2827 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2828 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2829 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2830 inserting/deleting/swapping columns and rows with the appropriate commands,
2831 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2832 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this, in
2833 particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table borders (using
2834 @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines using the
2835 @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does of course
2836 not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2837 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2839 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2843 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2844 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2845 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2846 it to the current field, and stores it.
2849 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2850 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2851 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2852 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2857 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2858 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2860 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2863 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2864 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2866 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2869 @node Column formulas
2870 @subsection Column formulas
2871 @cindex column formula
2872 @cindex formula, for table column
2874 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2875 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2876 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2877 hlines with rows above and below, everything before the first such hline is
2878 considered part of the table @emph{header} and will not be modified by column
2879 formulas. Therefore a header is mandatory when you use column formulas and
2880 want to add hlines to group rows, like for example to separate a total row at
2881 the bottom from the summand rows above. (ii) Fields that already get a value
2882 from a field/range formula will be left alone by column formulas. These
2883 conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2885 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2886 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2887 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2888 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2889 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2890 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2891 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2892 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2893 left-hand side of a column formula cannot be the name of column, it must be
2894 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2896 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2900 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2901 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2902 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2903 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2904 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g., @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2905 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2908 @node Lookup functions
2909 @subsection Lookup functions
2910 @cindex lookup functions in tables
2911 @cindex table lookup functions
2913 Org has three predefined Emacs Lisp functions for lookups in tables.
2915 @item (org-lookup-first VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)
2916 @findex org-lookup-first
2917 Searches for the first element @code{S} in list @code{S-LIST} for which
2921 is @code{t}; returns the value from the corresponding position in list
2922 @code{R-LIST}. The default @code{PREDICATE} is @code{equal}. Note that the
2923 parameters @code{VAL} and @code{S} are passed to @code{PREDICATE} in the same
2924 order as the corresponding parameters are in the call to
2925 @code{org-lookup-first}, where @code{VAL} precedes @code{S-LIST}. If
2926 @code{R-LIST} is @code{nil}, the matching element @code{S} of @code{S-LIST}
2928 @item (org-lookup-last VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)
2929 @findex org-lookup-last
2930 Similar to @code{org-lookup-first} above, but searches for the @i{last}
2931 element for which @code{PREDICATE} is @code{t}.
2932 @item (org-lookup-all VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)
2933 @findex org-lookup-all
2934 Similar to @code{org-lookup-first}, but searches for @i{all} elements for
2935 which @code{PREDICATE} is @code{t}, and returns @i{all} corresponding
2936 values. This function can not be used by itself in a formula, because it
2937 returns a list of values. However, powerful lookups can be built when this
2938 function is combined with other Emacs Lisp functions.
2941 If the ranges used in these functions contain empty fields, the @code{E} mode
2942 for the formula should usually be specified: otherwise empty fields will not be
2943 included in @code{S-LIST} and/or @code{R-LIST} which can, for example, result
2944 in an incorrect mapping from an element of @code{S-LIST} to the corresponding
2945 element of @code{R-LIST}.
2947 These three functions can be used to implement associative arrays, count
2948 matching cells, rank results, group data etc. For practical examples
2949 see @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-lookups.html, this
2952 @node Editing and debugging formulas
2953 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2954 @cindex formula editing
2955 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2957 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2958 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the field.
2959 Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active formulas of a table.
2960 When offering a formula for editing, Org converts references to the standard
2961 format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&}) if possible. If you prefer to only work
2962 with the internal format (like @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the
2963 option @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2966 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2967 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2968 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2969 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2970 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2971 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2972 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2973 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2974 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2975 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2976 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2978 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2980 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2981 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2982 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2984 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2986 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2987 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2988 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2989 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2990 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2991 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2992 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2993 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2994 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2997 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2998 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2999 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
3000 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
3001 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
3002 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
3003 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
3004 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
3005 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
3006 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
3007 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
3008 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
3009 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
3010 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
3011 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.@footnote{Many desktops
3012 intercept @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to switch windows. Use @kbd{C-M-i} or
3013 @kbd{@key{ESC} @key{TAB}} instead for completion (@pxref{Completion}).}
3015 @kindex S-@key{down}
3016 @kindex S-@key{left}
3017 @kindex S-@key{right}
3018 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
3019 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
3020 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
3021 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
3022 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
3023 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
3024 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
3025 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
3026 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
3027 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
3029 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
3030 Scroll the window displaying the table.
3032 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
3034 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
3038 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
3039 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
3040 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
3041 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
3042 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
3045 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
3046 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
3047 recalculation commands in the table.
3049 @anchor{Using multiple #+TBLFM lines}
3050 @subsubheading Using multiple #+TBLFM lines
3051 @cindex #+TBLFM line, multiple
3053 @cindex #+TBLFM, switching
3056 You may apply the formula temporarily. This is useful when you
3057 switch the formula. Place multiple @samp{#+TBLFM} lines right
3058 after the table, and then press @kbd{C-c C-c} on the formula to
3059 apply. Here is an example:
3071 Pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in the line of @samp{#+TBLFM: $2=$1*2} yields:
3083 Note: If you recalculate this table (with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, for example), you
3084 will get the following result of applying only the first @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
3095 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
3096 @cindex formula debugging
3097 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
3098 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
3099 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
3100 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
3101 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
3102 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
3103 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
3105 @node Updating the table
3106 @subsection Updating the table
3107 @cindex recomputing table fields
3108 @cindex updating, table
3110 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
3111 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
3112 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
3114 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
3118 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
3119 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
3120 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
3126 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
3127 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
3129 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
3130 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
3131 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
3132 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
3133 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables RET
3134 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
3135 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
3136 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables RET
3137 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
3138 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
3142 @node Advanced features
3143 @subsection Advanced features
3145 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
3146 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
3147 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
3148 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
3149 special marking characters.
3152 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
3153 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
3154 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
3155 change all marks in the region.
3158 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
3159 makes use of these features:
3163 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3164 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
3165 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3166 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
3167 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
3168 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
3169 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3170 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
3171 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
3172 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3173 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
3174 | ^ | | | | | at | |
3175 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
3176 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3177 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
3181 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
3182 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
3183 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
3184 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
3187 @cindex marking characters, tables
3188 The marking characters have the following meaning:
3192 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
3193 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
3195 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
3196 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
3197 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
3198 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
3200 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
3203 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
3204 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
3205 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
3206 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
3209 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
3210 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
3211 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
3212 lines will be left alone by this command.
3214 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
3215 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
3216 recalculation slows down editing too much.
3218 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
3219 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
3222 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3223 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3226 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3227 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3228 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3233 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3234 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3235 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3236 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3237 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3238 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3239 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3240 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3241 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3242 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3243 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3249 @cindex graph, in tables
3250 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3253 Org-Plot can produce graphs of information stored in org tables, either
3254 graphically or in ASCII-art.
3256 @subheading Graphical plots using @file{Gnuplot}
3258 Org-Plot produces 2D and 3D graphs using @file{Gnuplot}
3259 @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3260 @uref{http://xafs.org/BruceRavel/GnuplotMode}. To see this in action, ensure
3261 that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed on your system, then
3262 call @kbd{C-c " g} or @kbd{M-x org-plot/gnuplot @key{RET}} on the following
3267 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3268 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3269 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3270 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3271 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3272 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3273 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3274 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3278 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3279 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3280 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3281 for a complete list of Org-plot options. The @code{#+PLOT:} lines are
3282 optional. For more information and examples see the Org-plot tutorial at
3283 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3285 @subsubheading Plot Options
3289 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3292 Specify the title of the plot.
3295 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3298 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3299 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3300 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3304 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3307 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3308 (e.g., @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3309 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3312 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3315 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3319 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3322 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3323 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3326 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3327 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3330 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3331 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3332 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3333 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3334 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3338 @subheading ASCII bar plots
3340 While the cursor is on a column, typing @kbd{C-c " a} or
3341 @kbd{M-x orgtbl-ascii-plot @key{RET}} create a new column containing an
3342 ASCII-art bars plot. The plot is implemented through a regular column
3343 formula. When the source column changes, the bar plot may be updated by
3344 refreshing the table, for example typing @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
3348 | Sede | Max cites | |
3349 |---------------+-----------+--------------|
3350 | Chile | 257.72 | WWWWWWWWWWWW |
3351 | Leeds | 165.77 | WWWWWWWh |
3352 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | WWW; |
3353 | Stockholm | 134.19 | WWWWWW: |
3354 | Morelia | 257.56 | WWWWWWWWWWWH |
3355 | Rochefourchat | 0.00 | |
3356 #+TBLFM: $3='(orgtbl-ascii-draw $2 0.0 257.72 12)
3360 The formula is an elisp call:
3362 (orgtbl-ascii-draw COLUMN MIN MAX WIDTH)
3367 is a reference to the source column.
3370 are the minimal and maximal values displayed. Sources values
3371 outside this range are displayed as @samp{too small}
3372 or @samp{too large}.
3375 is the width in characters of the bar-plot. It defaults to @samp{12}.
3383 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3384 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3387 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3388 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3389 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3390 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3391 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3392 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3393 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3394 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3398 @section Link format
3400 @cindex format, of links
3402 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3403 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3406 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3410 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3411 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3412 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3413 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3414 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3415 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3416 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3417 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3420 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3421 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3422 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3423 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3424 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3425 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3426 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3428 @node Internal links
3429 @section Internal links
3430 @cindex internal links
3431 @cindex links, internal
3432 @cindex targets, for links
3434 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3435 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3436 current file. The most important case is a link like
3437 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3438 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. You are responsible yourself
3439 to make sure these custom IDs are unique in a file.
3441 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3442 lead to a text search in the current file.
3444 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3445 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3446 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3447 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets, like
3448 @samp{<<My Target>>}.
3451 If no dedicated target exists, the link will then try to match the exact name
3452 of an element within the buffer. Naming is done with the @code{#+NAME}
3453 keyword, which has to be put in the line before the element it refers to, as
3454 in the following example
3463 If none of the above succeeds, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3464 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3465 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type
3466 a star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3467 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3470 During export, internal links will be used to mark objects and assign them
3471 a number. Marked objects will then be referenced by links pointing to them.
3472 In particular, links without a description will appear as the number assigned
3473 to the marked object@footnote{When targeting a @code{#+NAME} keyword,
3474 @code{#+CAPTION} keyword is mandatory in order to get proper numbering
3475 (@pxref{Images and tables}).}. In the following excerpt from an Org buffer
3479 - <<target>>another item
3480 Here we refer to item [[target]].
3484 The last sentence will appear as @samp{Here we refer to item 2} when
3487 In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the link text. In
3488 the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3490 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3491 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3492 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3496 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3500 @subsection Radio targets
3501 @cindex radio targets
3502 @cindex targets, radio
3503 @cindex links, radio targets
3505 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3506 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3507 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3508 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3509 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3510 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3511 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3512 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3513 cursor on or at a target.
3515 @node External links
3516 @section External links
3517 @cindex links, external
3518 @cindex external links
3526 @cindex USENET links
3531 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages, BBDB
3532 database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their logs.
3533 External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short identifying
3534 string followed by a colon. There can be no space after the colon. The
3535 following list shows examples for each link type.
3538 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3539 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3540 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3541 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3542 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3543 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3544 file:/ssh:myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3545 /ssh:myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3546 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3547 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3548 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3549 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3550 the option @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3551 is @code{nil}, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is @code{t}, then only
3552 the exact headline will be matched, ignoring spaces and cookies. If the
3553 value is @code{query-to-create}, then an exact headline will be searched; if
3554 it is not found, then the user will be queried to create it.}
3555 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}@footnote{
3556 Headline searches always match the exact headline, ignoring
3557 spaces and cookies. If the headline is not found and the value of the option
3558 @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline} is @code{query-to-create},
3559 then the user will be queried to create it.}
3560 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3561 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3562 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3563 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3564 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3565 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3566 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3567 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3568 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3569 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3570 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3571 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3572 info:org#External links @r{Info node or index link}
3573 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3574 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3575 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3579 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3580 On top of these built-in link types, some are available through the
3581 @code{contrib/} directory (@pxref{Installation}). For example, these links
3582 to VM or Wanderlust messages are available when you load the corresponding
3583 libraries from the @code{contrib/} directory:
3586 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3587 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3588 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3589 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3590 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3591 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3592 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3595 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3597 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a descriptive
3598 text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link format}), for example:
3601 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3605 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3606 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3607 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3609 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3611 @cindex square brackets, around links
3612 @cindex plain text external links
3613 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3614 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3615 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3616 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3618 @node Handling links
3619 @section Handling links
3620 @cindex links, handling
3622 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3623 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3626 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3627 @cindex storing links
3628 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3629 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3630 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3631 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3634 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3635 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3636 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3637 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3638 removed from the link and result in a wrong link---you should avoid putting
3639 timestamp in the headline.}.
3641 @vindex org-id-link-to-org-use-id
3642 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3643 @cindex property, ID
3644 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3645 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3646 @code{org-id-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will
3647 be created and/or used to construct a link@footnote{The library
3648 @file{org-id.el} must first be loaded, either through @code{org-customize} by
3649 enabling @code{org-id} in @code{org-modules}, or by adding @code{(require
3650 'org-id)} in your Emacs init file.}. So using this command in Org buffers
3651 will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom ID, and
3652 one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from file to
3653 file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one to use.
3655 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3656 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3657 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3658 constructed from the author and the subject.
3660 @b{Web browsers: Eww, W3 and W3M}@*
3661 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3663 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3664 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3667 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3668 For IRC links, if you set the option @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to @code{t},
3669 a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for the current
3670 conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to the
3671 user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3674 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3675 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3676 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3677 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3678 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3679 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3680 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3683 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3684 entry referenced by the current line.
3687 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3688 @cindex link completion
3689 @cindex completion, of links
3690 @cindex inserting links
3691 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3692 @vindex org-link-parameters
3693 Insert a link@footnote{Note that you don't have to use this command to
3694 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3695 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3696 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3697 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3698 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3699 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3700 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3701 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3702 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3703 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3704 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3705 becomes the default description.
3707 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3708 All links stored during the
3709 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3710 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3712 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3713 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3714 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3715 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3716 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works if
3717 a completion function is defined in the @samp{:complete} property of a link
3718 in @code{org-link-parameters}.} For example, if you type @kbd{file
3719 @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see
3720 below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb @key{RET}} you can complete
3723 @cindex file name completion
3724 @cindex completion, of file names
3725 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3726 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3727 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3728 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3729 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3730 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3731 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3732 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3734 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3735 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3736 link and description parts of the link.
3738 @cindex following links
3739 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3740 @vindex org-file-apps
3741 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3742 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3743 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3744 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3745 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3746 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3747 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3748 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3749 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3750 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3751 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3752 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3753 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3754 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3755 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3756 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3759 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3760 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3767 On links, @kbd{mouse-1} and @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c
3772 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3773 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3774 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3775 option @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3777 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3778 @cindex inlining images
3779 @cindex images, inlining
3780 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3781 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3782 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3783 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3784 images that have no description part in the link, i.e., images that will also
3785 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3786 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3787 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3788 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3789 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{noinlineimages}}.
3790 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3792 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3793 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3795 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3796 @cindex links, returning to
3797 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3798 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3799 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3800 previously recorded positions.
3802 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3803 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3804 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3805 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3806 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3807 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3809 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3811 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3812 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3816 @node Using links outside Org
3817 @section Using links outside Org
3819 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3820 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3821 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3825 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3826 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3829 @node Link abbreviations
3830 @section Link abbreviations
3831 @cindex link abbreviations
3832 @cindex abbreviation, links
3834 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3835 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3836 abbreviated link looks like this
3839 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3843 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3844 where the tag is optional.
3845 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3846 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3847 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3848 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3852 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3853 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3854 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3855 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3856 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3857 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3858 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3862 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3863 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3864 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3865 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3866 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3868 If the replacement text doesn't contain any specifier, the tag will simply be
3869 appended in order to create the link.
3871 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3872 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3874 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3875 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3876 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3877 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3878 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3879 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3880 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3882 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3883 can define them in the file with
3887 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3888 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3892 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3893 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function that implements
3894 special (e.g., completion) support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c
3895 C-l}. Such a function should not accept any arguments, and return the full
3896 link with prefix. You can add a completion function to a link like this:
3899 (org-link-set-parameters ``type'' :complete #'some-function)
3903 @node Search options
3904 @section Search options in file links
3905 @cindex search option in file links
3906 @cindex file links, searching
3908 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3909 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3910 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3911 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3912 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3913 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3914 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3915 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3917 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3918 link, together with an explanation:
3921 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3922 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3923 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3924 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3925 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3932 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3933 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3934 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3935 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3938 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3940 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3942 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3943 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3944 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3945 sparse tree with the matches.
3946 @c If the target file is a directory,
3947 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3950 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3951 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3952 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3953 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3955 @node Custom searches
3956 @section Custom Searches
3957 @cindex custom search strings
3958 @cindex search strings, custom
3960 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3961 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3962 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3963 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3964 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3967 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3968 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3969 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3970 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3971 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3972 to be added to the hook variables
3973 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3974 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3975 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3976 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3977 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3983 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3984 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3985 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3986 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3987 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3988 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3989 item emerged is always present.
3991 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3992 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3993 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3996 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3997 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3998 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3999 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
4000 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
4001 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
4005 @section Basic TODO functionality
4007 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
4008 @samp{TODO}, for example:
4011 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
4015 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
4018 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
4019 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
4020 @vindex org-use-fast-todo-selection
4022 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
4025 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
4026 '--------------------------------'
4029 If TODO keywords have fast access keys (see @ref{Fast access to TODO
4030 states}), you will be prompted for a TODO keyword through the fast selection
4031 interface; this is the default behavior when
4032 @code{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is non-@code{nil}.
4034 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from agenda buffers with the
4035 @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4037 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
4038 When TODO keywords have no selection keys, select a specific keyword using
4039 completion; otherwise force cycling through TODO states with no prompt. When
4040 @code{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is set to @code{prefix}, use the fast
4041 selection interface.
4043 @kindex S-@key{right}
4044 @kindex S-@key{left}
4045 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
4046 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
4047 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
4048 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
4049 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
4050 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
4051 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
4052 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-tree}
4053 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
4054 @vindex org-todo-keywords
4055 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
4056 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
4057 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
4058 / T}), search for a specific TODO@. You will be prompted for the keyword,
4059 and you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
4060 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
4061 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the option @code{org-todo-keywords}.
4062 With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states, both un-done and done.
4063 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
4064 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
4065 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda views}) into a single buffer. The new
4066 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
4067 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4068 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
4069 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4070 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
4074 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
4075 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
4076 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
4078 @node TODO extensions
4079 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
4080 @cindex extended TODO keywords
4082 @vindex org-todo-keywords
4083 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
4084 DONE@. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
4085 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
4086 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
4089 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
4090 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
4093 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
4094 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
4095 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
4096 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
4097 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
4098 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
4099 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
4102 @node Workflow states
4103 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
4104 @cindex TODO workflow
4105 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
4107 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
4108 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
4109 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
4113 (setq org-todo-keywords
4114 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
4117 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
4118 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
4119 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
4121 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
4122 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
4123 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED@. You may
4124 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
4125 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY@.
4126 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
4127 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
4128 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
4129 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
4130 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
4131 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
4134 @subsection TODO keywords as types
4136 @cindex names as TODO keywords
4137 @cindex types as TODO keywords
4139 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
4140 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
4141 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
4142 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
4143 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
4144 be set up like this:
4147 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
4150 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
4151 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to
4152 a person, and later to mark it DONE@. Org mode supports this style by
4153 adapting the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true
4154 for the @kbd{t} command in the agenda buffers.}. When used several times in
4155 succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first select
4156 the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some time
4157 and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly to
4158 DONE@. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific name.
4159 You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree by
4160 using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things Lucy
4161 has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items from all
4162 agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix argument
4163 as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
4165 @node Multiple sets in one file
4166 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
4167 @cindex TODO keyword sets
4169 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
4170 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
4171 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
4172 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
4173 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
4177 (setq org-todo-keywords
4178 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
4179 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
4180 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
4183 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
4184 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
4185 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
4186 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
4187 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
4188 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
4189 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
4192 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
4193 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
4194 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
4195 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
4196 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
4197 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
4198 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
4199 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
4200 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
4201 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
4202 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
4203 @kindex S-@key{right}
4204 @kindex S-@key{left}
4207 @kbd{S-@key{left}} and @kbd{S-@key{right}} and walk through @emph{all}
4208 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{right}} would switch
4209 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
4210 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4211 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4214 @node Fast access to TODO states
4215 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
4217 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
4218 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
4219 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
4220 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
4221 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
4224 (setq org-todo-keywords
4225 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
4226 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
4227 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
4230 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
4231 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
4232 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
4233 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the option
4234 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
4235 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
4236 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
4237 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
4239 @node Per-file keywords
4240 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
4241 @cindex keyword options
4242 @cindex per-file keywords
4247 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
4248 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines to
4249 the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file only. For
4250 example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you need one of the
4251 following lines anywhere in the file:
4254 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
4256 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
4257 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
4259 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
4262 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
4266 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
4270 @cindex completion, of option keywords
4272 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
4273 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
4275 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
4276 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
4277 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
4278 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
4279 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
4280 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
4281 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
4282 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
4283 for the current buffer.}.
4285 @node Faces for TODO keywords
4286 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
4287 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
4289 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
4290 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
4291 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
4292 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
4293 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
4294 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
4295 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
4296 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the option
4297 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
4301 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
4302 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
4303 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4307 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4308 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4309 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The option
4310 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4311 foreground or a background color.
4313 @node TODO dependencies
4314 @subsection TODO dependencies
4315 @cindex TODO dependencies
4316 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4317 @cindex TODO dependencies, NOBLOCKING
4319 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4320 @cindex property, ORDERED
4321 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4322 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4323 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE@. And sometimes
4324 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4325 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4326 the option @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4327 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE@.
4328 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4329 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE@. Here is an
4333 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4342 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4343 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4346 You can ensure an entry is never blocked by using the @code{NOBLOCKING}
4350 * This entry is never blocked
4357 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4358 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4359 @cindex property, ORDERED
4360 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4361 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4362 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4363 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the option
4364 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4365 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4366 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4369 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4370 If you set the option @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4371 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4372 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda views}).
4374 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4375 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4376 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4377 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the option
4378 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4379 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4381 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4382 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4383 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4386 @node Progress logging
4387 @section Progress logging
4388 @cindex progress logging
4389 @cindex logging, of progress
4391 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4392 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4393 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable; settings can be on a
4394 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4395 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4399 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4400 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4401 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4405 @subsection Closing items
4407 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4408 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4409 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4412 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4415 @vindex org-closed-keep-when-no-todo
4417 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any of the
4418 DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted just after
4419 the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item through further
4420 state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you turn the entry back
4421 to a non-TODO state (by pressing @key{C-c C-t SPC} for example), that line
4422 will also be removed, unless you set @code{org-closed-keep-when-no-todo} to
4423 non-@code{nil}. If you want to record a note along with the timestamp,
4424 use@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP:
4428 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4432 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4433 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4435 @node Tracking TODO state changes
4436 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4437 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4439 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4440 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4441 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4442 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4443 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4444 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4445 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4446 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the option
4447 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4448 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4449 Customize @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the recommended
4450 drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4451 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4452 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4453 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4454 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4456 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4457 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4458 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4459 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4463 (setq org-todo-keywords
4464 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4467 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4468 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4471 @vindex org-log-done
4472 You not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4473 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4474 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4475 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4476 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4477 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4478 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4479 WAIT or CANCELED@. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4480 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4481 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4482 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4483 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4484 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4485 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4486 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4489 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4492 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4495 @cindex property, LOGGING
4496 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4497 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4498 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to @code{nil}. You may then turn
4499 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4500 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4501 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4504 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4506 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4508 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4510 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4512 * TODO No logging at all
4518 @node Tracking your habits
4519 @subsection Tracking your habits
4522 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4523 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4527 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing @code{org-modules}.
4529 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4531 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4533 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4534 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4535 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4536 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4538 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4539 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4540 three days, but at most every two days.
4542 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled
4543 (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be
4544 represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an
4545 error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless.
4548 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4549 actual habit with some history:
4553 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4556 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4558 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4559 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4560 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4561 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4562 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4563 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4564 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4565 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4566 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4567 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4570 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4571 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4572 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4573 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4574 after four days have elapsed.
4576 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4577 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4578 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4579 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4583 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4585 If the task could have been done on that day.
4587 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4589 If the task was overdue on that day.
4592 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4593 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4594 the current day falls in the graph.
4596 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4597 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4600 @item org-habit-graph-column
4601 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4602 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4603 titles brief and to the point.
4604 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4605 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4606 @item org-habit-following-days
4607 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4608 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4609 If non-@code{nil}, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4613 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4614 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4615 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4616 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4622 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4623 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4624 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4627 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4631 @vindex org-priority-faces
4632 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4633 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4634 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4635 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4636 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4637 special faces by customizing @code{org-priority-faces}.
4639 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4645 @findex org-priority
4646 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4647 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4648 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4649 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the agenda
4650 buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4652 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4653 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4654 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4655 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4656 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4657 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4658 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4661 @vindex org-highest-priority
4662 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4663 @vindex org-default-priority
4664 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the options
4665 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4666 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4667 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4668 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4671 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4676 @node Breaking down tasks
4677 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4678 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4679 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4681 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4682 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4683 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4684 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4685 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4686 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4687 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4688 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4689 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4692 * Organize Party [33%]
4693 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4697 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4700 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4701 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4702 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4703 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4706 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4707 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4708 subtree (not just direct children), configure
4709 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4710 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4714 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4716 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4720 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4721 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4724 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4725 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4726 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4727 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4729 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4733 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4734 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4741 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4742 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4743 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4744 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4745 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4746 (@pxref{TODO items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4747 in the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4748 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4749 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4750 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4752 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4755 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4756 - [-] call people [1/3]
4761 - [ ] think about what music to play
4762 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4765 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4766 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4767 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4770 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4771 @cindex checkbox statistics
4772 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4773 @vindex org-checkbox-hierarchical-statistics
4774 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4775 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4776 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4777 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4778 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4779 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4780 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the option
4781 @code{org-checkbox-hierarchical-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4782 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4783 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4784 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4785 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4786 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4787 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4788 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4789 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4790 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4792 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4793 @cindex checkbox blocking
4794 @cindex property, ORDERED
4795 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4796 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4797 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4799 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4802 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4803 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4804 a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4805 one@footnote{@kbd{C-u C-c C-c} before the @emph{first} bullet in a list with
4806 no checkbox will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double
4807 prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4809 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4810 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4811 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4815 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4816 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4817 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4819 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle the state of the first checkbox in the
4820 region between this headline and the next---so @emph{not} the entire
4821 subtree---and propagate this new state to all other checkboxes in the same
4824 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4826 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4827 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4828 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4829 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4830 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4831 @cindex property, ORDERED
4832 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4833 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4834 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4835 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4836 for better visibility, customize @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4837 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4838 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4839 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4840 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4841 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4842 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4843 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4849 @cindex headline tagging
4850 @cindex matching, tags
4851 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4853 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4854 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4857 @vindex org-tag-faces
4858 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4859 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4860 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4861 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4862 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4863 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the option
4864 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4865 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4868 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4869 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4870 * Tag hierarchy:: Create a hierarchy of tags
4871 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4874 @node Tag inheritance
4875 @section Tag inheritance
4876 @cindex tag inheritance
4877 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4878 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4880 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4881 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4882 well. For example, in the list
4885 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4886 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4887 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4891 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4892 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4893 explicitly marked with all those tags. You can also set tags that all
4894 entries in a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in
4895 a hypothetical level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like
4896 this@footnote{As with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}
4897 activates any changes in the line.}:
4901 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4905 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4906 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4907 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, use @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4908 To turn it off entirely, use @code{org-use-tag-inheritance}.
4910 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4911 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4912 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4913 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4914 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4915 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4916 match in a subtree, configure @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not
4919 @vindex org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance
4920 Tag inheritance is relevant when the agenda search tries to match a tag,
4921 either in the @code{tags} or @code{tags-todo} agenda types. In other agenda
4922 types, @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} has no effect. Still, you may want to
4923 have your tags correctly set in the agenda, so that tag filtering works fine,
4924 with inherited tags. Set @code{org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance} to control
4925 this: the default value includes all agenda types, but setting this to @code{nil}
4926 can really speed up agenda generation.
4929 @section Setting tags
4930 @cindex setting tags
4931 @cindex tags, setting
4934 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4935 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4936 also a special command for inserting tags:
4939 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4940 @cindex completion, of tags
4941 @vindex org-tags-column
4942 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4943 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4944 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4945 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4946 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4947 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4948 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4950 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4951 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4954 @vindex org-tag-alist
4955 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4956 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4957 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4958 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4959 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4963 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4964 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4967 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4968 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4969 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4975 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4976 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4977 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4978 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4979 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4980 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4986 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4987 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4988 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4989 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4990 assign unique, case-sensitive, letters to most of your commonly used tags.
4991 You can do this globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in
4992 your Emacs init file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items
4993 in different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4997 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
5000 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
5001 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
5004 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
5007 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
5008 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
5009 @samp{\n} into the tag list
5012 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
5015 @noindent or write them in two lines:
5018 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
5019 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
5023 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
5027 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
5030 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
5031 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
5033 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
5034 these lines to activate any changes.
5037 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tag-alist},
5038 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
5039 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
5040 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
5044 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
5045 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
5046 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
5048 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
5051 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
5052 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
5053 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
5054 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
5055 have no configured keys.}.
5057 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of tags
5058 in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually exclusive tags
5059 will turn off any other tags from that group.
5061 In this interface, you can also use the following special keys:
5066 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
5067 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
5068 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
5072 Clear all tags for this line.
5076 Accept the modified set.
5079 Abort without installing changes.
5082 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
5085 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
5086 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
5089 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
5090 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
5095 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
5096 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
5097 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
5098 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
5099 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
5100 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
5101 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
5102 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
5104 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
5105 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
5106 modify your list of tags, set @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}.
5107 Then you no longer have to press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it
5108 will immediately exit after the first change. If you then occasionally
5109 need more keys, press @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag
5110 selection process (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c}
5111 instead of @kbd{C-c C-c}). If you set the variable to the value
5112 @code{expert}, the special window is not even shown for single-key tag
5113 selection, it comes up only when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
5116 @section Tag hierarchy
5119 @cindex tags, groups
5120 @cindex tag hierarchy
5121 Tags can be defined in hierarchies. A tag can be defined as a @emph{group
5122 tag} for a set of other tags. The group tag can be seen as the ``broader
5123 term'' for its set of tags. Defining multiple @emph{group tags} and nesting
5124 them creates a tag hierarchy.
5126 One use-case is to create a taxonomy of terms (tags) that can be used to
5127 classify nodes in a document or set of documents.
5129 When you search for a group tag, it will return matches for all members in
5130 the group and its subgroups. In an agenda view, filtering by a group tag
5131 will display or hide headlines tagged with at least one of the members of the
5132 group or any of its subgroups. This makes tag searches and filters even more
5135 You can set group tags by using brackets and inserting a colon between the
5136 group tag and its related tags---beware that all whitespaces are mandatory so
5137 that Org can parse this line correctly:
5140 #+TAGS: [ GTD : Control Persp ]
5143 In this example, @samp{GTD} is the @emph{group tag} and it is related to two
5144 other tags: @samp{Control}, @samp{Persp}. Defining @samp{Control} and
5145 @samp{Persp} as group tags creates an hierarchy of tags:
5148 #+TAGS: [ Control : Context Task ]
5149 #+TAGS: [ Persp : Vision Goal AOF Project ]
5152 That can conceptually be seen as a hierarchy of tags:
5166 You can use the @code{:startgrouptag}, @code{:grouptags} and
5167 @code{:endgrouptag} keyword directly when setting @code{org-tag-alist}
5171 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgrouptag)
5185 The tags in a group can be mutually exclusive if using the same group syntax
5186 as is used for grouping mutually exclusive tags together; using curly
5190 #+TAGS: @{ Context : @@Home @@Work @@Call @}
5193 When setting @code{org-tag-alist} you can use @code{:startgroup} &
5194 @code{:endgroup} instead of @code{:startgrouptag} & @code{:endgrouptag} to
5195 make the tags mutually exclusive.
5197 Furthermore, the members of a @emph{group tag} can also be regular
5198 expressions, creating the possibility of a more dynamic and rule-based
5199 tag structure. The regular expressions in the group must be specified
5200 within @{ @}. Here is an expanded example:
5203 #+TAGS: [ Vision : @{V@@@.+@} ]
5204 #+TAGS: [ Goal : @{G@@@.+@} ]
5205 #+TAGS: [ AOF : @{AOF@@@.+@} ]
5206 #+TAGS: [ Project : @{P@@@.+@} ]
5209 Searching for the tag @samp{Project} will now list all tags also including
5210 regular expression matches for @samp{P@@@.+}, and similarly for tag searches on
5211 @samp{Vision}, @samp{Goal} and @samp{AOF}. For example, this would work well
5212 for a project tagged with a common project-identifier, e.g. @samp{P@@2014_OrgTags}.
5215 @vindex org-group-tags
5216 If you want to ignore group tags temporarily, toggle group tags support
5217 with @command{org-toggle-tags-groups}, bound to @kbd{C-c C-x q}. If you
5218 want to disable tag groups completely, set @code{org-group-tags} to @code{nil}.
5221 @section Tag searches
5222 @cindex tag searches
5223 @cindex searching for tags
5225 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
5226 information into special lists.
5229 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
5230 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags/property/TODO search.
5231 With a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5232 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5233 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5234 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files. @xref{Matching
5235 tags and properties}.
5236 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5237 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5238 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5239 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see the option
5240 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5243 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
5244 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
5245 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
5246 tagged as @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search string
5247 is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels and
5248 properties. For a complete description with many examples, see @ref{Matching
5249 tags and properties}.
5252 @node Properties and columns
5253 @chapter Properties and columns
5256 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
5257 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
5258 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
5260 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
5261 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
5262 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
5263 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
5264 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
5265 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
5266 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
5267 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
5268 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
5270 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
5271 (@pxref{Column view}).
5274 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
5275 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
5276 * Property searches:: Matching property values
5277 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
5278 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
5279 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
5282 @node Property syntax
5283 @section Property syntax
5284 @cindex property syntax
5285 @cindex drawer, for properties
5287 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
5288 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special drawer
5289 (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}, which has to be located
5290 right below a headline, and its planning line (@pxref{Deadlines and
5291 scheduling}) when applicable. Each property is specified on a single line,
5292 with the key (surrounded by colons) first, and the value after it. Keys are
5293 case-insensitives. Here is an example:
5298 *** Goldberg Variations
5300 :Title: Goldberg Variations
5301 :Composer: J.S. Bach
5303 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
5308 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
5309 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the subtree
5310 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
5312 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
5313 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
5314 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
5315 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
5316 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
5317 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
5318 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
5323 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
5324 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
5328 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
5329 file, use a line like
5330 @cindex property, _ALL
5333 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
5336 Contrary to properties set from a special drawer, you have to refresh the
5337 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-c} to activate this change.
5339 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
5340 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
5341 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
5344 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
5345 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
5348 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
5349 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
5350 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
5358 *** Goldberg Variations
5360 :Title: Goldberg Variations
5361 :Composer: J.S. Bach
5363 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
5368 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
5370 @vindex org-global-properties
5371 Property values set with the global variable
5372 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
5376 The following commands help to work with properties:
5379 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
5380 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
5381 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
5382 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
5383 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
5384 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
5385 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer RET
5386 @cindex org-insert-drawer
5387 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
5388 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
5389 information like deadlines.
5390 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
5391 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
5392 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
5393 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
5394 can be inserted using completion.
5395 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
5396 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
5397 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
5398 Remove a property from the current entry.
5399 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
5400 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
5401 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
5402 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
5403 nearest column format definition.
5406 @node Special properties
5407 @section Special properties
5408 @cindex properties, special
5410 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
5411 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
5412 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in
5413 a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The
5414 following property names are special and should not be used as keys in the
5417 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
5418 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
5419 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
5420 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
5421 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
5422 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
5423 @cindex property, special, FILE
5424 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5425 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
5426 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
5427 @cindex property, special, TAGS
5428 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
5429 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
5430 @cindex property, special, TODO
5432 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5433 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings.}
5434 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5435 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5436 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5437 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5438 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5439 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5440 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5441 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5442 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5443 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5444 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5445 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5446 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5447 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5448 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5451 @node Property searches
5452 @section Property searches
5453 @cindex properties, searching
5454 @cindex searching, of properties
5456 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5457 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5460 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
5461 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5462 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5463 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5464 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5465 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5466 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5467 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5468 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5469 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see the option
5470 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5473 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5476 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5481 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5482 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5483 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5484 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5485 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5488 @node Property inheritance
5489 @section Property Inheritance
5490 @cindex properties, inheritance
5491 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5493 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5494 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5495 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5496 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5497 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5498 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5499 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5500 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5501 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5502 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5503 inherited properties. If a property has the value @code{nil}, this is
5504 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5505 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5507 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5508 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5510 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5513 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5514 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5515 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5516 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5517 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5519 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5520 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5521 applies to the entire subtree.
5523 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5524 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5525 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5527 @cindex property, LOGGING
5528 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5529 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5533 @section Column view
5535 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5536 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5537 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5538 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5539 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5540 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5541 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5542 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5543 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5544 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5545 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5546 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda views}) where
5547 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5550 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5551 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5552 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5555 @node Defining columns
5556 @subsection Defining columns
5557 @cindex column view, for properties
5558 @cindex properties, column view
5560 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5561 done by defining a column format line.
5564 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5565 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5568 @node Scope of column definitions
5569 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5571 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5575 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5578 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5579 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5582 ** Top node for columns view
5584 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5588 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5589 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5590 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5591 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5592 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5593 deeper part of the tree.
5595 @node Column attributes
5596 @subsubsection Column attributes
5597 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5598 definition looks like this:
5601 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5605 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5606 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5609 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5610 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5611 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5612 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5613 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5614 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5616 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5617 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children@footnote{If
5618 more than one summary type apply to the property, the parent
5619 values are computed according to the first of them.}.}
5620 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5621 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5622 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5623 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5624 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5625 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5626 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5627 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5628 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5629 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5630 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are
5631 hours@footnote{A time can also be a duration, using effort
5632 modifiers defined in @code{org-effort-durations}, e.g.,
5633 @samp{3d 1h}. If any value in the column is as such, the
5634 summary will also be an effort duration.}.}
5635 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5636 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5637 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5638 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age@footnote{An age is defined as
5639 a duration since a given time-stamp (@pxref{Timestamps}). It
5640 can also be expressed as days, hours, minutes and seconds,
5641 identified by @samp{d}, @samp{h}, @samp{m} and @samp{s}
5642 suffixes, all mandatory, e.g., @samp{0d 13h 0m 10s}.} (in
5643 days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5644 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5645 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5646 @{est+@} @r{Add @samp{low-high} estimates.}
5649 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5650 combining estimates, expressed as @samp{low-high} ranges or plain numbers.
5651 For example, instead of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you
5652 might estimate it as 5--6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much
5653 work is required, or 1--10 days if you don't really know what needs to be
5654 done. Both ranges average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more
5655 predictable delivery.
5657 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5658 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5659 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5660 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5661 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5662 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5663 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5664 full job more realistically, at 10--15 days.
5666 Numbers are right-aligned when a format specifier with an explicit width like
5667 @code{%5d} or @code{%5.1f} is used.
5669 @vindex org-columns-summary-types
5670 You can also define custom summary types by setting
5671 @code{org-columns-summary-types}, which see.
5673 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5677 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5678 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5679 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5680 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5681 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5685 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5686 item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the
5687 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5688 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5689 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5690 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5691 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5692 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5693 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5694 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5695 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5696 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5697 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5698 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5701 @node Using column view
5702 @subsection Using column view
5705 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5706 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5707 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5708 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5709 or the function called with the universal prefix argument, column view is
5710 turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS} definition. If the
5711 cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command searches the hierarchy,
5712 up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that defines a format. When
5713 one is found, the column view table is established for the tree starting at
5714 the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:} property. If no such property
5715 is found, the format is taken from the @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the
5716 variable @code{org-columns-default-format}, and column view is established
5717 for the current entry and its subtree.
5718 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5719 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5720 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5722 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5724 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5725 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5726 Move through the column view from field to field.
5727 @kindex S-@key{left}
5728 @kindex S-@key{right}
5729 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5730 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5731 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5733 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5734 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5735 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5736 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5737 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5738 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5739 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5740 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5741 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5742 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5743 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5744 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5745 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5746 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5747 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5748 in the hierarchy, the modified value is stored there. If no list is
5749 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5750 current column view.
5751 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5752 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5753 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5754 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5755 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5756 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5757 Delete the current column.
5760 @node Capturing column view
5761 @subsection Capturing column view
5763 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5764 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5765 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5766 of this block looks like this:
5768 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5771 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5776 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5780 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5781 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5782 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5783 capture, you can use 4 values:
5784 @cindex property, ID
5786 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5787 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5788 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5789 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5790 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5791 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5792 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy RET} to create a globally unique ID for}
5793 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5796 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5797 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5799 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5801 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5802 @item :skip-empty-rows
5803 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5804 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5806 When non-@code{nil}, indent each @code{ITEM} field according to its level.
5811 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5814 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5815 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5816 for the scope or ID of the view.
5817 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5818 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5819 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5820 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5821 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5822 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5826 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5827 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5828 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5829 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5831 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5832 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5833 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5834 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5835 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5836 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5837 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5840 @section The Property API
5841 @cindex properties, API
5842 @cindex API, for properties
5844 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5845 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5846 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5849 @node Dates and times
5850 @chapter Dates and times
5856 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5857 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5858 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5859 little confusing because timestamp is often used to indicate when
5860 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5861 is used in a much wider sense.
5864 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5865 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5866 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5867 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5868 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5869 * Timers:: Notes with a running timer
5874 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5876 @cindex ranges, time
5881 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5882 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5883 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5884 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5885 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5886 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5887 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5888 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5889 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5890 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5893 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5896 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just like
5897 writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the agenda
5898 display, the headline of an entry associated with a plain timestamp will be
5899 shown exactly on that date.
5902 * Meet Peter at the movies
5903 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5904 * Discussion on climate change
5905 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5908 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5909 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5910 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5911 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5912 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5913 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5916 * Pick up Sam at school
5917 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5920 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5921 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5922 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5923 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5924 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depends
5925 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5926 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5927 December 1, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5928 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5929 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5930 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5931 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5932 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5933 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5934 example with optional time
5937 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5938 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5941 @item Time/Date range
5944 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5945 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5946 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5949 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5950 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5953 @item Inactive timestamp
5954 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5955 @cindex inactive timestamp
5956 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5957 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5958 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5961 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5967 @node Creating timestamps
5968 @section Creating timestamps
5969 @cindex creating timestamps
5970 @cindex timestamps, creating
5972 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5973 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5977 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5978 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5979 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5980 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5981 succession, a time range is inserted.
5983 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5984 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5991 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5992 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5993 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5994 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5997 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5999 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
6000 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
6002 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
6003 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
6004 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
6007 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
6008 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
6009 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
6011 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
6012 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
6013 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
6015 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
6016 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
6017 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
6018 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
6019 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
6020 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
6021 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
6022 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
6023 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
6025 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6026 @cindex evaluate time range
6027 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
6028 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
6029 the following column).
6034 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
6035 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
6038 @node The date/time prompt
6039 @subsection The date/time prompt
6040 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
6041 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
6043 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
6044 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
6045 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
6046 format. But it will in fact accept date/time information in a variety of
6047 formats. Generally, the information should start at the beginning of the
6048 string. Org mode will find whatever information is in
6049 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
6050 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
6051 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
6052 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
6053 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
6054 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
6055 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
6056 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
6057 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
6058 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
6059 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
6061 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
6062 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
6066 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
6067 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
6068 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
6069 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
6070 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
6071 Fri @result{} nearest Friday after the default date
6072 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
6073 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
6074 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
6075 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
6076 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 00:34
6077 w4 @result{} ISO week four of the current year @b{2006}
6078 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
6079 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
6082 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the @emph{first}
6083 thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a letter ([hdwmy]) to
6084 indicate change in hours, days, weeks, months, or years. With a single plus
6085 or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a double plus or minus,
6086 it is relative to the default date. If instead of a single letter, you use
6087 the abbreviation of day name, the date will be the Nth such day, e.g.:
6092 +4d @result{} four days from today
6093 +4 @result{} same as above
6094 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
6095 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
6096 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now
6097 -wed @result{} last Wednesday
6100 @vindex parse-time-months
6101 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
6102 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
6103 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
6104 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
6106 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
6107 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
6108 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
6109 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
6110 read the docstring of the variable
6111 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
6113 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
6114 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
6115 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
6119 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
6120 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
6121 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
6124 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
6125 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
6126 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
6127 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
6128 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
6129 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
6130 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
6131 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
6132 from the minibuffer:
6139 @kindex S-@key{right}
6140 @kindex S-@key{left}
6141 @kindex S-@key{down}
6143 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
6144 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
6146 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
6147 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
6150 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
6151 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
6152 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
6153 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
6154 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
6155 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
6156 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
6157 M-S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one year.}
6160 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
6161 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
6162 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
6163 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
6164 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
6165 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display off with
6166 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
6168 @node Custom time format
6169 @subsection Custom time format
6170 @cindex custom date/time format
6171 @cindex time format, custom
6172 @cindex date format, custom
6174 @vindex org-display-custom-times
6175 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
6176 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
6177 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
6178 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
6179 customizing the options @code{org-display-custom-times} and
6180 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
6183 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
6184 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
6188 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
6189 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
6190 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
6191 following consequences:
6194 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
6197 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
6198 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
6199 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
6200 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
6201 time will be changed by one minute.
6203 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
6204 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
6206 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
6207 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
6208 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
6210 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
6211 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
6212 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
6216 @node Deadlines and scheduling
6217 @section Deadlines and scheduling
6219 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning. Both
6220 the timestamp and the keyword have to be positioned immediatly after the task
6225 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
6227 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
6228 to be finished on that date.
6230 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
6231 @vindex org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled
6232 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
6233 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
6234 approaching or missed deadline, starting
6235 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
6236 until the entry is marked DONE@. An example:
6239 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
6240 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
6241 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
6244 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
6245 deadline using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
6246 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}. This warning is
6247 deactivated if the task gets scheduled and you set
6248 @code{org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled} to @code{t}.
6251 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
6253 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
6256 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
6257 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
6258 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE@. If you don't like
6259 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
6260 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
6261 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.,
6262 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
6265 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
6266 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
6269 @vindex org-scheduled-delay-days
6270 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline
6271 If you want to @emph{delay} the display of this task in the agenda, use
6272 @code{SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat -2d>}: the task is still scheduled on the
6273 25th but will appear two days later. In case the task contains a repeater,
6274 the delay is considered to affect all occurrences; if you want the delay to
6275 only affect the first scheduled occurrence of the task, use @code{--2d}
6276 instead. See @code{org-scheduled-delay-days} and
6277 @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline} for details on how to
6278 control this globally or per agenda.
6281 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
6282 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
6283 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
6284 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
6285 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
6286 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
6287 want to start working on an action item.
6290 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
6291 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
6292 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
6293 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
6295 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
6297 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
6298 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
6299 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
6303 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
6304 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
6307 @node Inserting deadline/schedule
6308 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
6310 The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
6315 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
6316 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. Any CLOSED timestamp will
6317 be removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be
6318 removed from the entry. Depending on the variable
6319 @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
6320 keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
6321 @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
6324 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
6325 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. Any CLOSED timestamp
6326 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
6327 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
6328 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
6329 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
6330 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
6333 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
6334 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
6335 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
6336 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
6337 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
6338 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
6339 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
6340 all deadlines due tomorrow.
6342 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
6343 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
6345 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
6346 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
6349 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
6350 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set
6351 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
6352 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
6354 @node Repeated tasks
6355 @subsection Repeated tasks
6356 @cindex tasks, repeated
6357 @cindex repeated tasks
6359 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
6360 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
6361 or plain timestamp. In the following example
6363 ** TODO Pay the rent
6364 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
6367 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
6368 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
6369 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
6370 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
6371 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
6372 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
6374 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
6375 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
6376 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
6377 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
6378 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
6379 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
6380 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
6381 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
6382 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
6383 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
6384 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
6385 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
6386 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
6387 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
6388 switch the date like this:
6391 ** TODO Pay the rent
6392 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
6395 To mark a task with a repeater as @code{DONE}, use @kbd{C-- 1 C-c C-t}
6396 (i.e., @code{org-todo} with a numeric prefix argument of -1.)
6398 @vindex org-log-repeat
6399 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
6400 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
6401 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
6402 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
6403 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
6405 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
6406 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
6409 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
6410 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
6411 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
6412 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
6413 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
6414 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
6415 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
6416 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
6417 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
6421 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
6422 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
6423 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
6424 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
6425 and marked it done on Saturday.
6426 ** TODO Empty kitchen trash
6427 DEADLINE: <2008-02-08 Fri 20:00 ++1d>
6428 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one day, and
6429 also by as many days as it takes to get the timestamp into the
6430 future. Since there is a time in the timestamp, the next
6431 deadline in the future will be on today's date if you
6432 complete the task before 20:00.
6433 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
6434 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
6435 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
6439 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown
6440 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific task.
6441 If the repeater is set for the scheduling information only, you probably want
6442 the repeater to be ignored after the deadline. If so, set the variable
6443 @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown} to
6444 @code{repeated-after-deadline}. However, any scheduling information without
6445 a repeater is no longer relevant once the task is done, and thus, removed
6446 upon repeating the task. If you want both scheduling and deadline
6447 information to repeat after the same interval, set the same repeater for both
6450 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
6451 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
6452 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
6455 @node Clocking work time
6456 @section Clocking work time
6457 @cindex clocking time
6458 @cindex time clocking
6460 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
6461 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
6462 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
6463 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
6464 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
6465 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
6466 limitation of @code{lmax} in @code{org-clock-sum}.} of a project.
6467 And it remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, so that you can jump
6468 quickly between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
6470 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6472 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6473 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6475 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6476 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6477 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6478 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6482 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6483 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6484 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6487 @node Clocking commands
6488 @subsection Clocking commands
6491 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6492 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6493 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6494 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6495 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6496 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6497 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6498 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6499 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6500 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6501 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6502 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6503 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6504 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6505 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6506 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6507 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6508 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6509 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6510 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6511 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6512 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6513 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6514 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6515 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6516 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6517 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6518 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6519 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6520 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6521 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6522 show all time clocked on this task today (see also the variable
6523 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6524 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6525 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6526 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6528 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6529 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6530 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6531 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6532 the resulting time and inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6533 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6534 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6535 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6536 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6537 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6538 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6539 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6540 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6541 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6543 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6544 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6547 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6548 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6549 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6550 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6551 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6552 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6553 clock duration keeps the same.
6554 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6555 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6556 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6557 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6558 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6559 increased by five minutes.
6560 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6561 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6562 if it is running in this same item.
6563 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6564 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6565 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6566 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6567 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6568 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6569 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6570 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6571 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6572 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6573 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6574 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6575 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6579 The @kbd{l} key may be used the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show
6580 which tasks have been worked on or closed during a day.
6582 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6583 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global key binding and will not
6584 modify the window disposition.
6586 @node The clock table
6587 @subsection The clock table
6588 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6589 @cindex report, of clocked time
6591 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6592 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6593 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6596 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6597 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6598 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6599 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6600 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6601 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6602 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6603 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6604 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6605 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6606 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6607 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6608 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6609 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6610 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6611 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6612 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6616 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6617 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6619 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6621 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6625 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6626 The @samp{BEGIN} line specifies a number of options to define the scope,
6627 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6628 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6630 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6633 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6634 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6635 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6636 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6637 file @r{the full current buffer}
6638 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6639 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6640 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6641 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6642 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6643 function @r{the list of files returned by a function of no argument}
6644 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6645 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6646 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6647 @r{absolutely, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6649 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6650 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6651 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6652 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6653 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6654 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6655 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6656 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6657 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6659 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6660 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6661 @r{Relative times like @code{"<-2w>"} can also be used. See}
6662 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for relative time syntax.}
6663 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6664 @r{Relative times like @code{"<now>"} can also be used. See}
6665 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for relative time syntax.}
6666 :wstart @r{The starting day of the week. The default is 1 for monday.}
6667 :mstart @r{The starting day of the month. The default 1 is for the first}
6668 @r{day of the month.}
6669 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6670 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6671 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6672 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6673 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6674 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6677 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. These
6678 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6679 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6681 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6682 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6683 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6684 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6685 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6686 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6687 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6688 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6689 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6690 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6691 :sort @r{A cons cell like containing the column to sort and a sorting type.}
6692 @r{E.g., @code{:sort (1 . ?a)} sorts the first column alphabetically.}
6693 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6694 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6695 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6696 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6697 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6698 @r{property will get its own column.}
6699 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6700 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6701 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6702 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6703 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6704 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6706 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6707 day, you could write
6709 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6713 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6714 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6715 only to fit it into the manual.}
6717 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6718 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6721 A range starting a week ago and ending right now could be written as
6723 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<-1w>" :tend "<now>"
6726 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6728 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6731 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6734 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6738 @node Resolving idle time
6739 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6741 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6742 @cindex resolve idle time
6743 @vindex org-clock-x11idle-program-name
6745 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6746 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6747 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6748 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6749 applying it to another one.
6751 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6752 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6753 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6754 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6755 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6756 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6757 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, or install the
6758 @file{xprintidle} package and set it to the variable
6759 @code{org-clock-x11idle-program-name} if you are running Debian, to get the
6760 same general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to
6761 Emacs idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time.
6762 There will be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how
6763 much idle time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as
6764 well as a set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6768 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6769 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6770 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6772 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6773 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6774 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6776 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6777 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6779 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6780 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6781 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6783 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6784 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6785 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6786 log with an empty entry.
6789 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6790 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6791 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6792 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6793 the next task you clock in on.
6795 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6796 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6797 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6798 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6799 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6801 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6802 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6803 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6804 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6805 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6806 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6808 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6809 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6811 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6812 @cindex continuous clocking
6813 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6815 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6816 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6817 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6818 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6820 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6821 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6823 @node Effort estimates
6824 @section Effort estimates
6825 @cindex effort estimates
6827 @cindex property, Effort
6828 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6829 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6830 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6831 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time,
6832 a great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in
6833 a special property @code{EFFORT}. You can set the effort for an entry with
6834 the following commands:
6837 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6838 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6839 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6840 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6841 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6842 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6845 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6846 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6847 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6848 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6852 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6853 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6857 @vindex org-global-properties
6858 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6859 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6860 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6861 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6862 setup may be advised.
6864 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6865 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6866 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6867 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6869 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6870 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6871 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6872 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6873 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6874 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6875 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6876 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6877 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6879 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6880 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6881 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6882 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6885 @section Taking notes with a timer
6886 @cindex relative timer
6887 @cindex countdown timer
6890 Org provides two types of timers. There is a relative timer that counts up,
6891 which can be useful when taking notes during, for example, a meeting or
6892 a video viewing. There is also a countdown timer.
6894 The relative and countdown are started with separate commands.
6897 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6898 Start or reset the relative timer. By default, the timer is set to 0. When
6899 called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, prompt the user for a starting offset. If
6900 there is a timer string at point, this is taken as the default, providing a
6901 convenient way to restart taking notes after a break in the process. When
6902 called with a double prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings
6903 in the active region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer
6904 strings if the timer was not started at exactly the right moment.
6905 @orgcmd{C-c C-x ;,org-timer-set-timer}
6906 Start a countdown timer. The user is prompted for a duration.
6907 @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the default countdown value. Giving
6908 a numeric prefix argument overrides this default value. This command is
6909 available as @kbd{;} in agenda buffers.
6912 Once started, relative and countdown timers are controlled with the same
6916 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6917 Insert the value of the current relative or countdown timer into the buffer.
6918 If no timer is running, the relative timer will be started. When called with
6919 a prefix argument, the relative timer is restarted.
6920 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6921 Insert a description list item with the value of the current relative or
6922 countdown timer. With a prefix argument, first reset the relative timer to
6924 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6925 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6927 @orgcmd{C-c C-x @comma{},org-timer-pause-or-continue}
6928 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused.
6929 @orgcmd{C-c C-x _,org-timer-stop}
6930 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6931 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6934 @node Capture - Refile - Archive
6935 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6938 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6939 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6940 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6941 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6942 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6943 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6946 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6947 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6948 * RSS feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6949 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6950 * Refile and copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another
6951 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6958 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6959 flow. Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John
6960 Wiegley excellent @file{remember.el} package. Up to version 6.36, Org
6961 used a special setup for @file{remember.el}, then replaced it with
6962 @file{org-remember.el}. As of version 8.0, @file{org-remember.el} has
6963 been completely replaced by @file{org-capture.el}.
6965 If your configuration depends on @file{org-remember.el}, you need to update
6966 it and use the setup described below. To convert your
6967 @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6969 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates RET}
6971 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6972 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6976 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6977 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6978 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6981 @node Setting up capture
6982 @subsection Setting up capture
6984 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6985 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6986 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6988 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6991 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6992 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6997 @subsection Using capture
7000 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
7001 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this key binding is global and
7002 not active by default: you need to install it. If you have templates
7004 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
7005 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
7006 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
7007 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
7009 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
7010 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
7011 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
7012 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
7013 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
7015 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
7016 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refile and copy}) the note to
7017 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
7018 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
7019 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
7020 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
7021 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
7023 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
7024 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
7028 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
7029 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
7030 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
7031 rather than to the current date.
7033 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
7038 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
7039 template in the usual way.
7040 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
7041 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
7044 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
7045 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
7046 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
7047 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
7050 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
7051 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
7053 @node Capture templates
7054 @subsection Capture templates
7055 @cindex templates, for Capture
7057 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
7058 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
7059 through the customize interface.
7063 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
7066 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
7067 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
7068 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
7069 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
7070 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
7075 (setq org-capture-templates
7076 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
7077 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
7078 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+olp+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
7079 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
7083 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
7087 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
7091 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
7092 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
7093 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
7094 the task definition, press @kbd{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
7095 place where you started the capture process.
7097 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
7098 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
7102 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
7103 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
7107 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
7108 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
7109 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
7112 @node Template elements
7113 @subsubsection Template elements
7115 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
7116 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
7120 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
7121 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
7122 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
7123 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
7124 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
7125 prefix key, for example
7127 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
7129 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
7130 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
7133 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
7137 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
7141 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
7142 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
7144 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
7145 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
7147 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
7150 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
7151 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
7152 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
7154 Text to be inserted as it is.
7158 @vindex org-default-notes-file
7159 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
7160 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
7161 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
7162 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
7163 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
7164 also be given as a variable or as a function called with no argument. When
7165 an absolute path is not specified for a target, it is taken as relative to
7166 @code{org-directory}.
7171 @item (file "path/to/file")
7172 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
7174 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
7175 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
7177 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
7178 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
7180 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
7181 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
7183 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
7184 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
7186 @item (file+olp+datetree "path/to/file" [ "Level 1 heading" ....])
7187 This target@footnote{Org used to offer four different targets for date/week
7188 tree capture. Now, Org automatically translates these to use
7189 @code{file+olp+datetree}, applying the @code{:time-prompt} and
7190 @code{:tree-type} properties. Please rewrite your date/week-tree targets
7191 using @code{file+olp+datetree} since the older targets are now deprecated.}
7192 will create a heading in a date tree@footnote{A date tree is an outline
7193 structure with years on the highest level, months or ISO-weeks as sublevels
7194 and then dates on the lowest level. Tags are allowed in the tree structure.}
7195 for today's date. If the optional outline path is given, the tree will be
7196 built under the node it is pointing to, instead of at top level. Check out
7197 the @code{:time-prompt} and @code{:tree-type} properties below for additional
7200 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
7201 A function to find the right location in the file.
7204 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
7206 @item (function function-finding-location)
7207 Most general way: write your own function which both visits
7208 the file and moves point to the right location.
7212 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
7213 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
7214 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
7215 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
7216 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
7220 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
7221 Recognized properties are:
7225 Normally new captured information will be appended at
7226 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
7227 Setting this property will change that.
7229 @item :immediate-finish
7230 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
7231 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
7232 information that can be added automatically.
7235 Set this to the number of lines to insert
7236 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
7239 Start the clock in this item.
7242 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
7245 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
7246 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
7247 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
7248 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
7251 Prompt for a date/time to be used for date/week trees and when filling the
7252 template. Without this property, capture uses the current date and time.
7253 Even if this property has not been set, you can force the same behavior by
7254 calling @code{org-capture} with a @kbd{C-1} prefix argument.
7257 When `week', make a week tree instead of the month tree, i.e. place the
7258 headings for each day under a heading with the current iso week.
7261 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
7262 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
7264 @item :table-line-pos
7265 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
7266 inserted. It can be a string, a variable holding a string or a function
7267 returning a string. The string should look like @code{"II-3"} meaning that
7268 the new line should become the third line before the second horizontal
7272 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
7273 buffer again after capture is completed.
7277 @node Template expansion
7278 @subsubsection Template expansion
7280 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
7281 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
7282 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
7285 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
7286 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
7287 @r{For convenience, %:keyword (see below) placeholders}
7288 @r{within the expression will be expanded prior to this.}
7289 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
7290 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
7291 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
7292 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
7293 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
7294 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
7295 @r{region is active.}
7296 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
7297 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
7298 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
7299 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
7300 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
7301 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
7302 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
7303 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
7304 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
7305 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
7306 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
7307 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
7308 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
7309 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
7310 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
7311 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
7312 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
7313 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
7314 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
7315 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
7316 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
7317 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
7318 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
7319 %\1 @dots{} %\N @r{Insert the text entered at the Nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{N} is}
7320 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
7321 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
7325 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
7326 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
7327 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
7328 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
7331 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
7333 Link type | Available keywords
7334 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
7335 bbdb | %:name %:company
7336 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
7337 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail, | %:type %:subject %:message-id
7338 gnus, notmuch | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
7339 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
7340 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
7341 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
7342 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
7343 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
7344 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
7345 eww, w3, w3m | %:url
7346 info | %:file %:node
7351 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
7354 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
7357 @node Templates in contexts
7358 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
7360 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
7361 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
7362 context, you can customize @code{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
7363 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
7364 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
7367 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
7368 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
7371 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
7372 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
7375 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
7376 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
7379 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
7382 @section Attachments
7385 @vindex org-attach-directory
7386 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
7387 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
7388 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
7389 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
7390 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
7391 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
7392 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
7393 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
7394 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
7395 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
7396 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
7397 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
7398 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
7400 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
7401 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
7402 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
7405 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
7408 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
7409 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
7410 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
7411 to select a command:
7414 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
7415 @vindex org-attach-method
7416 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
7417 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
7418 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
7424 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
7425 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
7427 @orgcmdtkc{u,C-c C-a u,org-attach-url}
7428 Attach a file from URL
7430 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
7431 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
7433 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
7434 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
7435 attachments yourself.
7437 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
7438 @vindex org-file-apps
7439 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
7440 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
7441 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
7442 (@pxref{Handling links}).
7444 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
7445 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
7447 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
7448 Open the current task's attachment directory.
7450 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
7451 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
7453 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
7454 Select and delete a single attachment.
7456 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
7457 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
7458 @command{dired} and delete from there.
7460 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
7461 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
7462 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
7463 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
7465 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
7466 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
7467 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
7468 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
7477 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
7478 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
7479 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
7480 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
7481 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
7482 information. Here is just an example:
7486 (setq org-feed-alist
7488 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
7489 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
7494 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
7495 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
7496 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
7497 the following command is used:
7500 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
7502 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
7504 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
7505 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
7508 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
7509 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
7510 adding the same item several times.
7512 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7513 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7516 @section Protocols for external access
7517 @cindex protocols, for external access
7520 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7521 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7522 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7523 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7524 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7525 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7526 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7527 documentation and setup instructions.
7529 @node Refile and copy
7530 @section Refile and copy
7531 @cindex refiling notes
7532 @cindex copying notes
7534 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile or to copy some of
7535 the entries into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting,
7536 finding the right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To
7537 simplify this process, you can use the following special command:
7540 @orgcmd{C-c M-w,org-copy}
7542 Copying works like refiling, except that the original note is not deleted.
7543 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7545 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7546 @vindex org-refile-targets
7547 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7548 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7549 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7550 @vindex org-log-refile
7551 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7552 @vindex org-refile-keep
7553 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7554 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7555 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7556 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7558 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7559 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7560 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7561 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7562 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7563 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7564 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7565 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7566 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7567 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7568 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7569 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7570 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7571 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7572 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7573 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7575 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7577 Refile and keep the entry in place. Also see @code{org-refile-keep} to make
7578 this the default behavior, and beware that this may result in duplicated
7579 @code{ID} properties.
7580 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7581 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7582 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7583 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7590 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7591 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7592 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7593 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7596 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7597 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7598 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7599 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7603 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7604 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7607 @node Moving subtrees
7608 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7609 @cindex external archiving
7611 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7615 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7616 @vindex org-archive-location
7617 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7618 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7619 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7620 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7621 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7622 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7623 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7624 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7625 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7626 As above, but check subtree for timestamps instead of TODO entries. The
7627 command will offer to archive the subtree if it @emph{does} contain a
7628 timestamp, and that timestamp is in the past.
7631 @cindex archive locations
7632 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7633 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7634 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7635 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7636 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7637 see the documentation string of the variable
7638 @code{org-archive-location}.
7640 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for example:
7644 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7647 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7649 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7650 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7651 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and columns}).
7653 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7654 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7655 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7656 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7657 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7661 @node Internal archiving
7662 @subsection Internal archiving
7665 If you want to just switch off---for agenda views---certain subtrees without
7666 moving them to a different file, you can use the archive tag.
7668 A headline that is marked with the @samp{:ARCHIVE:} tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays
7669 at its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7672 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7673 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7674 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7675 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7676 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7677 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7679 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7680 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7681 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7682 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7684 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7685 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda views}), the content of
7686 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7687 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7688 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7689 temporarily included.
7691 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7692 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7693 is. Configure the details using the variable
7694 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7696 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7697 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7698 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7701 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7704 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7705 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7706 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7708 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7709 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7710 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7711 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7712 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7713 level 1 trees will be checked.
7714 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7715 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7716 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7717 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7718 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7719 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7720 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7726 @chapter Agenda views
7727 @cindex agenda views
7729 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7730 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7731 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7732 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7733 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7735 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7736 in a separate buffer. Six different view types are provided:
7740 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7743 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7746 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7747 TODO state associated with them,
7749 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7750 that contain specified keywords,
7752 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7755 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7760 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7761 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7762 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7763 edit these files remotely.
7765 @vindex org-agenda-skip-comment-trees
7766 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7767 @cindex commented entries, in agenda views
7768 @cindex archived entries, in agenda views
7769 By default, the report ignores commented (@pxref{Comment lines}) and archived
7770 (@pxref{Internal archiving}) entries. You can override this by setting
7771 @code{org-agenda-skip-comment-trees} and
7772 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees} to @code{nil}.
7774 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7775 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7776 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7777 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7778 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7779 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7782 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7783 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7784 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7785 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7786 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7787 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7788 * Exporting agenda views:: Writing a view to a file
7789 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7793 @section Agenda files
7794 @cindex agenda files
7795 @cindex files for agenda
7797 @vindex org-agenda-files
7798 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7799 files}, the files listed in the variable
7800 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7801 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7802 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7803 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7806 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7807 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7808 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7809 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7810 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7811 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7813 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7815 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7816 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7817 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7818 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7819 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7820 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7822 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7823 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7825 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7826 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7827 @item M-x org-iswitchb RET
7828 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7833 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7834 to visit any of them.
7836 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7837 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7838 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7839 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7840 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7841 extended period, use the following commands:
7844 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7845 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7846 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7847 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7848 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7849 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7850 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7851 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7852 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7856 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7860 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7861 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7862 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7863 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7865 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7866 Lift the restriction.
7869 @node Agenda dispatcher
7870 @section The agenda dispatcher
7871 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7872 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7873 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7874 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7875 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7876 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7877 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7878 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7882 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7884 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7886 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7887 tags and properties}).
7889 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7890 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7892 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7893 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7894 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7895 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7896 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7899 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7901 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7902 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7903 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7904 selecting the command.
7906 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7907 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7908 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7909 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7910 character selecting the command.
7913 @cindex agenda, sticky
7914 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7915 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7916 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7917 is always up to date. If you often switch between agenda views and the build
7918 time bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers or make this the
7919 default by customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}. With sticky
7920 agendas, the agenda dispatcher will not recreate agenda views from scratch,
7921 it will only switch to the selected one, and you need to update the agenda by
7922 hand with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} when needed. You can toggle sticky agenda view
7923 any time with @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7926 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7927 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7928 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7929 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7930 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7932 @node Built-in agenda views
7933 @section The built-in agenda views
7935 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7938 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7939 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7940 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7941 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7942 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7945 @node Weekly/daily agenda
7946 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7948 @cindex weekly agenda
7949 @cindex daily agenda
7951 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7952 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7955 @cindex org-agenda, command
7956 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7957 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7958 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7959 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7960 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7961 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7962 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7965 @vindex org-agenda-span
7966 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7967 @vindex org-agenda-start-day
7968 @vindex org-agenda-start-on-weekday
7969 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7970 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7971 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7972 agenda, or to a span name, such as @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7973 @code{year}. For weekly agendas, the default is to start on the previous
7974 monday (see @code{org-agenda-start-on-weekday}). You can also set the start
7975 date using a date shift: @code{(setq org-agenda-start-day "+10d")} will
7976 start the agenda ten days from today in the future.
7978 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7979 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7980 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7983 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7984 @cindex calendar integration
7985 @cindex diary integration
7987 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7988 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7989 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7990 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7991 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7992 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7995 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7996 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7999 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
8002 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
8003 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
8004 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
8005 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
8006 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
8007 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
8008 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
8009 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
8010 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
8011 between calendar and agenda.
8013 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
8014 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
8015 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
8016 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
8017 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
8018 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
8019 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
8020 will be made in the agenda:
8027 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
8033 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
8034 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
8037 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
8038 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
8039 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
8041 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
8042 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
8043 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
8044 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
8045 following to one of your agenda files:
8052 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
8055 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
8056 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
8057 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
8058 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
8059 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
8060 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
8061 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
8067 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
8070 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
8071 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
8072 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
8073 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
8074 in an Org or Diary file.
8076 If you would like to see upcoming anniversaries with a bit of forewarning,
8077 you can use the following instead:
8084 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries-future 3)
8087 That will give you three days' warning: on the anniversary date itself and the
8088 two days prior. The argument is optional: if omitted, it defaults to 7.
8090 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
8091 @cindex @file{appt.el}
8092 @cindex appointment reminders
8096 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
8097 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
8098 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
8099 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
8100 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
8101 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
8102 docstring for details.
8104 @node Global TODO list
8105 @subsection The global TODO list
8106 @cindex global TODO list
8107 @cindex TODO list, global
8109 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
8110 collected into a single place.
8113 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
8114 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
8115 files (@pxref{Agenda views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
8116 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
8117 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
8118 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
8119 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
8120 @cindex TODO keyword matching
8121 @vindex org-todo-keywords
8122 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
8123 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
8124 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
8125 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
8126 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
8128 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
8129 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
8130 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
8131 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
8132 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
8133 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
8136 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
8137 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
8138 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
8140 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
8141 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
8142 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
8146 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
8147 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
8148 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
8149 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
8150 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
8151 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
8152 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
8153 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
8154 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
8155 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
8158 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
8159 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
8160 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
8161 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
8162 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
8165 @node Matching tags and properties
8166 @subsection Matching tags and properties
8167 @cindex matching, of tags
8168 @cindex matching, of properties
8172 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
8173 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and columns}), you can select headlines
8174 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
8175 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
8179 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
8180 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
8181 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
8182 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
8183 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
8184 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
8185 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
8186 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
8187 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
8188 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
8189 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
8190 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
8191 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
8192 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
8196 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
8199 @subsubheading Match syntax
8201 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
8202 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for @code{AND} and
8203 @samp{|} for @code{OR}@. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}.
8204 Parentheses are not implemented. Each element in the search is either a
8205 tag, a regular expression matching tags, or an expression like
8206 @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a
8207 property value. Each element may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select
8208 against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic sugar for positive selection. The
8209 @code{AND} operator @samp{&} is optional when @samp{+} or @samp{-} is
8210 present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
8214 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}.
8216 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:} and @samp{:boss:}.
8218 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
8221 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
8222 @item work|laptop+night
8223 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
8227 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
8228 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
8229 braces. For example,
8230 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
8231 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
8233 @cindex group tags, as regular expressions
8234 Group tags (@pxref{Tag hierarchy}) are expanded as regular expressions. E.g.,
8235 if @samp{:work:} is a group tag for the group @samp{:work:lab:conf:}, then
8236 searching for @samp{work} will search for @samp{@{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)@}}
8237 and searching for @samp{-work} will search for all headlines but those with
8238 one of the tags in the group (i.e., @samp{-@{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)@}}).
8240 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
8241 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
8242 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
8243 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
8244 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and columns}) at the same
8245 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
8246 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
8247 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
8248 entry and the ``property'' @code{PRIORITY} represents the PRIORITY keyword of
8251 In addition to the properties mentioned above, @code{LEVEL} represents the
8252 level of an entry. So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all
8253 level three headlines that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked
8254 with the TODO keyword DONE@. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set,
8255 @samp{LEVEL} does not count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will
8256 correspond to 3 stars etc.
8258 Here are more examples:
8261 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
8262 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
8263 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
8264 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
8265 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
8268 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
8269 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
8272 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
8273 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
8277 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
8280 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
8281 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
8282 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
8284 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
8285 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
8287 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
8288 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
8289 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
8290 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
8291 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
8292 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 00:00 hours, i.e., without a time
8293 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
8294 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
8295 respectively, can be used.
8297 If the comparison value is enclosed
8298 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
8299 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
8303 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
8304 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
8305 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
8306 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
8307 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
8308 on or after October 11, 2008.
8310 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
8311 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
8312 inheritance}, for details.
8314 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
8315 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
8316 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
8317 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
8318 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
8319 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
8320 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND@.
8321 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
8322 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
8323 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
8324 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
8325 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
8329 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
8330 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
8331 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
8333 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
8334 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
8339 @subsection Search view
8342 @cindex searching, for text
8344 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
8345 It is particularly useful to find notes.
8348 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
8349 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
8350 or specific words using a boolean logic.
8352 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
8353 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
8354 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
8355 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
8356 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
8357 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
8358 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
8359 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
8360 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
8361 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
8362 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
8364 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
8365 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
8366 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
8368 @node Stuck projects
8369 @subsection Stuck projects
8370 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
8372 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
8373 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
8374 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
8375 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
8376 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
8377 projects and define next actions for them.
8380 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
8381 List projects that are stuck.
8384 @vindex org-stuck-projects
8385 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
8386 project is and how to find it.
8389 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
8390 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
8391 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
8392 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
8394 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
8395 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
8396 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
8397 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
8398 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
8399 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
8400 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
8401 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
8402 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
8403 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
8404 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
8405 correct customization for this is
8408 (setq org-stuck-projects
8409 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
8413 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
8414 will still be searched for stuck projects.
8416 @node Presentation and sorting
8417 @section Presentation and sorting
8418 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
8420 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
8421 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
8422 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
8423 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
8424 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
8425 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
8426 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
8427 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
8428 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
8429 associated with the item.
8432 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
8433 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
8434 * Sorting agenda items:: The order of things
8435 * Filtering/limiting agenda items:: Dynamically narrow the agenda
8439 @subsection Categories
8443 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default, the
8444 category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also specify it
8445 with a special line in the buffer, like this:
8452 @cindex property, CATEGORY
8453 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
8454 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
8455 special category you want to apply as the value.
8458 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
8459 longer than 10 characters.
8462 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
8463 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
8465 @node Time-of-day specifications
8466 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
8467 @cindex time-of-day specification
8469 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
8470 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
8471 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
8472 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
8474 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
8476 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
8477 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
8478 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
8479 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
8481 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
8482 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
8483 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
8486 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
8487 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
8488 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
8489 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
8493 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
8494 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
8497 8:00...... ------------------
8498 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
8499 10:00...... ------------------
8500 12:00...... ------------------
8501 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
8502 14:00...... ------------------
8503 16:00...... ------------------
8504 18:00...... ------------------
8505 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
8506 20:00...... ------------------
8507 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
8510 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8511 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8512 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
8513 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
8514 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8516 @node Sorting agenda items
8517 @subsection Sorting agenda items
8518 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
8519 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
8520 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
8521 done depends on the type of view.
8524 @vindex org-agenda-files
8525 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
8526 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
8527 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
8528 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
8529 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
8530 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8531 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8532 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8533 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8535 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8536 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8537 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8538 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8541 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8542 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8545 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8546 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8547 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8548 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8550 @node Filtering/limiting agenda items
8551 @subsection Filtering/limiting agenda items
8553 Agenda built-in or customized commands are statically defined. Agenda
8554 filters and limits provide two ways of dynamically narrowing down the list of
8555 agenda entries: @emph{filters} and @emph{limits}. Filters only act on the
8556 display of the items, while limits take effect before the list of agenda
8557 entries is built. Filters are more often used interactively, while limits are
8558 mostly useful when defined as local variables within custom agenda commands.
8560 @subsubheading Filtering in the agenda
8561 @cindex filtering, by tag, category, top headline and effort, in agenda
8562 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8563 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8564 @cindex top headline filtering, in agenda
8565 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8566 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8569 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8570 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8571 Filter the agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates. The
8572 difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is very
8573 fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without having
8574 to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8575 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8576 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8577 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8578 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8579 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8581 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag
8582 at all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to
8583 select a tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character).
8584 The command then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag.
8585 When called with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag.
8586 A second @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden
8587 entries. Pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} switches between filtering and
8588 excluding the next tag.
8590 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8591 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8592 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8593 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8594 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8595 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8596 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8597 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8598 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8602 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8604 ((string= tag "Net")
8605 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8606 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8607 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8608 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8609 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8612 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8623 @item @r{in} search view
8624 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8625 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8626 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8627 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8628 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8632 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8633 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8635 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8636 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. When called
8637 with a prefix argument exclude the category of the item at point from the
8640 You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the option
8641 @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}. @xref{Setting options}.
8643 @orgcmd{^,org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline}
8644 Filter the current agenda view and only display the siblings and the parent
8645 headline of the one at point.
8647 @orgcmd{=,org-agenda-filter-by-regexp}
8648 @vindex org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset
8650 Filter the agenda view by a regular expression: only show agenda entries
8651 matching the regular expression the user entered. When called with a prefix
8652 argument, it will filter @emph{out} entries matching the regexp. With two
8653 universal prefix arguments, it will remove all the regexp filters, which can
8656 You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the option
8657 @code{org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset}. @xref{Setting options}.
8659 @orgcmd{_,org-agenda-filter-by-effort}
8660 @vindex org-agenda-effort-filter-preset
8661 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8662 Filter the agenda view with respect to effort estimates.
8663 You first need to set up allowed efforts globally, for example
8665 (setq org-global-properties
8666 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8668 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8669 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8670 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8671 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8672 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. For application of the operator,
8673 entries without a defined effort will be treated according to the value of
8674 @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}.
8676 When called with a prefix argument, it will remove entries matching the
8677 condition. With two universal prefix arguments, it will clear effort
8678 filters, which can be accumulated.
8680 You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the option
8681 @code{org-agenda-effort-filter-preset}. @xref{Setting options}.
8683 @orgcmd{|,org-agenda-filter-remove-all}
8684 Remove all filters in the current agenda view.
8687 @subsubheading Setting limits for the agenda
8688 @cindex limits, in agenda
8689 @vindex org-agenda-max-entries
8690 @vindex org-agenda-max-effort
8691 @vindex org-agenda-max-todos
8692 @vindex org-agenda-max-tags
8694 Here is a list of options that you can set, either globally, or locally in
8695 your custom agenda views (@pxref{Custom agenda views}).
8698 @item org-agenda-max-entries
8699 Limit the number of entries.
8700 @item org-agenda-max-effort
8701 Limit the duration of accumulated efforts (as minutes).
8702 @item org-agenda-max-todos
8703 Limit the number of entries with TODO keywords.
8704 @item org-agenda-max-tags
8705 Limit the number of tagged entries.
8708 When set to a positive integer, each option will exclude entries from other
8709 categories: for example, @code{(setq org-agenda-max-effort 100)} will limit
8710 the agenda to 100 minutes of effort and exclude any entry that has no effort
8711 property. If you want to include entries with no effort property, use a
8712 negative value for @code{org-agenda-max-effort}.
8714 One useful setup is to use @code{org-agenda-max-entries} locally in a custom
8715 command. For example, this custom command will display the next five entries
8716 with a @code{NEXT} TODO keyword.
8719 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8721 ((org-agenda-max-entries 5)))))
8724 Once you mark one of these five entry as @code{DONE}, rebuilding the agenda
8725 will again the next five entries again, including the first entry that was
8728 You can also dynamically set temporary limits, which will be lost when
8729 rebuilding the agenda:
8732 @orgcmd{~,org-agenda-limit-interactively}
8733 This prompts for the type of limit to apply and its value.
8736 @node Agenda commands
8737 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8738 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8740 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8741 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8742 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8743 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8744 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8745 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8747 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8748 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8751 @tsubheading{Motion}
8752 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8753 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8754 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8755 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8756 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8757 @orgcmd{N,org-agenda-next-item}
8758 Next item: same as next line, but only consider items.
8759 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-previous-item}
8760 Previous item: same as previous line, but only consider items.
8761 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8762 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8763 Display the original location of the item in another window. With prefix
8764 arg, make sure that drawers stay folded.
8766 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8767 Display original location and recenter that window.
8769 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8770 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8772 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8773 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8775 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8776 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8777 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8778 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8779 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8780 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8781 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8783 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8784 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8785 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8786 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8787 previously used indirect buffer.
8789 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8790 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8791 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8792 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8794 @tsubheading{Change display}
8795 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8798 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8802 Delete other windows.
8804 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8805 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8806 @xorgcmd{v t,org-agenda-fortnight-view}
8807 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8808 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8809 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8810 @vindex org-agenda-span
8811 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8812 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8813 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8814 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8815 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8816 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8817 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8818 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8819 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8820 1938--2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8821 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8823 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8824 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8825 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8826 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8828 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8829 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8831 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8834 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8835 Prompt for a date and go there.
8837 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8838 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8840 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8841 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8843 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8845 @vindex org-log-done
8846 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8847 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8848 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8849 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8850 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8851 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8852 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8853 prefix arguments @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8854 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8856 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8857 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8860 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8861 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8862 @cindex Archives mode
8863 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8864 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8865 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8866 press @kbd{v a} again.
8868 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8869 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8870 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8871 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8872 always show a table with the clocked times for the time span and file scope
8873 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8874 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8875 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8876 when toggling this mode (i.e., @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8877 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8878 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8879 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8882 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8883 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8884 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8885 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8886 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8887 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8890 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8891 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8892 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8893 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8894 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8895 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8896 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8897 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8899 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8900 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8901 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8902 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8903 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8905 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8906 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8907 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8908 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8909 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8911 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8914 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8915 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8918 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8919 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8920 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8921 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8922 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8923 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8924 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8925 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8927 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8928 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8929 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8931 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8933 For a detailed description of these commands, @pxref{Filtering/limiting
8936 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8937 Filter the agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8939 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8940 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8943 @orgcmd{^,org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline}
8944 Filter the current agenda view and only display the siblings and the parent
8945 headline of the one at point.
8947 @orgcmd{=,org-agenda-filter-by-regexp}
8948 Filter the agenda view by a regular expression.
8950 @orgcmd{_,org-agenda-filter-by-effort}
8951 Filter the agenda view with respect to effort estimates.
8953 @orgcmd{|,org-agenda-filter-remove-all}
8954 Remove all filters in the current agenda view.
8956 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8957 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8962 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8963 @cindex remote editing, undo
8964 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8965 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8966 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8968 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8969 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8972 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8973 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8974 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8976 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8977 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8978 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8979 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8980 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8981 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8983 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8984 Refile the entry at point.
8986 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8987 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8988 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8989 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8990 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8992 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8993 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8995 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8996 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8999 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
9000 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
9001 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
9004 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
9005 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
9006 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
9007 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
9008 tags of a headline occasionally.
9010 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
9011 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
9012 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
9016 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
9017 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
9018 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
9020 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
9021 Display weighted priority of current item.
9023 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
9024 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
9025 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
9028 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
9029 Decrease the priority of the current item.
9031 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
9032 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
9033 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
9034 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
9035 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
9037 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
9038 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
9040 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
9041 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
9043 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
9044 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
9046 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
9047 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
9048 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
9050 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
9051 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
9052 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
9053 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
9054 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
9055 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
9056 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
9058 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
9059 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
9062 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
9063 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
9064 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
9066 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
9067 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
9070 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
9071 Stop the previously started clock.
9073 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
9074 Cancel the currently running clock.
9076 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
9077 Jump to the running clock in another window.
9079 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-capture}
9080 Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for
9081 the capture template. See @code{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this
9082 the default behavior of @code{org-capture}.
9083 @cindex capturing, from agenda
9084 @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date
9086 @tsubheading{Dragging agenda lines forward/backward}
9087 @cindex dragging, agenda lines
9089 @orgcmd{M-<up>,org-agenda-drag-line-backward}
9090 Drag the line at point backward one line@footnote{Moving agenda lines does
9091 not persist after an agenda refresh and does not modify the contributing
9092 @file{.org} files}. With a numeric prefix argument, drag backward by that
9095 @orgcmd{M-<down>,org-agenda-drag-line-forward}
9096 Drag the line at point forward one line. With a numeric prefix argument,
9097 drag forward by that many lines.
9099 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
9100 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
9101 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
9103 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
9104 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With numeric prefix argument, mark
9105 that many successive entries.
9107 @orgcmd{*,org-agenda-bulk-mark-all}
9108 Mark all visible agenda entries for bulk action.
9110 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
9111 Unmark entry at point for bulk action.
9113 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
9114 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
9116 @orgcmd{M-m,org-agenda-bulk-toggle}
9117 Toggle mark of the entry at point for bulk action.
9119 @orgcmd{M-*,org-agenda-bulk-toggle-all}
9120 Toggle marks of all visible entries for bulk action.
9122 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
9123 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
9125 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
9126 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
9127 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
9128 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
9129 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
9130 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-persistent-marks} to @code{t}
9131 or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
9135 Toggle persistent marks.
9137 Archive all selected entries.
9139 Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.
9141 Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and changes the
9142 state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and suppressing logging
9143 notes (but not timestamps).
9145 Add a tag to all selected entries.
9147 Remove a tag from all selected entries.
9149 Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates by a
9150 fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus at the prompt,
9151 for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.
9153 Set deadline to a specific date.
9155 Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries will no
9156 longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.
9158 Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for. With
9159 prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.
9161 Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions
9162 through @code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries. For
9163 example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the entries to web.
9167 (defun set-category ()
9169 (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)
9170 (org-agenda-error)))
9171 (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))
9172 (with-current-buffer buffer
9177 (org-back-to-heading t)
9178 (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))
9183 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
9184 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
9186 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
9187 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
9189 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
9190 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
9193 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
9194 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
9195 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
9196 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
9197 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
9198 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
9199 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
9200 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
9201 you can add the entry.
9203 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
9204 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
9205 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
9206 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
9207 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
9208 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
9209 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
9210 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
9211 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
9212 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
9214 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
9215 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
9217 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
9218 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
9219 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
9221 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
9222 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
9225 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
9226 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
9228 @item M-x org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files RET
9229 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
9230 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
9232 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
9233 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
9234 @cindex exporting agenda views
9235 @cindex agenda views, exporting
9236 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
9237 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
9238 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (@file{.html} or @file{.htm}),
9239 Postscript (@file{.ps}), PDF (@file{.pdf}), Org (@file{.org}) and plain text
9240 (any other extension). When exporting to Org, only the body of original
9241 headlines are exported, not subtrees or inherited tags. When called with a
9242 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the
9243 variable @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for
9244 @file{ps-print} and for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
9246 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
9247 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
9248 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
9250 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
9251 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
9252 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
9253 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
9254 visit Org files will not be removed.
9258 @node Custom agenda views
9259 @section Custom agenda views
9260 @cindex custom agenda views
9261 @cindex agenda views, custom
9263 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
9264 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
9265 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
9266 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
9269 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
9270 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
9271 * Setting options:: Changing the rules
9274 @node Storing searches
9275 @subsection Storing searches
9277 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
9278 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
9279 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
9282 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
9283 @cindex agenda views, main example
9284 @cindex agenda, as an agenda views
9285 @cindex agenda*, as an agenda views
9286 @cindex tags, as an agenda view
9287 @cindex todo, as an agenda view
9293 Custom commands are configured in the variable
9294 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
9295 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
9296 Lisp in the Emacs init file. The following example contains all valid agenda
9301 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9304 ("w" todo "WAITING")
9305 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
9306 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
9307 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
9308 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
9309 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
9310 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
9311 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
9312 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
9313 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
9318 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
9319 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
9320 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
9321 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
9322 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
9323 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
9324 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
9325 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
9326 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
9331 as a global search for agenda entries planned@footnote{@emph{Planned} means
9332 here that these entries have some planning information attached to them, like
9333 a time-stamp, a scheduled or a deadline string. See
9334 @code{org-agenda-entry-types} on how to set what planning information will be
9335 taken into account.} this week/day.
9337 as a global search for agenda entries planned this week/day, but only those
9338 with an hour specification like @code{[h]h:mm}---think of them as appointments.
9340 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
9343 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
9344 results as a sparse tree
9346 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
9349 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
9350 headlines that are also TODO items
9352 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
9353 displaying the result as a sparse tree
9355 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
9356 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
9358 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
9359 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
9360 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
9363 Note that the @code{*-tree} agenda views need to be called from an
9364 Org buffer as they operate on the current buffer only.
9367 @subsection Block agenda
9368 @cindex block agenda
9369 @cindex agenda, with block views
9371 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
9372 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
9373 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
9374 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
9375 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
9376 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
9377 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
9381 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9382 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
9386 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
9394 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
9395 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
9396 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
9397 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
9398 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
9400 @node Setting options
9401 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
9402 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
9404 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
9405 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
9406 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
9407 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
9408 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
9409 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
9410 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
9414 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9415 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
9416 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
9417 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
9418 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
9419 ((org-show-context-detail 'minimal)))
9421 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
9422 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
9427 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
9428 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
9429 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
9430 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
9431 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
9432 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
9433 to only a single file.
9435 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
9436 For command sets creating a block agenda,
9437 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
9438 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
9439 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
9440 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
9441 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
9442 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
9443 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
9444 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
9445 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
9449 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9450 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
9454 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
9455 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
9456 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
9463 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
9464 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
9465 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
9466 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
9467 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
9470 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
9471 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
9472 context, you can customize @code{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
9473 say for example that you have an agenda command @code{"o"} displaying a view
9474 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
9478 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
9479 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
9482 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
9483 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
9486 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
9487 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
9490 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
9492 @node Exporting agenda views
9493 @section Exporting agenda views
9494 @cindex agenda views, exporting
9496 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
9497 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
9498 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
9499 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
9500 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
9501 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
9502 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
9505 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
9506 @cindex exporting agenda views
9507 @cindex agenda views, exporting
9508 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
9509 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
9510 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
9511 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
9512 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
9513 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
9514 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
9516 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
9517 @vindex htmlize-output-type
9518 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
9519 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
9521 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
9522 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
9523 (ps-landscape-mode t)
9524 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
9525 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
9529 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
9530 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
9531 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
9532 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
9533 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
9534 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
9535 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
9536 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
9537 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
9542 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9543 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
9544 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
9545 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
9550 ("~/views/home.html"))
9551 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
9556 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
9560 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
9561 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
9562 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
9563 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
9564 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
9565 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
9566 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
9567 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
9569 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
9570 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
9571 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
9575 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
9576 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
9580 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
9581 set options for the export commands. For example:
9584 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
9586 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
9587 (ps-landscape-mode t)
9588 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
9589 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
9590 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
9595 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
9596 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
9597 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
9598 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
9599 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
9600 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
9601 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
9602 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
9603 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
9606 From the command line you may also use
9608 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
9611 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
9612 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
9614 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
9615 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
9616 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
9617 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
9618 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
9622 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
9623 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
9626 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
9627 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
9631 @node Agenda column view
9632 @section Using column view in the agenda
9633 @cindex column view, in agenda
9634 @cindex agenda, column view
9636 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
9637 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
9638 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
9639 collected by certain criteria.
9642 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
9643 Turn on column view in the agenda.
9646 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
9647 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
9648 This causes the following issues:
9652 @vindex org-columns-default-format
9653 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
9654 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
9655 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
9656 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
9657 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format}
9658 is currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
9659 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
9660 does not have a specific format---defined in a property, or in its file---it
9661 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
9664 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
9665 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
9666 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
9667 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
9668 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
9669 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
9670 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
9671 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice}---for
9672 example as scheduled and as a deadline---and it may show two entries from the
9673 same hierarchy---for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}. In these
9674 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
9675 some values will count double.
9678 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
9679 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
9680 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
9681 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
9682 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
9683 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
9684 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
9688 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
9689 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
9690 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda, the
9691 clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets you
9692 compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
9693 spent ---via @code{CLOCKSUM}---and with the planned total effort for it.
9698 @chapter Markup for rich export
9700 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9701 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the back-end. Since
9702 export targets like HTML and @LaTeX{} allow much richer formatting, Org mode has
9703 rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section summarizes the
9704 markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9707 * Paragraphs:: The basic unit of text
9708 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9709 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9710 * Images and tables:: Images, tables and caption mechanism
9711 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9712 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9713 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9714 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9718 @section Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9719 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9721 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9722 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9724 To preserve the line breaks, indentation and blank lines in a region, but
9725 otherwise use normal formatting, you can use this construct, which can also
9726 be used to format poetry.
9728 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9729 @cindex verse blocks
9732 Great clouds overhead
9733 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9740 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9741 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9742 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9744 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9745 @cindex quote blocks
9748 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9749 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9753 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9754 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9755 @cindex center blocks
9758 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9763 @node Emphasis and monospace
9764 @section Emphasis and monospace
9766 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9767 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9768 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9769 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9770 @cindex code text, markup rules
9771 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9772 @vindex org-fontify-emphasized-text
9773 @vindex org-emphasis-regexp-components
9774 @vindex org-emphasis-alist
9775 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=verbatim=}
9776 and @code{~code~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9777 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9778 syntax, it is exported verbatim.
9780 To turn off fontification for marked up text, you can set
9781 @code{org-fontify-emphasized-text} to @code{nil}. To narrow down the list of
9782 available markup syntax, you can customize @code{org-emphasis-alist}. To fine
9783 tune what characters are allowed before and after the markup characters, you
9784 can tweak @code{org-emphasis-regexp-components}. Beware that changing one of
9785 the above variables will no take effect until you reload Org, for which you
9786 may need to restart Emacs.
9788 @node Horizontal rules
9789 @section Horizontal rules
9790 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9791 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9794 @node Images and tables
9795 @section Images and Tables
9797 @cindex tables, markup rules
9800 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9801 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9802 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9803 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9804 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9805 the object with @code{[[tab:basic-data]]} (@pxref{Internal links}):
9808 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9809 #+NAME: tab:basic-data
9814 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9816 #+CAPTION[Caption for list of tables]: Caption for table.
9819 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9820 Some back-ends allow you to directly include images into the exported
9821 document. Org does this, if a link to an image files does not have
9822 a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}. If you wish to
9823 define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal cross
9824 references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede it
9825 with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+NAME} as follows:
9828 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9829 #+NAME: fig:SED-HR4049
9834 Such images can be displayed within the buffer. @xref{Handling links,the
9835 discussion of image links}.
9837 Even though images and tables are prominent examples of captioned structures,
9838 the same caption mechanism can apply to many others (e.g., @LaTeX{}
9839 equations, source code blocks). Depending on the export back-end, those may
9840 or may not be handled.
9842 @node Literal examples
9843 @section Literal examples
9844 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9845 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9847 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9848 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9849 for source code and similar examples.
9850 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9854 Some example from a text file.
9858 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9859 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9860 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9861 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9862 whitespace before the colon:
9866 : Some example from a text file.
9869 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9870 @vindex org-latex-listings
9871 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9872 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9873 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9874 the HTML back-end (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9875 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9876 achieved using either the
9877 @url{https://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/macros/latex/contrib/listings/?lang=en, listings,}
9879 @url{https://github.com/gpoore/minted, minted,} package.
9880 If you use minted or listing, you must load the packages manually, for
9881 example by adding the desired package to
9882 @code{org-latex-packages-alist}. Refer to @code{org-latex-listings}
9883 for details.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also need
9884 to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
9885 example@footnote{Code in @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either
9886 interactively or on export. @xref{Working with source code}, for more
9887 information on evaluating code blocks.}, see @ref{Easy templates} for
9888 shortcuts to easily insert code blocks.
9892 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9893 (defun org-xor (a b)
9899 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9900 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9901 numbered. The @code{-n} takes an optional numeric argument specifying the
9902 starting line number of the block. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the
9903 numbering from the previous numbered snippet will be continued in the current
9904 one. The @code{+n} can also take a numeric argument. The value of the
9905 argument will be added to the last line of the previous block to determine
9906 the starting line number.
9909 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n 20
9910 ;; this will export with line number 20
9911 (message "This is line 21")
9913 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp +n 10
9914 ;; This will be listed as line 31
9915 (message "This is line 32")
9919 In literal examples, Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as
9920 labels, and use them as targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]}
9921 (i.e., the reference name enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering
9922 the mouse over such a link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line,
9923 which is kind of cool.
9925 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9926 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9927 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9928 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9929 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9930 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9934 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9935 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9936 (goto-char (point-min))) (ref:jump)
9938 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9942 @cindex indentation, in source blocks
9943 Finally, you can use @code{-i} to preserve the indentation of a specific code
9944 block (@pxref{Editing source code}).
9946 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9947 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9948 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9949 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9951 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9952 areas in HTML export}).
9954 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9955 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy templates facility
9956 (@pxref{Easy templates}).
9961 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9962 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9963 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*},
9964 @samp{,*}, @samp{#+} and @samp{,#+} will get a comma prepended, to keep them
9965 from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special syntax. These
9966 commas will be stripped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}.
9967 The edited version will then replace the old version in the Org buffer.
9968 Fixed-width regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space)
9969 will be edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select
9970 a different-mode with the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.}
9971 to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line
9972 will create a new fixed-width region.
9975 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9976 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9977 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9978 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9979 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9982 @node Special symbols
9983 @section Special symbols
9984 @cindex Org entities
9985 @cindex math symbols
9986 @cindex special symbols
9987 @cindex HTML entities
9988 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9990 You can use @LaTeX{}-like syntax to insert special symbols---named
9991 entities---like @samp{\alpha} to indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to
9992 indicate an arrow. Completion for these symbols is available, just type
9993 @samp{\} and maybe a few letters, and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible
9994 completions. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it with
9995 a pair of curly brackets. For example
9998 Protip: Given a circle \Gamma of diameter d, the length of its circumference
10002 @findex org-entities-help
10003 @vindex org-entities-user
10004 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
10005 @LaTeX{}; you can comfortably browse the complete list from a dedicated
10006 buffer using the command @code{org-entities-help}. It is also possible to
10007 provide your own special symbols in the variable @code{org-entities-user}.
10009 During export, these symbols are transformed into the native format of the
10010 exporter back-end. Strings like @code{\alpha} are exported as @code{α}
10011 in the HTML output, and as @code{\(\alpha\)} in the @LaTeX{} output.
10012 Similarly, @code{\nbsp} becomes @code{ } in HTML and @code{~} in
10015 @cindex escaping characters
10016 Entities may also be used as a may to escape markup in an Org document, e.g.,
10017 @samp{\under@{@}not underlined\under} exports as @samp{_not underlined_}.
10019 @cindex special symbols, in-buffer display
10020 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF-8 characters, use the
10021 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
10022 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
10023 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
10026 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
10029 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
10030 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
10031 for display purposes only.
10034 @cindex shy hyphen, special symbol
10035 @cindex dash, special symbol
10036 @cindex ellipsis, special symbol
10037 In addition to regular entities defined above, Org exports in a special
10038 way@footnote{This behaviour can be disabled with @code{-} export setting
10039 (@pxref{Export settings}).} the following commonly used character
10040 combinations: @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, @samp{--} and @samp{---}
10041 are converted into dashes, and @samp{...} becomes a compact set of dots.
10043 @node Subscripts and superscripts
10044 @section Subscripts and superscripts
10046 @cindex superscript
10048 @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super- and subscripts. To
10049 increase the readability of ASCII text, it is not necessary---but OK---to
10050 surround multi-character sub- and superscripts with curly braces. Those are,
10051 however, mandatory, when more than one word is involved. For example
10054 The radius of the sun is R_sun = 6.96 x 10^8 m. On the other hand, the
10055 radius of Alpha Centauri is R_@{Alpha Centauri@} = 1.28 x R_@{sun@}.
10058 @vindex org-use-sub-superscripts
10059 If you write a text where the underscore is often used in a different
10060 context, Org's convention to always interpret these as subscripts can get in
10061 your way. Configure the variable @code{org-use-sub-superscripts} to change
10062 this convention. For example, when setting this variable to @code{@{@}},
10063 @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
10068 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
10069 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
10072 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}
10073 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
10074 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
10075 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
10077 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
10078 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
10079 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
10080 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
10081 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
10082 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
10083 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
10084 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
10085 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export back-ends.
10088 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
10089 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
10090 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
10093 @node @LaTeX{} fragments
10094 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
10095 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
10097 @vindex org-format-latex-header
10098 Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways to process
10099 these for several export back-ends. When exporting to @LaTeX{}, the code is
10100 left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org can use either
10101 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax} (@pxref{Math formatting in HTML
10102 export}) or transcode the math into images (see @pxref{Previewing @LaTeX{}
10105 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
10106 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
10109 Environments of any kind@footnote{When MathJax is used, only the
10110 environments recognized by MathJax will be processed. When
10111 @file{dvipng} program, @file{dvisvgm} program or @file{imagemagick} suite is
10112 used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environment will be handled.}. The only
10113 requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears on a new line, at the
10114 beginning of the line or after whitespaces only.
10116 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
10117 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
10118 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
10119 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
10120 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace or punctuation
10121 (parentheses and quotes are considered to be punctuation in this
10122 context). For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in
10123 doubt, use @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
10126 @noindent For example:
10133 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
10134 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
10139 @c @vindex org-format-latex-options
10140 @c If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
10141 @c can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
10142 @c ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
10144 @vindex org-export-with-latex
10145 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
10146 @code{org-export-with-latex}. The default setting is @code{t} which means
10147 MathJax for HTML, and no processing for ASCII and @LaTeX{} back-ends.
10148 You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one of these
10152 #+OPTIONS: tex:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
10153 #+OPTIONS: tex:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
10154 #+OPTIONS: tex:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
10157 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
10158 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
10159 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
10161 @vindex org-preview-latex-default-process
10162 If you have a working @LaTeX{} installation and @file{dvipng}, @file{dvisvgm}
10163 or @file{convert} installed@footnote{These are respectively available at
10164 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}, @url{http://dvisvgm.bplaced.net/}
10165 and from the @file{imagemagick} suite. Choose the converter by setting the
10166 variable @code{org-preview-latex-default-process} accordingly.}, @LaTeX{}
10167 fragments can be processed to produce images of the typeset expressions to be
10168 used for inclusion while exporting to HTML (see @pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}),
10169 or for inline previewing within Org mode.
10171 @vindex org-format-latex-options
10172 @vindex org-format-latex-header
10173 You can customize the variables @code{org-format-latex-options} and
10174 @code{org-format-latex-header} to influence some aspects of the preview. In
10175 particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML export, @code{:html-scale})
10176 property of the former can be used to adjust the size of the preview images.
10179 @kindex C-c C-x C-l
10181 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
10182 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
10183 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
10184 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
10185 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
10186 process the entire buffer.
10189 Remove the overlay preview images.
10192 @vindex org-startup-with-latex-preview
10193 You can turn on the previewing of all @LaTeX{} fragments in a file with
10196 #+STARTUP: latexpreview
10199 To disable it, simply use
10202 #+STARTUP: nolatexpreview
10206 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
10209 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
10210 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
10211 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
10212 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
10213 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
10214 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{https://staff.fnwi.uva.nl/c.dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
10215 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
10216 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
10217 on for the current buffer with @kbd{M-x org-cdlatex-mode RET}, or for all
10221 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
10224 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
10225 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
10229 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
10232 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
10233 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
10234 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
10235 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
10236 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
10237 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
10238 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
10239 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
10240 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
10241 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
10242 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help RET}.
10246 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
10247 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
10248 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
10249 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
10250 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
10251 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
10254 Pressing the grave accent @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
10255 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
10256 after the grave accent, a help window will pop up.
10259 Pressing the apostrophe @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
10260 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
10261 1.5 seconds after the apostrophe, a help window will pop up. Character
10262 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
10270 Sometimes, you may want to pretty print your notes, publish them on the web
10271 or even share them with people not using Org. In these cases, the Org export
10272 facilities can be used to convert your documents to a variety of other
10273 formats, while retaining as much structure (@pxref{Document structure}) and
10274 markup (@pxref{Markup}) as possible.
10276 @cindex export back-end
10277 Libraries responsible for such translation are called back-ends. Org ships
10278 with the following ones
10281 @item ascii (ASCII format)
10282 @item beamer (@LaTeX{} Beamer format)
10283 @item html (HTML format)
10284 @item icalendar (iCalendar format)
10285 @item latex (@LaTeX{} format)
10286 @item md (Markdown format)
10287 @item odt (OpenDocument Text format)
10288 @item org (Org format)
10289 @item texinfo (Texinfo format)
10290 @item man (Man page format)
10293 @noindent Org also uses additional libraries located in @code{contrib/}
10294 directory (@pxref{Installation}). Users can install additional export
10295 libraries for additional formats from the Emacs packaging system. For easy
10296 discovery, these packages have a common naming scheme: @file{ox-NAME}, where
10297 NAME is one of the formats. For example, @file{ox-koma-letter} for
10298 @code{koma-letter} back-end.
10300 @vindex org-export-backends
10301 Org loads back-ends for the following formats by default: @code{ascii},
10302 @code{html}, @code{icalendar}, @code{latex} and @code{odt}.
10304 Org can load additional back-ends either of two ways: through the
10305 @code{org-export-backends} variable configuration; or, by requiring the
10306 library in the Emacs init file like this:
10313 * The export dispatcher:: The main interface
10314 * Export settings:: Common export settings
10315 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
10316 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
10317 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create templates
10318 * Comment lines:: What will not be exported
10319 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
10320 * Beamer export:: Exporting as a Beamer presentation
10321 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
10322 * @LaTeX{} export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
10323 * Markdown export:: Exporting to Markdown
10324 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
10325 * Org export:: Exporting to Org
10326 * Texinfo export:: Exporting to Texinfo
10327 * iCalendar export:: Exporting to iCalendar
10328 * Other built-in back-ends:: Exporting to a man page
10329 * Advanced configuration:: Fine-tuning the export output
10330 * Export in foreign buffers:: Author tables and lists in Org syntax
10333 @node The export dispatcher
10334 @section The export dispatcher
10335 @vindex org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui
10336 @cindex Export, dispatcher
10338 The export dispatcher is the main interface for Org's exports. A
10339 hierarchical menu presents the currently configured export formats. Options
10340 are shown as easy toggle switches on the same screen.
10342 Org also has a minimal prompt interface for the export dispatcher. When the
10343 variable @code{org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui} is set to a non-@code{nil}
10344 value, Org prompts in the minibuffer. To switch back to the hierarchical
10345 menu, press @key{?}.
10348 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export-dispatch}
10350 Invokes the export dispatcher interface. The options show default settings.
10351 The @kbd{C-u} prefix argument preserves options from the previous export,
10352 including any sub-tree selections.
10356 Org exports the entire buffer by default. If the Org buffer has an active
10357 region, then Org exports just that region.
10359 These are the export options, the key combinations that toggle them
10360 (@pxref{Export settings}):
10364 @vindex org-export-async-init-file
10365 Toggles asynchronous export. Asynchronous export uses an external Emacs
10366 process with a specially configured initialization file to complete the
10367 exporting process in the background thereby releasing the current interface.
10368 This is particularly useful when exporting long documents.
10370 Output from an asynchronous export is saved on the ``the export stack''. To
10371 view this stack, call the export dispatcher with a double @kbd{C-u} prefix
10372 argument. If already in the export dispatcher menu, @kbd{&} displays the
10375 @vindex org-export-in-background
10376 To make the background export process the default, customize the variable,
10377 @code{org-export-in-background}.
10380 Toggle body-only export. Useful for excluding headers and footers in the
10381 export. Affects only those back-end formats that have such sections---like
10382 @code{<head>...</head>} in HTML.
10385 @vindex org-export-initial-scope
10386 Toggle sub-tree export. When turned on, Org exports only the sub-tree starting
10387 from the cursor position at the time the export dispatcher was invoked. Org
10388 uses the top heading of this sub-tree as the document's title. If the cursor
10389 is not on a heading, Org uses the nearest enclosing header. If the cursor is
10390 in the document preamble, Org signals an error and aborts export.
10392 To make the sub-tree export the default, customize the variable,
10393 @code{org-export-initial-scope}.
10396 Toggle visible-only export. Useful for exporting only visible parts of an
10397 Org document by adjusting outline visibility settings.
10400 @node Export settings
10401 @section Export settings
10402 @cindex Export, settings
10405 Export options can be set: globally with variables; for an individual file by
10406 making variables buffer-local with in-buffer settings (@pxref{In-buffer
10407 settings}), by setting individual keywords, or by specifying them in a
10408 compact form with the @code{#+OPTIONS} keyword; or for a tree by setting
10409 properties (@pxref{Properties and columns}). Options set at a specific level
10410 override options set at a more general level.
10412 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
10413 In-buffer settings may appear anywhere in the file, either directly or
10414 indirectly through a file included using @samp{#+SETUPFILE: filename or URL}
10415 syntax. Option keyword sets tailored to a particular back-end can be
10416 inserted from the export dispatcher (@pxref{The export dispatcher}) using the
10417 @code{Insert template} command by pressing @key{#}. To insert keywords
10418 individually, a good way to make sure the keyword is correct is to type
10419 @code{#+} and then to use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}@footnote{Many desktops intercept
10420 @kbd{M-TAB} to switch windows. Use @kbd{C-M-i} or @kbd{@key{ESC} @key{TAB}}
10421 instead.} for completion.
10423 The export keywords available for every back-end, and their equivalent global
10424 variables, include:
10429 @vindex user-full-name
10430 The document author (@code{user-full-name}).
10434 @vindex org-export-creator-string
10435 Entity responsible for output generation (@code{org-export-creator-string}).
10439 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
10440 A date or a time-stamp@footnote{The variable
10441 @code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this time-stamp will be
10446 @vindex user-mail-address
10447 The email address (@code{user-mail-address}).
10451 @vindex org-export-default-language
10452 Language to use for translating certain strings
10453 (@code{org-export-default-language}). With @samp{#+LANGUAGE: fr}, for
10454 example, Org translates @emph{Table of contents} to the French @emph{Table
10458 @cindex #+SELECT_TAGS
10459 @vindex org-export-select-tags
10460 The default value is @code{:export:}. When a tree is tagged with
10461 @code{:export:} (@code{org-export-select-tags}), Org selects that tree and
10462 its sub-trees for export. Org excludes trees with @code{:noexport:} tags,
10463 see below. When selectively exporting files with @code{:export:} tags set,
10464 Org does not export any text that appears before the first headline.
10467 @cindex #+EXCLUDE_TAGS
10468 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
10469 The default value is @code{:noexport:}. When a tree is tagged with
10470 @code{:noexport:} (@code{org-export-exclude-tags}), Org excludes that tree
10471 and its sub-trees from export. Entries tagged with @code{:noexport:} will be
10472 unconditionally excluded from the export, even if they have an
10473 @code{:export:} tag. Even if a sub-tree is not exported, Org will execute any
10474 code blocks contained in them.
10478 @cindex document title
10479 Org displays this title. For long titles, use multiple @code{#+TITLE} lines.
10481 @item EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10482 @cindex #+EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10483 The name of the output file to be generated. Otherwise, Org generates the
10484 file name based on the buffer name and the extension based on the back-end
10488 The @code{#+OPTIONS} keyword is a compact form. To configure multiple
10489 options, use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines. @code{#+OPTIONS} recognizes the
10490 following arguments.
10494 @vindex org-export-with-smart-quotes
10495 Toggle smart quotes (@code{org-export-with-smart-quotes}). Depending on the
10496 language used, when activated, Org treats pairs of double quotes as primary
10497 quotes, pairs of single quotes as secondary quotes, and single quote marks as
10501 Toggle emphasized text (@code{org-export-with-emphasize}).
10504 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10505 Toggle conversion of special strings
10506 (@code{org-export-with-special-strings}).
10509 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10510 Toggle fixed-width sections
10511 (@code{org-export-with-fixed-width}).
10514 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10515 Toggle inclusion of time/date active/inactive stamps
10516 (@code{org-export-with-timestamps}).
10519 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10520 Toggles whether to preserve line breaks (@code{org-export-preserve-breaks}).
10523 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10524 Toggle @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If you write "^:@{@}",
10525 @samp{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but the simple @samp{a_b} will be left as
10526 it is (@code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}).
10529 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10530 Configure how archived trees are exported. When set to @code{headline}, the
10531 export process skips the contents and processes only the headlines
10532 (@code{org-export-with-archived-trees}).
10535 @vindex org-export-with-author
10536 Toggle inclusion of author name into exported file
10537 (@code{org-export-with-author}).
10539 @item broken-links:
10540 @vindex org-export-with-broken-links
10541 Toggles if Org should continue exporting upon finding a broken internal link.
10542 When set to @code{mark}, Org clearly marks the problem link in the output
10543 (@code{org-export-with-broken-links}).
10546 @vindex org-export-with-clocks
10547 Toggle inclusion of CLOCK keywords (@code{org-export-with-clocks}).
10550 @vindex org-export-with-creator
10551 Toggle inclusion of creator information in the exported file
10552 (@code{org-export-with-creator}).
10555 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
10556 Toggles inclusion of drawers, or list of drawers to include, or list of
10557 drawers to exclude (@code{org-export-with-drawers}).
10560 @vindex org-export-with-date
10561 Toggle inclusion of a date into exported file (@code{org-export-with-date}).
10564 @vindex org-export-with-entities
10565 Toggle inclusion of entities (@code{org-export-with-entities}).
10568 @vindex org-export-with-email
10569 Toggle inclusion of the author's e-mail into exported file
10570 (@code{org-export-with-email}).
10573 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10574 Toggle the inclusion of footnotes (@code{org-export-with-footnotes}).
10577 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
10578 Set the number of headline levels for export
10579 (@code{org-export-headline-levels}). Below that level, headlines are treated
10580 differently. In most back-ends, they become list items.
10583 @vindex org-export-with-inlinetasks
10584 Toggle inclusion of inlinetasks (@code{org-export-with-inlinetasks}).
10587 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10588 @cindex property, UNNUMBERED
10589 Toggle section-numbers (@code{org-export-with-section-numbers}). When set to
10590 number @samp{n}, Org numbers only those headlines at level @samp{n} or above.
10591 Set @code{UNNUMBERED} property to non-@code{nil} to disable numbering of
10592 heading and subheadings entirely.
10595 @vindex org-export-with-planning
10596 Toggle export of planning information (@code{org-export-with-planning}).
10597 ``Planning information'' comes from lines located right after the headline
10598 and contain any combination of these cookies: @code{SCHEDULED:},
10599 @code{DEADLINE:}, or @code{CLOSED:}.
10602 @vindex org-export-with-priority
10603 Toggle inclusion of priority cookies (@code{org-export-with-priority}).
10606 @vindex org-export-with-properties
10607 Toggle inclusion of property drawers, or list the properties to include
10608 (@code{org-export-with-properties}).
10611 @vindex org-export-with-statistics-cookies
10612 Toggle inclusion of statistics cookies
10613 (@code{org-export-with-statistics-cookies}).
10616 @vindex org-export-with-tags
10617 Toggle inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}
10618 (@code{org-export-with-tags}).
10621 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
10622 Toggle inclusion of tasks (TODO items); or @code{nil} to remove all tasks; or
10623 @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks; or list the keywords to keep
10624 (@code{org-export-with-tasks}).
10627 @vindex org-export-with-latex
10628 @code{nil} does not export; @code{t} exports; @code{verbatim} keeps
10629 everything in verbatim (@code{org-export-with-latex}).
10632 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10633 Toggle inclusion of the creation time in the exported file
10634 (@code{org-export-time-stamp-file}).
10637 @vindex org-export-with-title
10638 Toggle inclusion of title (@code{org-export-with-title}).
10641 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10642 Toggle inclusion of the table of contents, or set the level limit
10643 (@code{org-export-with-toc}).
10646 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10647 Toggle inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text
10648 (@code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}).
10651 @vindex org-export-with-tables
10652 Toggle inclusion of tables (@code{org-export-with-tables}).
10656 When exporting sub-trees, special node properties in them can override the
10657 above keywords. They are special because they have an @samp{EXPORT_} prefix.
10658 For example, @samp{DATE} and @samp{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} keywords become,
10659 respectively, @samp{EXPORT_DATE} and @samp{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}. Except for
10660 @samp{SETUPFILE}, all other keywords listed above have an @samp{EXPORT_}
10664 @vindex org-export-allow-bind-keywords
10665 If @code{org-export-allow-bind-keywords} is non-@code{nil}, Emacs variables
10666 can become buffer-local during export by using the BIND keyword. Its syntax
10667 is @samp{#+BIND: variable value}. This is particularly useful for in-buffer
10668 settings that cannot be changed using keywords.
10670 @node Table of contents
10671 @section Table of contents
10672 @cindex table of contents
10673 @cindex list of tables
10674 @cindex list of listings
10677 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10678 Org normally inserts the table of contents directly before the first headline
10679 of the file. Org sets the TOC depth the same as the headline levels in the
10680 file. Use a lower number for lower TOC depth. To turn off TOC entirely, use
10681 @code{nil}. This is configured in the @code{org-export-with-toc} variable or
10682 as keywords in an Org file as:
10685 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 @r{only include two levels in TOC}
10686 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil @r{no default TOC at all}
10689 To move the table of contents to a different location, first turn off the
10690 default with @code{org-export-with-toc} variable or with @code{#+OPTIONS:
10691 toc:nil}. Then insert @code{#+TOC: headlines N} at the desired location(s).
10694 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil @r{no default TOC}
10696 #+TOC: headlines 2 @r{insert TOC here, with two headline levels}
10699 To adjust the TOC depth for a specific section of the Org document, append an
10700 additional @samp{local} parameter. This parameter becomes a relative depth
10701 for the current level.
10703 Note that for this feature to work properly in @LaTeX{} export, the Org file
10704 requires the inclusion of the @code{titletoc} package. Because of
10705 compatibility issues, @code{titletoc} has to be loaded @emph{before}
10706 @code{hyperref}. Customize the @code{org-latex-default-packages-alist}
10710 * Section #+TOC: headlines 1 local @r{insert local TOC, with direct children
10714 Use the @code{TOC} keyword to generate list of tables (resp.@: all listings)
10718 #+TOC: listings @r{build a list of listings}
10719 #+TOC: tables @r{build a list of tables}
10722 @cindex property, ALT_TITLE
10723 Normally Org uses the headline for its entry in the table of contents. But
10724 with @code{ALT_TITLE} property, a different entry can be specified for the
10727 @node Include files
10728 @section Include files
10729 @cindex include files, during export
10730 Include other files during export. For example, to include your @file{.emacs}
10731 file, you could use:
10735 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
10739 The first parameter is the file name to include. The optional second
10740 parameter specifies the block type: @samp{example}, @samp{export} or
10741 @samp{src}. The optional third parameter specifies the source code language
10742 to use for formatting the contents. This is relevant to both @samp{export}
10743 and @samp{src} block types.
10745 If an include file is specified as having a markup language, Org neither
10746 checks for valid syntax nor changes the contents in any way. For
10747 @samp{example} and @samp{src} blocks, Org code-escapes the contents before
10750 If an include file is not specified as having any markup language, Org
10751 assumes it be in Org format and proceeds as usual with a few exceptions. Org
10752 makes the footnote labels (@pxref{Footnotes}) in the included file local to
10753 that file. The contents of the included file will belong to the same
10754 structure---headline, item---containing the @code{INCLUDE} keyword. In
10755 particular, headlines within the file will become children of the current
10756 section. That behavior can be changed by providing an additional keyword
10757 parameter, @code{:minlevel}. It shifts the headlines in the included file to
10758 become the lowest level. For example, this syntax makes the included file
10759 a sibling of the current top-level headline:
10762 #+INCLUDE: "~/my-book/chapter2.org" :minlevel 1
10765 Inclusion of only portions of files are specified using ranges parameter with
10766 @code{:lines} keyword. The line at the upper end of the range will not be
10767 included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
10771 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
10772 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
10773 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
10776 Inclusions may specify a file-link to extract an object matched by
10777 @code{org-link-search}@footnote{Note that
10778 @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline} is locally bound to
10779 non-@code{nil}. Therefore, @code{org-link-search} only matches headlines and
10780 named elements.} (@pxref{Search options}).
10782 To extract only the contents of the matched object, set @code{:only-contents}
10783 property to non-@code{nil}. This will omit any planning lines or property
10784 drawers. The ranges for @code{:lines} keyword are relative to the requested
10785 element. Some examples:
10788 #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::#theory" :only-contents t
10789 @r{Include the body of the heading with the custom id @samp{theory}}
10790 #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::mytable" @r{Include named element.}
10791 #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::*conclusion" :lines 1-20
10792 @r{Include the first 20 lines of the headline named @samp{conclusion}.}
10798 Visit the include file at point.
10801 @node Macro replacement
10802 @section Macro replacement
10803 @cindex macro replacement, during export
10806 @vindex org-export-global-macros
10807 Macros replace text snippets during export. Macros are defined globally in
10808 @code{org-export-global-macros}, or document-wise with the following syntax:
10811 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
10814 @noindent which can be referenced using
10815 @code{@{@{@{name(arg1, arg2)@}@}@}}@footnote{Since commas separate the
10816 arguments, commas within arguments have to be escaped with the backslash
10817 character. So only those backslash characters before a comma need escaping
10818 with another backslash character.}.
10820 Org recognizes macro references in following Org markup areas: paragraphs,
10821 headlines, verse blocks, tables cells and lists. Org also recognizes macro
10822 references in keywords, such as @code{#+CAPTION}, @code{#+TITLE},
10823 @code{#+AUTHOR}, @code{#+DATE}, and for some back-end specific export
10826 Org comes with following pre-defined macros:
10829 @item @{@{@{title@}@}@}
10830 @itemx @{@{@{author@}@}@}
10831 @itemx @{@{@{email@}@}@}
10832 @cindex title, macro
10833 @cindex author, macro
10834 @cindex email, macro
10835 Org replaces these macro references with available information at the time of
10838 @item @{@{@{date@}@}@}
10839 @itemx @{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}
10840 @cindex date, macro
10841 This macro refers to the @code{#+DATE} keyword. @var{FORMAT} is an optional
10842 argument to the @code{@{@{@{date@}@}@}} macro that will be used only if
10843 @code{#+DATE} is a single timestamp. @var{FORMAT} should be a format string
10844 understood by @code{format-time-string}.
10846 @item @{@{@{time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}
10847 @itemx @{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT}, @var{VC})@}@}@}
10848 @cindex time, macro
10849 @cindex modification time, macro
10850 These macros refer to the document's date and time of export and date and
10851 time of modification. @var{FORMAT} is a string understood by
10852 @code{format-time-string}. If the second argument to the
10853 @code{modification-time} macro is non-@code{nil}, Org uses @file{vc.el} to
10854 retrieve the document's modification time from the version control
10855 system. Otherwise Org reads the file attributes.
10857 @item @{@{@{input-file@}@}@}
10858 @cindex input file, macro
10859 This macro refers to the filename of the exported file.
10861 @item @{@{@{property(@var{PROPERTY-NAME})@}@}@}
10862 @itemx @{@{@{property(@var{PROPERTY-NAME},@var{SEARCH-OPTION})@}@}@}
10863 @cindex property, macro
10864 This macro returns the value of property @var{PROPERTY-NAME} in the current
10865 entry. If @var{SEARCH-OPTION} (@pxref{Search options}) refers to a remote
10866 entry, that will be used instead.
10868 @item @{@{@{n@}@}@}
10869 @itemx @{@{@{n(@var{NAME})@}@}@}
10870 @itemx @{@{@{n(@var{NAME},@var{ACTION})@}@}@}
10872 @cindex counter, macro
10873 This macro implements custom counters by returning the number of times the
10874 macro has been expanded so far while exporting the buffer. You can create
10875 more than one counter using different @var{NAME} values. If @var{ACTION} is
10876 @code{-}, previous value of the counter is held, i.e. the specified counter
10877 is not incremented. If the value is a number, the specified counter is set
10878 to that value. If it is any other non-empty string, the specified counter is
10879 reset to 1. You may leave @var{NAME} empty to reset the default counter.
10882 The surrounding brackets can be made invisible by setting
10883 @code{org-hide-macro-markers} non-@code{nil}.
10885 Org expands macros at the very beginning of the export process.
10887 @node Comment lines
10888 @section Comment lines
10889 @cindex exporting, not
10891 @cindex comment lines
10892 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one
10893 @samp{#} and a whitespace are treated as comments and, as such, are not
10896 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
10897 Likewise, regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT}
10898 ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} are not exported.
10900 @cindex comment trees
10901 Finally, a @samp{COMMENT} keyword at the beginning of an entry, but after any
10902 other keyword or priority cookie, comments out the entire subtree. In this
10903 case, the subtree is not exported and no code block within it is executed
10904 either@footnote{For a less drastic behavior, consider using a select tag
10905 (@pxref{Export settings}) instead.}. The command below helps changing the
10906 comment status of a headline.
10911 Toggle the @samp{COMMENT} keyword at the beginning of an entry.
10914 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
10915 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
10916 @cindex ASCII export
10917 @cindex Latin-1 export
10918 @cindex UTF-8 export
10920 ASCII export produces an output file containing only plain ASCII characters.
10921 This is the most simplest and direct text output. It does not contain any
10922 Org markup either. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export use additional characters and
10923 symbols available in these encoding standards. All three of these export
10924 formats offer the most basic of text output for maximum portability.
10926 @vindex org-ascii-text-width
10927 On export, Org fills and justifies text according to the text width set in
10928 @code{org-ascii-text-width}.
10930 @vindex org-ascii-links-to-notes
10931 Org exports links using a footnote-like style where the descriptive part is
10932 in the text and the link is in a note before the next heading. See the
10933 variable @code{org-ascii-links-to-notes} for details.
10935 @subheading ASCII export commands
10938 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t a/l/u,org-ascii-export-to-ascii}
10939 Export as an ASCII file with a @file{.txt} extension. For @file{myfile.org},
10940 Org exports to @file{myfile.txt}, overwriting without warning. For
10941 @file{myfile.txt}, Org exports to @file{myfile.txt.txt} in order to prevent
10943 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t A/L/U,org-ascii-export-as-ascii}
10944 Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file.
10947 @subheading ASCII specific export settings
10948 The ASCII export back-end has one extra keyword for customizing ASCII output.
10949 Setting this keyword works similar to the general options (@pxref{Export
10954 @cindex #+SUBTITLE (ASCII)
10955 The document subtitle. For long subtitles, use multiple @code{#+SUBTITLE}
10956 lines in the Org file. Org prints them on one continuous line, wrapping into
10957 multiple lines if necessary.
10960 @subheading Header and sectioning structure
10962 Org converts the first three outline levels into headlines for ASCII export.
10963 The remaining levels are turned into lists. To change this cut-off point
10964 where levels become lists, @pxref{Export settings}.
10966 @subheading Quoting ASCII text
10968 To insert text within the Org file by the ASCII back-end, use one the
10969 following constructs, inline, keyword, or export block:
10972 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii
10974 Inline text @@@@ascii:and additional text@@@@ within a paragraph.
10978 #+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii
10979 Org exports text in this block only when using ASCII back-end.
10983 @subheading ASCII specific attributes
10984 @cindex #+ATTR_ASCII
10985 @cindex horizontal rules, in ASCII export
10987 ASCII back-end recognizes only one attribute, @code{:width}, which specifies
10988 the width of an horizontal rule in number of characters. The keyword and
10989 syntax for specifying widths is:
10992 #+ATTR_ASCII: :width 10
10996 @subheading ASCII special blocks
10997 @cindex special blocks, in ASCII export
10998 @cindex #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYLEFT
10999 @cindex #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYRIGHT
11001 Besides @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER} blocks (@pxref{Paragraphs}), ASCII back-end has
11002 these two left and right justification blocks:
11005 #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYLEFT
11006 It's just a jump to the left...
11009 #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYRIGHT
11010 ...and then a step to the right.
11014 @node Beamer export
11015 @section Beamer export
11016 @cindex Beamer export
11018 Org uses @emph{Beamer} export to convert an Org file tree structure into a
11019 high-quality interactive slides for presentations. @emph{Beamer} is a
11020 @LaTeX{} document class for creating presentations in PDF, HTML, and other
11021 popular display formats.
11024 * Beamer export commands:: For creating Beamer documents.
11025 * Beamer specific export settings:: For customizing Beamer export.
11026 * Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer:: For composing Beamer slides.
11027 * Beamer specific syntax:: For using in Org documents.
11028 * Editing support:: For using helper functions.
11029 * A Beamer example:: A complete presentation.
11032 @node Beamer export commands
11033 @subsection Beamer export commands
11036 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l b,org-beamer-export-to-latex}
11037 Export as @LaTeX{} file with a @file{.tex} extension. For @file{myfile.org},
11038 Org exports to @file{myfile.tex}, overwriting without warning.
11039 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l B,org-beamer-export-as-latex}
11040 Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file.
11041 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l P,org-beamer-export-to-pdf}
11042 Export as @LaTeX{} file and then convert it to PDF format.
11044 Export as @LaTeX{} file, convert it to PDF format, and then open the PDF
11048 @node Beamer specific export settings
11049 @subsection Beamer specific export settings
11051 Beamer export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing Beamer
11052 output. These keywords work similar to the general options settings
11053 (@pxref{Export settings}).
11057 @cindex #+BEAMER_THEME
11058 @vindex org-beamer-theme
11059 The Beamer layout theme (@code{org-beamer-theme}). Use square brackets for
11060 options. For example:
11062 #+BEAMER_THEME: Rochester [height=20pt]
11065 @item BEAMER_FONT_THEME
11066 @cindex #+BEAMER_FONT_THEME
11067 The Beamer font theme.
11069 @item BEAMER_INNER_THEME
11070 @cindex #+BEAMER_INNER_THEME
11071 The Beamer inner theme.
11073 @item BEAMER_OUTER_THEME
11074 @cindex #+BEAMER_OUTER_THEME
11075 The Beamer outer theme.
11077 @item BEAMER_HEADER
11078 @cindex #+BEAMER_HEADER
11079 Arbitrary lines inserted in the preamble, just before the @samp{hyperref}
11083 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION (Beamer)
11084 The document description. For long descriptions, use multiple
11085 @code{#+DESCRIPTION} keywords. By default, @samp{hyperref} inserts
11086 @code{#+DESCRIPTION} as metadata. Use @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} to
11087 configure document metadata. Use @code{org-latex-title-command} to configure
11088 typesetting of description as part of front matter.
11091 @cindex #+KEYWORDS (Beamer)
11092 The keywords for defining the contents of the document. Use multiple
11093 @code{#+KEYWORDS} lines if necessary. By default, @samp{hyperref} inserts
11094 @code{#+KEYWORDS} as metadata. Use @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} to
11095 configure document metadata. Use @code{org-latex-title-command} to configure
11096 typesetting of keywords as part of front matter.
11099 @cindex #+SUBTITLE (Beamer)
11100 @vindex org-beamer-subtitle-format
11101 Document's subtitle. For typesetting, use @code{org-beamer-subtitle-format}
11102 string. Use @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} to configure document
11103 metadata. Use @code{org-latex-title-command} to configure typesetting of
11104 subtitle as part of front matter.
11107 @node Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer
11108 @subsection Sectioning, Frames and Blocks in Beamer
11110 Org transforms heading levels into Beamer's sectioning elements, frames and
11111 blocks. Any Org tree with a not-too-deep-level nesting should in principle
11112 be exportable as a Beamer presentation.
11116 @vindex org-beamer-frame-level
11117 Org headlines become Beamer frames when the heading level in Org is equal to
11118 @code{org-beamer-frame-level} or @code{H} value in an @code{OPTIONS} line
11119 (@pxref{Export settings}).
11121 @cindex property, BEAMER_ENV
11122 Org overrides headlines to frames conversion for the current tree of an Org
11123 file if it encounters the @code{BEAMER_ENV} property set to @code{frame} or
11124 @code{fullframe}. Org ignores whatever @code{org-beamer-frame-level} happens
11125 to be for that headline level in the Org tree. In Beamer terminology, a
11126 @code{fullframe} is a frame without its title.
11129 @vindex org-beamer-environments-default
11130 @vindex org-beamer-environments-extra
11131 Org exports a Beamer frame's objects as @code{block} environments. Org can
11132 enforce wrapping in special block types when @code{BEAMER_ENV} property is
11133 set@footnote{If @code{BEAMER_ENV} is set, Org export adds
11134 @code{:B_environment:} tag to make it visible. The tag serves as a visual
11135 aid and has no semantic relevance.}. For valid values see
11136 @code{org-beamer-environments-default}. To add more values, see
11137 @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}.
11140 @cindex property, BEAMER_REF
11141 If @code{BEAMER_ENV} is set to @code{appendix}, Org exports the entry as an
11142 appendix. When set to @code{note}, Org exports the entry as a note within
11143 the frame or between frames, depending on the entry's heading level. When
11144 set to @code{noteNH}, Org exports the entry as a note without its title.
11145 When set to @code{againframe}, Org exports the entry with @code{\againframe}
11146 command, which makes setting the @code{BEAMER_REF} property mandatory because
11147 @code{\againframe} needs frame to resume.
11149 When @code{ignoreheading} is set, Org export ignores the entry's headline but
11150 not its content. This is useful for inserting content between frames. It is
11151 also useful for properly closing a @code{column} environment.
11154 @cindex property, BEAMER_ACT
11155 @cindex property, BEAMER_OPT
11156 When @code{BEAMER_ACT} is set for a headline, Org export translates that
11157 headline as an overlay or action specification. When enclosed in square
11158 brackets, Org export makes the overlay specification a default. Use
11159 @code{BEAMER_OPT} to set any options applicable to the current Beamer frame
11160 or block. The Beamer export back-end wraps with appropriate angular or
11161 square brackets. It also adds the @code{fragile} option for any code that may
11162 require a verbatim block.
11164 @cindex property, BEAMER_COL
11165 To create a column on the Beamer slide, use the @code{BEAMER_COL} property
11166 for its headline in the Org file. Set the value of @code{BEAMER_COL} to a
11167 decimal number representing the fraction of the total text width. Beamer
11168 export uses this value to set the column's width and fills the column with
11169 the contents of the Org entry. If the Org entry has no specific environment
11170 defined, Beamer export ignores the heading. If the Org entry has a defined
11171 environment, Beamer export uses the heading as title. Behind the scenes,
11172 Beamer export automatically handles @LaTeX{} column separations for
11173 contiguous headlines. To manually adjust them for any unique configurations
11174 needs, use the @code{BEAMER_ENV} property.
11176 @node Beamer specific syntax
11177 @subsection Beamer specific syntax
11178 Since Org's Beamer export back-end is an extension of the @LaTeX{} back-end,
11179 it recognizes other @LaTeX{} specific syntax---for example, @samp{#+LATEX:}
11180 or @samp{#+ATTR_LATEX:}. @xref{@LaTeX{} export}, for details.
11182 Beamer export wraps the table of contents generated with @code{toc:t}
11183 @code{OPTION} keyword in a @code{frame} environment. Beamer export does not
11184 wrap the table of contents generated with @code{TOC} keyword (@pxref{Table of
11185 contents}). Use square brackets for specifying options.
11188 #+TOC: headlines [currentsection]
11191 Insert Beamer-specific code using the following constructs:
11194 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXPORT beamer
11198 #+BEGIN_EXPORT beamer
11199 Only Beamer export back-end will export this line.
11202 Text @@@@beamer:some code@@@@ within a paragraph.
11205 Inline constructs, such as the last one above, are useful for adding overlay
11206 specifications to objects with @code{bold}, @code{item}, @code{link},
11207 @code{radio-target} and @code{target} types. Enclose the value in angular
11208 brackets and place the specification at the beginning the object as shown in
11212 A *@@@@beamer:<2->@@@@useful* feature
11215 @cindex #+ATTR_BEAMER
11216 Beamer export recognizes the @code{ATTR_BEAMER} keyword with the following
11217 attributes from Beamer configurations: @code{:environment} for changing local
11218 Beamer environment, @code{:overlay} for specifying Beamer overlays in angular
11219 or square brackets, and @code{:options} for inserting optional arguments.
11222 #+ATTR_BEAMER: :environment nonindentlist
11223 - item 1, not indented
11224 - item 2, not indented
11225 - item 3, not indented
11229 #+ATTR_BEAMER: :overlay <+->
11235 #+ATTR_BEAMER: :options [Lagrange]
11236 Let $G$ be a finite group, and let $H$ be
11237 a subgroup of $G$. Then the order of $H$ divides the order of $G$.
11240 @node Editing support
11241 @subsection Editing support
11244 The @code{org-beamer-mode} is a special minor mode for faster editing of
11252 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
11253 The @code{org-beamer-mode} provides this key for quicker selections in Beamer
11254 normal environments, and for selecting the @code{BEAMER_COL} property.
11257 @node A Beamer example
11258 @subsection A Beamer example
11260 Here is an example of an Org document ready for Beamer export.
11263 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
11264 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
11265 #+OPTIONS: H:2 toc:t num:t
11266 #+LATEX_CLASS: beamer
11267 #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
11268 #+BEAMER_THEME: Madrid
11269 #+COLUMNS: %45ITEM %10BEAMER_ENV(Env) %10BEAMER_ACT(Act) %4BEAMER_COL(Col) %8BEAMER_OPT(Opt)
11271 * This is the first structural section
11274 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :B_block:
11279 for the first viable Beamer setup in Org
11280 *** Thanks to everyone else :B_block:
11286 for contributing to the discussion
11287 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
11291 ** Frame 2 (where we will not use columns)
11293 Please test this stuff!
11297 @section HTML export
11298 @cindex HTML export
11300 Org mode contains an HTML exporter with extensive HTML formatting compatible
11301 with XHTML 1.0 strict standard.
11304 * HTML Export commands:: Invoking HTML export
11305 * HTML Specific export settings:: Settings for HTML export
11306 * HTML doctypes:: Exporting various (X)HTML flavors
11307 * HTML preamble and postamble:: Inserting preamble and postamble
11308 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org files
11309 * Links in HTML export:: Interpreting and formatting links
11310 * Tables in HTML export:: Formatting and modifying tables
11311 * Images in HTML export:: Inserting figures with HTML output
11312 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Handling math equations
11313 * Text areas in HTML export:: Showing an alternate approach, an example
11314 * CSS support:: Styling HTML output
11315 * JavaScript support:: Folding scripting in the web browser
11319 @node HTML Export commands
11320 @subsection HTML export commands
11323 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h h,org-html-export-to-html}
11324 Export as HTML file with a @file{.html} extension. For @file{myfile.org},
11325 Org exports to @file{myfile.html}, overwriting without warning. @kbd{C-c C-e
11326 h o} Exports to HTML and opens it in a web browser.
11328 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h H,org-html-export-as-html}
11329 Exports to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file.
11332 @node HTML Specific export settings
11333 @subsection HTML Specific export settings
11334 HTML export has a number of keywords, similar to the general options settings
11335 described in @ref{Export settings}.
11339 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION (HTML)
11340 This is the document's description, which the HTML exporter inserts it as a
11341 HTML meta tag in the HTML file. For long descriptions, use multiple
11342 @code{#+DESCRIPTION} lines. The exporter takes care of wrapping the lines
11346 @cindex #+HTML_DOCTYPE
11347 @vindex org-html-doctype
11348 Specify the document type, for example: HTML5 (@code{org-html-doctype}).
11350 @item HTML_CONTAINER
11351 @cindex #+HTML_CONTAINER
11352 @vindex org-html-container-element
11353 Specify the HTML container, such as @samp{div}, for wrapping sections and
11354 elements (@code{org-html-container-element}).
11356 @item HTML_LINK_HOME
11357 @cindex #+HTML_LINK_HOME
11358 @vindex org-html-link-home
11359 The URL for home link (@code{org-html-link-home}).
11362 @cindex #+HTML_LINK_UP
11363 @vindex org-html-link-up
11364 The URL for the up link of exported HTML pages (@code{org-html-link-up}).
11367 @cindex #+HTML_MATHJAX
11368 @vindex org-html-mathjax-options
11369 Options for MathJax (@code{org-html-mathjax-options}). MathJax is used to
11370 typeset @LaTeX{} math in HTML documents. @xref{Math formatting in HTML
11371 export}, for an example.
11374 @cindex #+HTML_HEAD
11375 @vindex org-html-head
11376 Arbitrary lines for appending to the HTML document's head
11377 (@code{org-html-head}).
11379 @item HTML_HEAD_EXTRA
11380 @cindex #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA
11381 @vindex org-html-head-extra
11382 More arbitrary lines for appending to the HTML document's head
11383 (@code{org-html-head-extra}).
11386 @cindex #+KEYWORDS (HTML)
11387 Keywords to describe the document's content. HTML exporter inserts these
11388 keywords as HTML meta tags. For long keywords, use multiple
11389 @code{#+KEYWORDS} lines.
11392 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER (HTML)
11393 Arbitrary lines for appending to the preamble; HTML exporter appends when
11394 transcoding @LaTeX{} fragments to images (@pxref{Math formatting in HTML
11398 @cindex #+SUBTILE (HTML)
11399 The document's subtitle. HTML exporter formats subtitle if document type is
11400 @samp{HTML5} and the CSS has a @samp{subtitle} class.
11403 Some of these keywords are explained in more detail in the following sections
11406 @node HTML doctypes
11407 @subsection HTML doctypes
11409 Org can export to various (X)HTML flavors.
11411 @vindex org-html-doctype
11412 @vindex org-html-doctype-alist
11413 Set the @code{org-html-doctype} variable for different (X)HTML variants.
11414 Depending on the variant, the HTML exporter adjusts the syntax of HTML
11415 conversion accordingly. Org includes the following ready-made variants:
11421 ``html4-transitional''
11427 ``xhtml-transitional''
11438 @noindent See the variable @code{org-html-doctype-alist} for details.
11439 The default is ``xhtml-strict''.
11441 @vindex org-html-html5-fancy
11442 @cindex HTML5, export new elements
11443 Org's HTML exporter does not by default enable new block elements introduced
11444 with the HTML5 standard. To enable them, set @code{org-html-html5-fancy} to
11445 non-@code{nil}. Or use an @code{OPTIONS} line in the file to set
11446 @code{html5-fancy}. HTML5 documents can now have arbitrary #+BEGIN and #+END
11447 blocks. For example:
11466 #+ATTR_HTML: :controls controls :width 350
11468 #+HTML: <source src="movie.mp4" type="video/mp4">
11469 #+HTML: <source src="movie.ogg" type="video/ogg">
11470 Your browser does not support the video tag.
11477 <video controls="controls" width="350">
11478 <source src="movie.mp4" type="video/mp4">
11479 <source src="movie.ogg" type="video/ogg">
11480 <p>Your browser does not support the video tag.</p>
11484 @vindex org-html-html5-elements
11485 When special blocks do not have a corresponding HTML5 element, the HTML
11486 exporter reverts to standard translation (see
11487 @code{org-html-html5-elements}). For example, @code{#+BEGIN_lederhosen}
11488 exports to @samp{<div class="lederhosen">}.
11490 Special blocks cannot have headlines. For the HTML exporter to wrap the
11491 headline and its contents in @samp{<section>} or @samp{<article>} tags, set
11492 the @code{HTML_CONTAINER} property for the headline.
11494 @node HTML preamble and postamble
11495 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
11496 @vindex org-html-preamble
11497 @vindex org-html-postamble
11498 @vindex org-html-preamble-format
11499 @vindex org-html-postamble-format
11500 @vindex org-html-validation-link
11501 @vindex org-export-creator-string
11502 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
11504 The HTML exporter has delineations for preamble and postamble. The default
11505 value for @code{org-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which makes the HTML exporter
11506 insert the preamble. See the variable @code{org-html-preamble-format} for
11509 Set @code{org-html-preamble} to a string to override the default format
11510 string. If the string is a function, the HTML exporter expects the function
11511 to return a string upon execution. The HTML exporter inserts this string in
11512 the preamble. The HTML exporter will not insert a preamble if
11513 @code{org-html-preamble} is set @code{nil}.
11515 The default value for @code{org-html-postamble} is @code{auto}, which makes
11516 the HTML exporter build a postamble from looking up author's name, email
11517 address, creator's name, and date. Set @code{org-html-postamble} to @code{t}
11518 to insert the postamble in the format specified in the
11519 @code{org-html-postamble-format} variable. The HTML exporter will not insert
11520 a postamble if @code{org-html-postamble} is set to @code{nil}.
11522 @node Quoting HTML tags
11523 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
11525 The HTML export back-end transforms @samp{<} and @samp{>} to @samp{<} and
11526 @samp{>}. To include raw HTML code in the Org file so the HTML export
11527 back-end can insert that HTML code in the output, use this inline syntax:
11528 @samp{@@@@html:}. For example: @samp{@@@@html:<b>@@@@bold
11529 text@@@@html:</b>@@@@}. For larger raw HTML code blocks, use these HTML
11530 export code blocks:
11533 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXPORT html
11535 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
11539 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXPORT html
11542 #+BEGIN_EXPORT html
11543 All lines between these markers are exported literally
11548 @node Links in HTML export
11549 @subsection Links in HTML export
11551 @cindex links, in HTML export
11552 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
11553 @cindex external links, in HTML export
11554 @vindex org-html-link-org-files-as-html
11555 The HTML export back-end transforms Org's internal links (@pxref{Internal
11556 links}) to equivalent HTML links in the output. The back-end similarly
11557 handles Org's automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
11558 targets}) similarly. For Org links to external files, the back-end
11559 transforms the links to @emph{relative} paths.
11561 For Org links to other @file{.org} files, the back-end automatically changes
11562 the file extension to @file{.html} and makes file paths relative. If the
11563 @file{.org} files have an equivalent @file{.html} version at the same
11564 location, then the converted links should work without any further manual
11565 intervention. However, to disable this automatic path translation, set
11566 @code{org-html-link-org-files-as-html} to @code{nil}. When disabled, the
11567 HTML export back-end substitutes the @samp{id:}-based links in the HTML
11568 output. For more about linking files when publishing to a directory,
11569 @pxref{Publishing links}.
11571 Org files can also have special directives to the HTML export back-end. For
11572 example, by using @code{#+ATTR_HTML} lines to specify new format attributes
11573 to @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. This example shows changing the link's
11574 @code{title} and @code{style}:
11576 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
11578 #+ATTR_HTML: :title The Org mode homepage :style color:red;
11579 [[http://orgmode.org]]
11582 @node Tables in HTML export
11583 @subsection Tables in HTML export
11584 @cindex tables, in HTML
11585 @vindex org-html-table-default-attributes
11587 The HTML export back-end uses @code{org-html-table-default-attributes} when
11588 exporting Org tables to HTML. By default, the exporter does not draw frames
11589 and cell borders. To change for this for a table, use the following lines
11590 before the table in the Org file:
11593 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
11595 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
11596 #+ATTR_HTML: :border 2 :rules all :frame border
11599 The HTML export back-end preserves column groupings in Org tables
11600 (@pxref{Column groups}) when exporting to HTML.
11602 Additional options for customizing tables for HTML export.
11605 @vindex org-html-table-align-individual-fields
11606 @item org-html-table-align-individual-fields
11607 Non-@code{nil} attaches style attributes for alignment to each table field.
11609 @vindex org-html-table-caption-above
11610 @item org-html-table-caption-above
11611 Non-@code{nil} places caption string at the beginning of the table.
11613 @vindex org-html-table-data-tags
11614 @item org-html-table-data-tags
11615 Opening and ending tags for table data fields.
11617 @vindex org-html-table-default-attributes
11618 @item org-html-table-default-attributes
11619 Default attributes and values for table tags.
11621 @vindex org-html-table-header-tags
11622 @item org-html-table-header-tags
11623 Opening and ending tags for table's header fields.
11625 @vindex org-html-table-row-tags
11626 @item org-html-table-row-tags
11627 Opening and ending tags for table rows.
11629 @vindex org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column
11630 @item org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column
11631 Non-@code{nil} formats column one in tables with header tags.
11634 @node Images in HTML export
11635 @subsection Images in HTML export
11637 @cindex images, inline in HTML
11638 @cindex inlining images in HTML
11639 @vindex org-html-inline-images
11641 The HTML export back-end has features to convert Org image links to HTML
11642 inline images and HTML clickable image links.
11644 When the link in the Org file has no description, the HTML export back-end by
11645 default in-lines that image. For example: @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} is
11646 in-lined, while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} links to the text,
11649 For more details, see the variable @code{org-html-inline-images}.
11651 On the other hand, if the description part of the Org link is itself another
11652 link, such as @code{file:} or @code{http:} URL pointing to an image, the HTML
11653 export back-end in-lines this image and links to the main image. This Org
11654 syntax enables the back-end to link low-resolution thumbnail to the
11655 high-resolution version of the image, as shown in this example:
11658 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
11661 To change attributes of in-lined images, use @code{#+ATTR_HTML} lines in the
11662 Org file. This example shows realignment to right, and adds @code{alt} and
11663 @code{title} attributes in support of text viewers and modern web accessibility
11667 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
11669 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
11670 #+ATTR_HTML: :alt cat/spider image :title Action! :align right
11675 The HTML export back-end copies the @code{http} links from the Org file as
11678 @node Math formatting in HTML export
11679 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
11683 @cindex imagemagick
11685 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
11686 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use
11687 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax} which should work out of the box with
11688 Org@footnote{By default Org loads MathJax from @uref{https://cdnjs.com, cdnjs.com} as
11689 recommended by @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax}.}. Some MathJax display
11690 options can be configured via @code{org-html-mathjax-options}, or in the
11691 buffer. For example, with the following settings,
11693 #+HTML_MATHJAX: align: left indent: 5em tagside: left font: Neo-Euler
11695 equation labels will be displayed on the left marign and equations will be
11696 five ems from the left margin.
11698 @noindent See the docstring of
11699 @code{org-html-mathjax-options} for all supported variables. The MathJax
11700 template can be configure via @code{org-html-mathjax-template}.
11702 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
11703 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
11704 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
11705 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program, @file{dvisvgm} or
11706 @file{imagemagick} suite is available on your system. You can still get
11707 this processing with
11710 #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng
11714 #+OPTIONS: tex:dvisvgm
11720 #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick
11723 @node Text areas in HTML export
11724 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
11726 @cindex text areas, in HTML
11727 Before Org mode's Babel, one popular approach to publishing code in HTML was
11728 by using @code{:textarea}. The advantage of this approach was that copying
11729 and pasting was built into browsers with simple JavaScript commands. Even
11730 editing before pasting was made simple.
11732 The HTML export back-end can create such text areas. It requires an
11733 @code{#+ATTR_HTML:} line as shown in the example below with the
11734 @code{:textarea} option. This must be followed by either an
11735 @code{example} or a @code{src} code block. Other Org block types will not
11736 honor the @code{:textarea} option.
11738 By default, the HTML export back-end creates a text area 80 characters wide
11739 and height just enough to fit the content. Override these defaults with
11740 @code{:width} and @code{:height} options on the @code{#+ATTR_HTML:} line.
11743 #+ATTR_HTML: :textarea t :width 40
11745 (defun org-xor (a b)
11753 @subsection CSS support
11754 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
11755 @cindex HTML export, CSS
11757 @vindex org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
11758 @vindex org-html-tag-class-prefix
11759 You can modify the CSS style definitions for the exported file. The HTML
11760 exporter assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on
11761 TODO keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
11762 @code{org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and @code{org-html-tag-class-prefix} to
11763 make them unique.} to appropriate parts of the document---your style
11764 specifications may change these, in addition to any of the standard classes
11765 like for headlines, tables, etc.
11767 p.author @r{author information, including email}
11768 p.date @r{publishing date}
11769 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
11770 .title @r{document title}
11771 .subtitle @r{document subtitle}
11772 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
11773 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
11774 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
11775 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
11776 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
11777 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
11778 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
11779 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
11780 .target @r{target for links}
11781 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
11782 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
11783 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
11784 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
11785 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
11786 .figure-number @r{label like "Figure 1:"}
11787 .table-number @r{label like "Table 1:"}
11788 .listing-number @r{label like "Listing 1:"}
11789 div.figure @r{how to format an in-lined image}
11790 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
11791 pre.example @r{normal example}
11792 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
11793 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
11794 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
11795 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
11796 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
11797 .org-svg @r{default class for a linked @file{.svg} image}
11800 @vindex org-html-style-default
11801 @vindex org-html-head-include-default-style
11802 @vindex org-html-head
11803 @vindex org-html-head-extra
11804 @cindex #+HTML_INCLUDE_STYLE
11805 The HTML export back-end includes a compact default style in each exported
11806 HTML file. To override the default style with another style, use these
11807 keywords in the Org file. They will replace the global defaults the HTML
11810 @cindex #+HTML_HEAD
11811 @cindex #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA
11813 #+HTML_HEAD: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="style1.css" />
11814 #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA: <link rel="alternate stylesheet" type="text/css" href="style2.css" />
11817 To just turn off the default style, customize
11818 @code{org-html-head-include-default-style} variable, or use this option line in
11822 #+OPTIONS: html-style:nil
11826 For longer style definitions, either use several @code{#+HTML_HEAD} and
11827 @code{#+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA} lines, or use @code{<style>} @code{</style>} blocks
11828 around them. Both of these approaches can avoid referring to an external
11831 In order to add styles to a sub-tree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
11832 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
11833 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
11836 Never change the @code{org-html-style-default} constant. Instead use other
11837 simpler ways of customizing as described above.
11840 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
11841 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
11843 @node JavaScript support
11844 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
11846 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
11847 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
11848 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
11849 program enhances large files in two different ways of viewing. One is an
11850 @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
11851 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
11852 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
11853 one has a @emph{folding} view, much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
11854 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and the
11855 documentation at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}. The script
11856 is hosted on @url{http://orgmode.org}, but for reliability, prefer installing
11857 it on your own web server.
11859 To use this program, just add this line to the Org file:
11861 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
11863 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
11867 The HTML header now has the code needed to automatically invoke the script.
11868 For setting options, use the syntax from the above line for options described
11872 path: @r{The path to the script. The default grabs the script from}
11873 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
11874 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
11875 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
11876 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
11877 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
11878 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
11879 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
11880 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
11881 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
11882 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
11883 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
11884 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
11885 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
11886 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
11887 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
11888 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
11889 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
11890 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
11891 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
11892 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
11893 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
11894 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
11895 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
11896 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
11899 @vindex org-html-infojs-options
11900 @vindex org-html-use-infojs
11901 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
11902 @code{org-html-infojs-options}. If you want the script to always apply to
11903 your pages, configure the variable @code{org-html-use-infojs}.
11905 @node @LaTeX{} export
11906 @section @LaTeX{} export
11907 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
11910 The @LaTeX{} export back-end can handle complex documents, incorporate
11911 standard or custom @LaTeX{} document classes, generate documents using
11912 alternate @LaTeX{} engines, and produce fully linked PDF files with indexes,
11913 bibliographies, and tables of contents, destined for interactive online
11914 viewing or high-quality print publication.
11916 While the details are covered in-depth in this section, here are some quick
11917 references to variables for the impatient: for engines, see
11918 @code{org-latex-compiler}; for build sequences, see
11919 @code{org-latex-pdf-process}; for packages, see
11920 @code{org-latex-default-packages-alist} and @code{org-latex-packages-alist}.
11922 An important note about the @LaTeX{} export back-end: it is sensitive to
11923 blank lines in the Org document. That's because @LaTeX{} itself depends on
11924 blank lines to tell apart syntactical elements, such as paragraphs.
11927 * @LaTeX{} export commands:: For producing @LaTeX{} and PDF documents.
11928 * @LaTeX{} specific export settings:: Unique to this @LaTeX{} back-end.
11929 * @LaTeX{} header and sectioning:: For file structure.
11930 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Directly in the Org document.
11931 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to tables.
11932 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to images.
11933 * Plain lists in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to lists.
11934 * Source blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to source code blocks.
11935 * Example blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to example blocks.
11936 * Special blocks in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to special blocks.
11937 * Horizontal rules in @LaTeX{} export:: Attributes specific to horizontal rules.
11940 @node @LaTeX{} export commands
11941 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
11944 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l l,org-latex-export-to-latex}
11945 Export as @LaTeX{} file with a @file{.tex} extension. For @file{myfile.org},
11946 Org exports to @file{myfile.tex}, overwriting without warning. @kbd{C-c C-e
11947 l l} Exports to @LaTeX{} file.
11949 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l L,org-latex-export-as-latex}
11950 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
11951 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l p,org-latex-export-to-pdf}
11952 Export as @LaTeX{} file and convert it to PDF file.
11954 Export as @LaTeX{} file and convert it to PDF, then open the PDF using the default viewer.
11957 @vindex org-latex-compiler
11958 @vindex org-latex-bibtex-compiler
11959 @vindex org-latex-default-packages-alist
11960 The @LaTeX{} export back-end can use any of these @LaTeX{} engines:
11961 @samp{pdflatex}, @samp{xelatex}, and @samp{lualatex}. These engines compile
11962 @LaTeX{} files with different compilers, packages, and output options. The
11963 @LaTeX{} export back-end finds the compiler version to use from
11964 @code{org-latex-compiler} variable or the @code{#+LATEX_COMPILER} keyword in
11965 the Org file. See the docstring for the
11966 @code{org-latex-default-packages-alist} for loading packages with certain
11967 compilers. Also see @code{org-latex-bibtex-compiler} to set the bibliography
11968 compiler@footnote{This does not allow setting different bibliography
11969 compilers for different files. However, ``smart'' @LaTeX{} compilation
11970 systems, such as @samp{latexmk}, can select the correct bibliography
11973 @node @LaTeX{} specific export settings
11974 @subsection @LaTeX{} specific export settings
11976 The @LaTeX{} export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing
11977 @LaTeX{} output. Setting these keywords works similar to the general options
11978 (@pxref{Export settings}).
11982 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION (@LaTeX{})
11983 The document's description. The description along with author name,
11984 keywords, and related file metadata are inserted in the output file by the
11985 @samp{hyperref} package. See @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} for
11986 customizing metadata items. See @code{org-latex-title-command} for
11987 typesetting description into the document's front matter. Use multiple
11988 @code{#+DESCRIPTION} lines for long descriptions.
11991 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
11992 @vindex org-latex-default-class
11993 @vindex org-latex-classes
11994 This is @LaTeX{} document class, such as @code{article}, @code{report},
11995 @code{book}, and so on, which contain predefined preamble and headline level
11996 mapping that the @LaTeX{} export back-end needs. The back-end reads the
11997 default class name from the @code{org-latex-default-class} variable. Org has
11998 @code{article} as the default class. A valid default class must be an
11999 element of @code{org-latex-classes}.
12001 @item LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
12002 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
12003 Options the @LaTeX{} export back-end uses when calling the @LaTeX{} document
12006 @item LATEX_COMPILER
12007 @cindex #+LATEX_COMPILER
12008 @vindex org-latex-compiler
12009 The compiler, such as @samp{pdflatex}, @samp{xelatex}, @samp{lualatex}, for
12010 producing the PDF (@code{org-latex-compiler}).
12013 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
12014 @vindex org-latex-classes
12015 Arbitrary lines to add to the document's preamble, before the @samp{hyperref}
12016 settings. See @code{org-latex-classes} for adjusting the structure and order
12017 of the @LaTeX{} headers.
12019 @item LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA
12020 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA
12021 @vindex org-latex-classes
12022 Arbitrary lines to add to the document's preamble, before the @samp{hyperref}
12023 settings. See @code{org-latex-classes} for adjusting the structure and order
12024 of the @LaTeX{} headers.
12027 @cindex #+KEYWORDS (@LaTeX{})
12028 The keywords for the document. The description along with author name,
12029 keywords, and related file metadata are inserted in the output file by the
12030 @samp{hyperref} package. See @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} for
12031 customizing metadata items. See @code{org-latex-title-command} for
12032 typesetting description into the document's front matter. Use multiple
12033 @code{#+KEYWORDS} lines if necessary.
12036 @cindex #+SUBTITLE (@LaTeX{})
12037 @vindex org-latex-subtitle-separate
12038 @vindex org-latex-subtitle-format
12039 The document's subtitle. It is typeset as per
12040 @code{org-latex-subtitle-format}. If @code{org-latex-subtitle-separate} is
12041 non-@code{nil}, it is typed as part of the @samp{\title}-macro. See
12042 @code{org-latex-hyperref-template} for customizing metadata items. See
12043 @code{org-latex-title-command} for typesetting description into the
12044 document's front matter.
12047 The following sections have further details.
12049 @node @LaTeX{} header and sectioning
12050 @subsection @LaTeX{} header and sectioning structure
12051 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
12052 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
12053 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
12054 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
12055 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
12057 The @LaTeX{} export back-end converts the first three of Org's outline levels
12058 into @LaTeX{} headlines. The remaining Org levels are exported as
12059 @code{itemize} or @code{enumerate} lists. To change this globally for the
12060 cut-off point between levels and lists, (@pxref{Export settings}).
12062 By default, the @LaTeX{} export back-end uses the @code{article} class.
12064 @vindex org-latex-default-class
12065 @vindex org-latex-classes
12066 @vindex org-latex-default-packages-alist
12067 @vindex org-latex-packages-alist
12068 To change the default class globally, edit @code{org-latex-default-class}.
12069 To change the default class locally in an Org file, add option lines
12070 @code{#+LATEX_CLASS: myclass}. To change the default class for just a part
12071 of the Org file, set a sub-tree property, @code{EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS}. The
12072 class name entered here must be valid member of @code{org-latex-classes}.
12073 This variable defines a header template for each class into which the
12074 exporter splices the values of @code{org-latex-default-packages-alist} and
12075 @code{org-latex-packages-alist}. Use the same three variables to define
12076 custom sectioning or custom classes.
12078 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
12079 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
12080 @cindex property, EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS
12081 @cindex property, EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
12082 The @LaTeX{} export back-end sends the @code{LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS} keyword and
12083 @code{EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS} property as options to the @LaTeX{}
12084 @code{\documentclass} macro. The options and the syntax for specifying them,
12085 including enclosing them in square brackets, follow @LaTeX{} conventions.
12088 #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper,11pt,twoside,twocolumn]
12091 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
12092 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA
12093 The @LaTeX{} export back-end appends values from @code{LATEX_HEADER} and
12094 @code{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA} keywords to the @LaTeX{} header. The docstring for
12095 @code{org-latex-classes} explains in more detail. Also note that @LaTeX{}
12096 export back-end does not append @code{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA} to the header when
12097 previewing @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments}).
12099 A sample Org file with the above headers:
12102 #+LATEX_CLASS: article
12103 #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
12104 #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
12112 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code
12113 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
12115 The @LaTeX{} export back-end can insert any arbitrary @LaTeX{} code,
12116 @pxref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}. There are three ways to embed such code in the
12117 Org file and they all use different quoting syntax.
12119 Inserting in-line quoted with @ symbols:
12120 @cindex inline, in @LaTeX{} export
12122 Code embedded in-line @@@@latex:any arbitrary LaTeX code@@@@ in a paragraph.
12125 Inserting as one or more keyword lines in the Org file:
12128 #+LATEX: any arbitrary LaTeX code
12131 Inserting as an export block in the Org file, where the back-end exports any
12132 code between begin and end markers:
12133 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXPORT latex
12135 #+BEGIN_EXPORT latex
12136 any arbitrary LaTeX code
12140 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export
12141 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
12142 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
12143 @cindex #+ATTR_LATEX, in tables
12145 The @LaTeX{} export back-end can pass several @LaTeX{} attributes for table
12146 contents and layout. Besides specifying label and caption (@pxref{Images and
12147 tables}), the other valid @LaTeX{} attributes include:
12151 @vindex org-latex-default-table-mode
12152 The @LaTeX{} export back-end wraps the table differently depending on the
12153 mode for accurate rendering of math symbols. Mode is either @code{table},
12154 @code{math}, @code{inline-math} or @code{verbatim}. For @code{math} or
12155 @code{inline-math} mode, @LaTeX{} export back-end wraps the table in a math
12156 environment, but every cell in it is exported as-is. The @LaTeX{} export
12157 back-end determines the default mode from
12158 @code{org-latex-default-table-mode}. For , The @LaTeX{} export back-end
12159 merges contiguous tables in the same mode into a single environment.
12161 @vindex org-latex-default-table-environment
12162 Set the default @LaTeX{} table environment for the @LaTeX{} export back-end
12163 to use when exporting Org tables. Common @LaTeX{} table environments are
12164 provided by these packages: @code{tabularx}, @code{longtable}, @code{array},
12165 @code{tabu}, and @code{bmatrix}. For packages, such as @code{tabularx} and
12166 @code{tabu}, or any newer replacements, include them in the
12167 @code{org-latex-packages-alist} variable so the @LaTeX{} export back-end can
12168 insert the appropriate load package headers in the converted @LaTeX{} file.
12169 Look in the docstring for the @code{org-latex-packages-alist} variable for
12170 configuring these packages for @LaTeX{} snippet previews, if any.
12172 Use @code{#+CAPTION} keyword to set a simple caption for a table
12173 (@pxref{Images and tables}). For custom captions, use @code{:caption}
12174 attribute, which accepts raw @LaTeX{} code. @code{:caption} value overrides
12175 @code{#+CAPTION} value.
12178 The table environments by default are not floats in @LaTeX{}. To make them
12179 floating objects use @code{:float} with one of the following options:
12180 @code{sideways}, @code{multicolumn}, @code{t}, and @code{nil}. Note that
12181 @code{sidewaystable} has been deprecated since Org 8.3. @LaTeX{} floats can
12182 also have additional layout @code{:placement} attributes. These are the
12183 usual @code{[h t b p ! H]} permissions specified in square brackets. Note
12184 that for @code{:float sideways} tables, the @LaTeX{} export back-end ignores
12185 @code{:placement} attributes.
12189 The @LaTeX{} export back-end uses these attributes for regular tables to set
12190 their alignments, fonts, and widths.
12192 When @code{:spread} is non-@code{nil}, the @LaTeX{} export back-end spreads
12193 or shrinks the table by the @code{:width} for @code{tabu} and @code{longtabu}
12194 environments. @code{:spread} has no effect if @code{:width} is not set.
12198 @vindex org-latex-tables-booktabs
12199 @vindex org-latex-tables-centered
12200 All three commands are toggles. @code{:booktabs} brings in modern
12201 typesetting enhancements to regular tables. The @code{booktabs} package has
12202 to be loaded through @code{org-latex-packages-alist}. @code{:center} is for
12203 centering the table. @code{:rmlines} removes all but the very first
12204 horizontal line made of ASCII characters from "table.el" tables only.
12206 @itemx :math-suffix
12207 @itemx :math-arguments
12208 The @LaTeX{} export back-end inserts @code{:math-prefix} string value in a
12209 math environment before the table. The @LaTeX{} export back-end inserts
12210 @code{:math-suffix} string value in a math environment after the table. The
12211 @LaTeX{} export back-end inserts @code{:math-arguments} string value between
12212 the macro name and the table's contents. @code{:math-arguments} comes in use
12213 for matrix macros that require more than one argument, such as
12214 @code{qbordermatrix}.
12217 @LaTeX{} table attributes help formatting tables for a wide range of
12218 situations, such as matrix product or spanning multiple pages:
12221 #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment longtable :align l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
12225 #+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix :math-suffix \times
12228 #+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix
12233 Set the caption with the @LaTeX{} command
12234 @code{\bicaption@{HeadingA@}@{HeadingB@}}:
12237 #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption@{HeadingA@}@{HeadingB@}
12243 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export
12244 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
12245 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
12246 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
12247 @cindex #+ATTR_LATEX, in images
12249 The @LaTeX{} export back-end processes image links in Org files that do not
12250 have descriptions, such as these links @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or
12251 @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, as direct image insertions in the final PDF output. In
12252 the PDF, they are no longer links but actual images embedded on the page.
12253 The @LaTeX{} export back-end uses @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the
12254 image. But for TikZ@footnote{@url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/pgf/}}
12255 images, the back-end uses an @code{\input} macro wrapped within
12256 a @code{tikzpicture} environment.
12258 For specifying image @code{:width}, @code{:height}, and other
12259 @code{:options}, use this syntax:
12262 #+ATTR_LATEX: :width 5cm :options angle=90
12263 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
12266 For custom commands for captions, use the @code{:caption} attribute. It will
12267 override the default @code{#+CAPTION} value:
12270 #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption@{HeadingA@}@{HeadingB@}
12271 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
12274 When captions follow the method as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the
12275 @LaTeX{} export back-end wraps the picture in a floating @code{figure}
12276 environment. To float an image without specifying a caption, set the
12277 @code{:float} attribute to one of the following:
12280 @code{t}: for a standard @samp{figure} environment; used by default whenever
12281 an image has a caption.
12283 @code{multicolumn}: to span the image across multiple columns of a page; the
12284 back-end wraps the image in a @code{figure*} environment.
12286 @code{wrap}: for text to flow around the image on the right; the figure
12287 occupies the left half of the page.
12289 @code{sideways}: for a new page with the image sideways, rotated ninety
12290 degrees, in a @code{sidewaysfigure} environment; overrides @code{:placement}
12293 @code{nil}: to avoid a @code{:float} even if using a caption.
12296 Use the @code{placement} attribute to modify a floating environment's placement.
12299 #+ATTR_LATEX: :float wrap :width 0.38\textwidth :placement
12300 @{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@} [[./img/hst.png]]
12303 @vindex org-latex-images-centered
12304 @cindex center image (@LaTeX{} export)
12305 @cindex image, centering (@LaTeX{} export)
12307 The @LaTeX{} export back-end centers all images by default. Setting
12308 @code{:center} attribute to @code{nil} disables centering. To disable
12309 centering globally, set @code{org-latex-images-centered} to @code{t}.
12311 Set the @code{:comment-include} attribute to non-@code{nil} value for the
12312 @LaTeX{} export back-end to comment out the @code{\includegraphics} macro.
12314 @node Plain lists in @LaTeX{} export
12315 @subsection Plain lists in @LaTeX{} export
12316 @cindex plain lists, in @LaTeX{} export
12317 @cindex #+ATTR_LATEX, in plain lists
12319 The @LaTeX{} export back-end accepts the @code{:environment} and
12320 @code{:options} attributes for plain lists. Both attributes work together
12321 for customizing lists, as shown in the examples:
12324 #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage[inline]@{enumitem@}
12325 Some ways to say "Hello":
12326 #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment itemize*
12327 #+ATTR_LATEX: :options [label=@{@}, itemjoin=@{,@}, itemjoin*=@{, and@}]
12333 Since @LaTeX{} supports only four levels of nesting for lists, use an
12334 external package, such as @samp{enumitem} in @LaTeX{}, for levels deeper than
12338 #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{enumitem@}
12339 #+LATEX_HEADER: \renewlist@{itemize@}@{itemize@}@{9@}
12340 #+LATEX_HEADER: \setlist[itemize]@{label=$\circ$@}
12348 @node Source blocks in @LaTeX{} export
12349 @subsection Source blocks in @LaTeX{} export
12350 @cindex source blocks, in @LaTeX{} export
12351 @cindex #+ATTR_LATEX, in source blocks
12353 The @LaTeX{} export back-end can make source code blocks into floating
12354 objects through the attributes @code{:float} and @code{:options}. For
12359 @code{t}: makes a source block float; by default floats any source block with
12362 @code{multicolumn}: spans the source block across multiple columns of a page.
12364 @code{nil}: avoids a @code{:float} even if using a caption; useful for
12365 source code blocks that may not fit on a page.
12369 #+ATTR_LATEX: :float nil
12370 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12371 Lisp code that may not fit in a single page.
12375 @vindex org-latex-listings-options
12376 @vindex org-latex-minted-options
12377 The @LaTeX{} export back-end passes string values in @code{:options} to
12378 @LaTeX{} packages for customization of that specific source block. In the
12379 example below, the @code{:options} are set for Minted. Minted is a source
12380 code highlighting @LaTeX{}package with many configurable options.
12383 #+ATTR_LATEX: :options commentstyle=\bfseries
12384 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12386 (if (< n 2) n (+ (Fib (- n 1)) (Fib (- n 2)))))
12390 To apply similar configuration options for all source blocks in a file, use
12391 the @code{org-latex-listings-options} and @code{org-latex-minted-options}
12394 @node Example blocks in @LaTeX{} export
12395 @subsection Example blocks in @LaTeX{} export
12396 @cindex example blocks, in @LaTeX{} export
12397 @cindex verbatim blocks, in @LaTeX{} export
12398 @cindex #+ATTR_LATEX, in example blocks
12400 The @LaTeX{} export back-end wraps the contents of example blocks in a
12401 @samp{verbatim} environment. To change this behavior to use another
12402 environment globally, specify an appropriate export filter (@pxref{Advanced
12403 configuration}). To change this behavior to use another environment for each
12404 block, use the @code{:environment} parameter to specify a custom environment.
12407 #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment myverbatim
12409 This sentence is false.
12413 @node Special blocks in @LaTeX{} export
12414 @subsection Special blocks in @LaTeX{} export
12415 @cindex special blocks, in @LaTeX{} export
12416 @cindex abstract, in @LaTeX{} export
12417 @cindex proof, in @LaTeX{} export
12418 @cindex #+ATTR_LATEX, in special blocks
12421 For other special blocks in the Org file, the @LaTeX{} export back-end makes
12422 a special environment of the same name. The back-end also takes
12423 @code{:options}, if any, and appends as-is to that environment's opening
12424 string. For example:
12428 We demonstrate how to solve the Syracuse problem.
12431 #+ATTR_LATEX: :options [Proof of important theorem]
12434 Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes.
12443 We demonstrate how to solve the Syracuse problem.
12446 \begin@{proof@}[Proof of important theorem]
12448 Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes.
12452 If you need to insert a specific caption command, use @code{:caption}
12453 attribute. It will override standard @code{#+CAPTION} value, if any. For
12457 #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \MyCaption@{HeadingA@}
12463 @node Horizontal rules in @LaTeX{} export
12464 @subsection Horizontal rules in @LaTeX{} export
12465 @cindex horizontal rules, in @LaTeX{} export
12466 @cindex #+ATTR_LATEX, in horizontal rules
12468 The @LaTeX{} export back-end converts horizontal rules by the specified
12469 @code{:width} and @code{:thickness} attributes. For example:
12472 #+ATTR_LATEX: :width .6\textwidth :thickness 0.8pt
12476 @node Markdown export
12477 @section Markdown export
12478 @cindex Markdown export
12480 The Markdown export back-end, @code{md}, converts an Org file to a Markdown
12481 format, as defined at @url{http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/}.
12483 Since @code{md} is built on top of the HTML back-end, any Org constructs not
12484 supported by Markdown, such as tables, the underlying @code{html} back-end
12485 (@pxref{HTML export}) converts them.
12487 @subheading Markdown export commands
12490 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m m,org-md-export-to-markdown}
12491 Export to a text file with Markdown syntax. For @file{myfile.org}, Org
12492 exports to @file{myfile.md}, overwritten without warning.
12493 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m M,org-md-export-as-markdown}
12494 Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file.
12496 Export as a text file with Markdown syntax, then open it.
12499 @subheading Header and sectioning structure
12501 @vindex org-md-headline-style
12502 Based on @code{org-md-headline-style}, markdown export can generate headlines
12503 of both @code{atx} and @code{setext} types. @code{atx} limits headline
12504 levels to two. @code{setext} limits headline levels to six. Beyond these
12505 limits, the export back-end converts headlines to lists. To set a limit to a
12506 level before the absolute limit (@pxref{Export settings}).
12508 @c begin opendocument
12510 @node OpenDocument Text export
12511 @section OpenDocument Text export
12513 @cindex OpenDocument
12514 @cindex export, OpenDocument
12515 @cindex LibreOffice
12517 The ODT export back-end handles creating of OpenDocument Text (ODT) format
12518 files. The format complies with @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
12519 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
12520 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
12521 is compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
12524 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: Required packages.
12525 * ODT export commands:: Invoking export.
12526 * ODT specific export settings:: Configuration options.
12527 * Extending ODT export:: Producing @file{.doc}, @file{.pdf} files.
12528 * Applying custom styles:: Styling the output.
12529 * Links in ODT export:: Handling and formatting links.
12530 * Tables in ODT export:: Org table conversions.
12531 * Images in ODT export:: Inserting images.
12532 * Math formatting in ODT export:: Formatting @LaTeX{} fragments.
12533 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: Rendering objects.
12534 * Literal examples in ODT export:: For source code and example blocks.
12535 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: For power users.
12538 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export
12539 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
12541 The ODT export back-end relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
12542 compressed ODT output. Check if @file{zip} is locally available and
12543 executable. Without @file{zip}, export cannot finish.
12545 @node ODT export commands
12546 @subsection ODT export commands
12547 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
12548 @cindex region, active
12549 @cindex active region
12550 @cindex transient-mark-mode
12552 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o o,org-odt-export-to-odt}
12553 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
12555 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
12557 @vindex org-odt-preferred-output-format
12558 If @code{org-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, the ODT export
12559 back-end automatically converts the exported file to that format.
12560 @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically exporting to other formats}.
12562 For @file{myfile.org}, Org exports to @file{myfile.odt}, overwriting without
12563 warning. The ODT export back-end exports a region only if a region was
12564 active. Note for exporting active regions, the @code{transient-mark-mode}
12565 has to be turned on.
12567 If the selected region is a single tree, the ODT export back-end makes the
12568 tree head the document title. Incidentally, @kbd{C-c @@} selects the current
12569 sub-tree. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an
12570 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, the ODT export back-end uses that for file
12574 Export to an OpenDocument Text file format and open it.
12576 @vindex org-odt-preferred-output-format
12577 When @code{org-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the converted
12578 file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically exporting to
12582 @node ODT specific export settings
12583 @subsection ODT specific export settings
12584 The ODT export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing ODT
12585 output. Setting these keywords works similar to the general options
12586 (@pxref{Export settings}).
12590 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION (ODT)
12591 This is the document's description, which the ODT export back-end inserts as
12592 document metadata. For long descriptions, use multiple @code{#+DESCRIPTION}
12596 @cindex #+KEYWORDS (ODT)
12597 The keywords for the document. The ODT export back-end inserts the
12598 description along with author name, keywords, and related file metadata as
12599 metadata in the output file. Use multiple @code{#+KEYWORDS} lines if
12602 @item ODT_STYLES_FILE
12603 @cindex ODT_STYLES_FILE
12604 @vindex org-odt-styles-file
12605 The ODT export back-end uses the @code{org-odt-styles-file} by default. See
12606 @ref{Applying custom styles} for details.
12609 @cindex SUBTITLE (ODT)
12610 The document subtitle.
12613 @node Extending ODT export
12614 @subsection Extending ODT export
12616 The ODT export back-end can produce documents in other formats besides ODT
12617 using a specialized ODT converter process. Its common interface works with
12618 popular converters to produce formats such as @samp{doc}, or convert a
12619 document from one format, say @samp{csv}, to another format, say @samp{xls}.
12621 @cindex @file{unoconv}
12622 @cindex LibreOffice
12624 Customize @code{org-odt-convert-process} variable to point to @code{unoconv},
12625 which is the ODT's preferred converter. Working installations of LibreOffice
12626 would already have @code{unoconv} installed. Alternatively, other converters
12627 may be substituted here. @xref{Configuring a document converter}.
12629 @subsubheading Automatically exporting to other formats
12630 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
12632 @vindex org-odt-preferred-output-format
12633 If ODT format is just an intermediate step to get to other formats, such as
12634 @samp{doc}, @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, or @samp{pdf}, etc., then extend the ODT
12635 export back-end to directly produce that format. Specify the final format in
12636 the @code{org-odt-preferred-output-format} variable. This is one way to
12637 extend (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}).
12639 @subsubheading Converting between document formats
12640 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
12642 The Org export back-end is made to be inter-operable with a wide range of text
12643 document format converters. Newer generation converters, such as LibreOffice
12644 and Pandoc, can handle hundreds of formats at once. Org provides a
12645 consistent interaction with whatever converter is installed. Here are some
12648 @vindex org-odt-convert
12651 @item M-x org-odt-convert RET
12652 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
12653 argument, opens the newly produced file.
12656 @node Applying custom styles
12657 @subsection Applying custom styles
12658 @cindex styles, custom
12659 @cindex template, custom
12661 The ODT export back-end comes with many OpenDocument styles (@pxref{Working
12662 with OpenDocument style files}). To expand or further customize these
12663 built-in style sheets, either edit the style sheets directly or generate them
12664 using an application such as LibreOffice. The example here shows creating a
12665 style using LibreOffice.
12667 @subsubheading Applying custom styles: the easy way
12671 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with settings as shown below, and
12672 export it to ODT format.
12675 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
12679 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
12680 to locate the target styles, which typically have the @samp{Org} prefix.
12681 Open one, modify, and save as either OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or
12682 OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
12685 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
12686 @vindex org-odt-styles-file
12687 Customize the variable @code{org-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
12688 newly created file. For additional configuration options
12689 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
12691 To apply and ODT style to a particular file, use the @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE}
12692 option as shown in the example below:
12695 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
12701 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
12706 @subsubheading Using third-party styles and templates
12708 The ODT export back-end relies on many templates and style names. Using
12709 third-party styles and templates can lead to mismatches. Templates derived
12710 from built in ODT templates and styles seem to have fewer problems.
12712 @node Links in ODT export
12713 @subsection Links in ODT export
12714 @cindex links, in ODT export
12716 ODT export back-end creates native cross-references for internal links and
12717 Internet-style links for all other link types.
12719 A link with no description and pointing to a regular---un-itemized---outline
12720 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
12722 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc.@: is replaced
12723 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
12724 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
12726 @node Tables in ODT export
12727 @subsection Tables in ODT export
12728 @cindex tables, in ODT export
12730 The ODT export back-end handles native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and
12731 simple @file{table.el} tables. Complex @file{table.el} tables having column
12732 or row spans are not supported. Such tables are stripped from the exported
12735 By default, the ODT export back-end exports a table with top and bottom
12736 frames and with ruled lines separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column
12737 groups}). All tables are typeset to occupy the same width. The ODT export
12738 back-end honors any table alignments and relative widths for columns
12739 (@pxref{Column width and alignment}).
12741 Note that the ODT export back-end interprets column widths as weighted
12742 ratios, the default weight being 1.
12746 Specifying @code{:rel-width} property on an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line controls
12747 the width of the table. For example:
12750 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
12751 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
12752 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
12754 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
12755 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
12756 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
12757 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
12758 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
12759 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
12762 On export, the above table takes 50% of text width area. The exporter sizes
12763 the columns in the ratio: 13:5:5:5:6. The first column is left-aligned and
12764 rest of the columns, right-aligned. Vertical rules separate the header and
12765 the last column. Horizontal rules separate the header and the last row.
12767 For even more customization, create custom table styles and associate them
12768 with a table using the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in
12771 @node Images in ODT export
12772 @subsection Images in ODT export
12773 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
12774 @cindex embedding images in ODT
12776 @subsubheading Embedding images
12777 The ODT export back-end processes image links in Org files that do not have
12778 descriptions, such as these links @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or
12779 @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, as direct image insertions in the final output. Either
12780 of these examples works:
12790 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
12791 For clickable images, provide a link whose description is another link to an
12792 image file. For example, to embed a image @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which
12793 when clicked jumps to @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
12796 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
12799 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
12802 Control the size and scale of the embedded images with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT}
12805 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
12806 @vindex org-odt-pixels-per-inch
12807 The ODT export back-end starts with establishing the size of the image in the
12808 final document. The dimensions of this size is measured in centimeters. The
12809 back-end then queries the image file for its dimensions measured in pixels.
12810 For this measurement, the back-end relies on ImageMagick's @file{identify}
12811 program or Emacs @code{create-image} and @code{image-size} API. ImageMagick
12812 is the preferred choice for large file sizes or frequent batch operations.
12813 The back-end then converts the pixel dimensions using
12814 @code{org-odt-pixels-per-inch} into the familiar 72 dpi or 96 dpi. The
12815 default value for this is in @code{display-pixels-per-inch}, which can be
12816 tweaked for better results based on the capabilities of the output device.
12817 Here are some common image scaling operations:
12820 @item Explicitly size the image
12821 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
12824 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
12828 @item Scale the image
12829 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
12832 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
12836 @item Scale the image to a specific width
12837 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
12838 height:width ratio, do the following:
12841 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
12845 @item Scale the image to a specific height
12846 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
12847 height:width ratio, do the following
12850 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
12855 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
12858 The ODT export back-end can anchor images to @samp{"as-char"},
12859 @samp{"paragraph"}, or @samp{"page"}. Set the preferred anchor using the
12860 @code{:anchor} property of the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
12862 To create an image that is anchored to a page:
12864 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
12868 @node Math formatting in ODT export
12869 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
12871 The ODT export back-end has special support built-in for handling math.
12874 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: Embedding in @LaTeX{} format.
12875 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: Embedding in native format.
12878 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
12879 @subsubheading Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
12881 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in an ODT
12882 document in one of the following ways:
12888 Add this line to the Org file. This option is activated on a per-file basis.
12894 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
12895 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
12896 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
12897 the exported document.
12899 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
12900 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
12902 To specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter, customize the variables
12903 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
12904 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
12906 To use MathToWeb@footnote{See
12907 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}.} as the
12908 preferred converter, configure the above variables as
12911 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
12912 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
12913 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
12914 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
12916 To use @LaTeX{}ML@footnote{See @uref{http://dlmf.nist.gov/LaTeXML/}.} use
12918 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
12919 "latexmlmath \"%i\" --presentationmathml=%o")
12922 To quickly verify the reliability of the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter, use
12923 the following commands:
12926 @item M-x org-odt-export-as-odf RET
12927 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
12929 @item M-x org-odt-export-as-odf-and-open RET
12930 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
12931 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
12936 @cindex imagemagick
12939 Add this line to the Org file. This option is activated on a per-file basis.
12942 #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng
12946 #+OPTIONS: tex:dvisvgm
12952 #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick
12955 Under this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG or SVG images
12956 and the resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method
12957 requires @file{dvipng} program, @file{dvisvgm} or @file{imagemagick}
12961 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
12962 @subsubheading Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
12964 When embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in ODT documents is not reliable, there
12965 is one more option to try. Embed an equation by linking to its MathML
12966 (@file{.mml}) source or its OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown
12979 @node Labels and captions in ODT export
12980 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
12982 ODT format handles labeling and captioning of objects based on their
12983 types. Inline images, tables, @LaTeX{} fragments, and Math formulas are
12984 numbered and captioned separately. Each object also gets a unique sequence
12985 number based on its order of first appearance in the Org file. Each category
12986 has its own sequence. A caption is just a label applied to these objects.
12989 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
12990 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
12994 When rendered, it may show as follows in the exported document:
12997 Figure 2: Bell curve
13000 @vindex org-odt-category-map-alist
13001 To modify the category component of the caption, customize the option
13002 @code{org-odt-category-map-alist}. For example, to tag embedded images with
13003 the string @samp{Illustration} instead of the default string @samp{Figure},
13004 use the following setting:
13007 (setq org-odt-category-map-alist
13008 '(("__Figure__" "Illustration" "value" "Figure" org-odt--enumerable-image-p)))
13011 With the above modification, the previous example changes to:
13014 Illustration 2: Bell curve
13017 @node Literal examples in ODT export
13018 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
13020 The ODT export back-end supports literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples})
13021 with full fontification. Internally, the ODT export back-end relies on
13022 @file{htmlfontify.el} to generate the style definitions needed for fancy
13023 listings. The auto-generated styles get @samp{OrgSrc} prefix and inherit
13024 colors from the faces used by Emacs @code{font-lock} library for that source
13027 @vindex org-odt-fontify-srcblocks
13028 For custom fontification styles, customize the
13029 @code{org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks} option.
13031 @vindex org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
13032 To turn off fontification of literal examples, customize the
13033 @code{org-odt-fontify-srcblocks} option.
13035 @node Advanced topics in ODT export
13036 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
13038 The ODT export back-end has extensive features useful for power users and
13039 frequent uses of ODT formats.
13042 * Configuring a document converter:: Registering a document converter.
13043 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Exploring internals.
13044 * Creating one-off styles:: Customizing styles, highlighting.
13045 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: Defining table templates.
13046 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: Debugging corrupted OpenDocument files.
13049 @node Configuring a document converter
13050 @subsubheading Configuring a document converter
13052 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
13055 The ODT export back-end works with popular converters with little or no extra
13056 configuration. @xref{Extending ODT export}. The following is for unsupported
13057 converters or tweaking existing defaults.
13060 @item Register the converter
13062 @vindex org-odt-convert-processes
13063 Add the name of the converter to the @code{org-odt-convert-processes}
13064 variable. Note that it also requires how the converter is invoked on the
13065 command line. See the variable's docstring for details.
13067 @item Configure its capabilities
13069 @vindex org-odt-convert-capabilities
13070 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities} Specify which formats the converter can
13071 handle by customizing the variable @code{org-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use
13072 the entry for the default values in this variable for configuring the new
13073 converter. Also see its docstring for details.
13075 @item Choose the converter
13077 @vindex org-odt-convert-process
13078 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
13079 option @code{org-odt-convert-process}.
13082 @node Working with OpenDocument style files
13083 @subsubheading Working with OpenDocument style files
13084 @cindex styles, custom
13085 @cindex template, custom
13087 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter; the means by which
13088 it produces styled documents; the use of automatic and custom OpenDocument
13091 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
13092 @subsubheading a) Factory styles
13094 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
13095 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
13096 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
13099 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
13101 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
13103 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
13104 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
13108 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
13111 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
13115 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
13117 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
13119 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
13120 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
13121 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
13123 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
13124 file serves the following purposes:
13128 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
13132 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
13133 elements that control numbering of tables, images, equations, and similar
13138 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
13139 @subsubheading b) Overriding factory styles
13140 The following two variables control the location from where the ODT exporter
13141 picks up the custom styles and content template files. Customize these
13142 variables to override the factory styles used by the exporter.
13145 @anchor{x-org-odt-styles-file}
13147 @code{org-odt-styles-file}
13149 The ODT export back-end uses the file pointed to by this variable, such as
13150 @file{styles.xml}, for the final output. It can take one of the following
13154 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
13156 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
13158 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
13160 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
13163 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
13165 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
13166 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
13167 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
13169 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
13170 like header and footer images.
13174 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
13177 @anchor{x-org-odt-content-template-file}
13179 @code{org-odt-content-template-file}
13181 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
13182 in the final output.
13185 @node Creating one-off styles
13186 @subsubheading Creating one-off styles
13188 The ODT export back-end can read embedded raw OpenDocument XML from the Org
13189 file. Such direct formatting are useful for one-off instances.
13192 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
13194 Enclose OpenDocument syntax in @samp{@@@@odt:...@@@@} for inline markup. For
13195 example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
13198 @@@@odt:<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is highlighted
13199 text</text:span>@@@@. But this is regular text.
13202 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit the @file{styles.xml}
13203 (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a custom
13204 @samp{Highlight} style as shown below:
13207 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
13208 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
13212 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
13214 The ODT export back-end can read one-liner options with @code{#+ODT:}
13215 in the Org file. For example, to force a page break:
13218 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
13221 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
13222 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
13223 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
13226 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
13227 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
13228 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
13232 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
13234 The ODT export back-end can also read ODT export blocks for OpenDocument XML.
13235 Such blocks use the @code{#+BEGIN_EXPORT odt}@dots{}@code{#+END_EXPORT}
13238 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
13243 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
13244 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
13251 @node Customizing tables in ODT export
13252 @subsubheading Customizing tables in ODT export
13253 @cindex tables, in ODT export
13256 Override the default table format by specifying a custom table style with the
13257 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default formatting of tables
13258 @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
13260 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
13262 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
13263 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
13265 @vindex org-odt-table-styles
13266 For quick preview of this feature, install the settings below and export the
13267 table that follows:
13270 (setq org-odt-table-styles
13271 (append org-odt-table-styles
13272 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
13273 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
13274 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
13275 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
13276 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
13277 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
13281 #+ATTR_ODT: :style TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn
13282 | Name | Phone | Age |
13283 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
13284 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
13287 The example above used @samp{Custom} template and installed two table styles
13288 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}.
13289 @strong{Important:} The OpenDocument styles needed for producing the above
13290 template were pre-defined. They are available in the section marked
13291 @samp{Custom Table Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
13292 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}. For adding new
13293 templates, define new styles here.
13295 To use this feature proceed as follows:
13299 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
13300 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
13302 A table template is set of @samp{table-cell} and @samp{paragraph} styles for
13303 each of the following table cell categories:
13317 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
13318 template using a well-defined convention.
13320 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
13321 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
13322 the following table.
13324 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
13325 @headitem Table cell type
13326 @tab @code{table-cell} style
13327 @tab @code{paragraph} style
13332 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
13333 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
13335 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
13336 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
13338 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
13339 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
13341 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
13342 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
13344 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
13345 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
13347 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
13348 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
13350 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
13351 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
13353 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
13354 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
13356 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
13357 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
13360 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
13362 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
13363 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
13367 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
13368 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
13369 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
13370 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
13371 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
13372 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
13374 @vindex org-odt-table-styles
13375 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
13376 @code{org-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
13379 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
13380 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
13383 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
13384 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
13385 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
13386 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
13389 (setq org-odt-table-styles
13390 (append org-odt-table-styles
13391 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
13392 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
13393 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
13394 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
13395 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
13396 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
13400 Associate a table with the table style
13402 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
13403 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
13406 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
13407 | Name | Phone | Age |
13408 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
13409 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
13413 @node Validating OpenDocument XML
13414 @subsubheading Validating OpenDocument XML
13416 Sometimes ODT format files may not open due to @file{.odt} file corruption.
13417 To verify if the @file{.odt} file is corrupt, validate it against the
13418 OpenDocument RELAX NG Compact Syntax---RNC---schema. But first the
13419 @file{.odt} files have to be decompressed using @samp{zip}. Note that
13420 @file{.odt} files are @samp{zip} archives: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}.
13421 The contents of @file{.odt} files are in @file{.xml}. For general help with
13422 validation---and schema-sensitive editing---of XML files:
13423 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
13425 @vindex org-odt-schema-dir
13426 Customize @code{org-odt-schema-dir} to point to a directory with OpenDocument
13427 @file{.rnc} files and the needed schema-locating rules. The ODT export
13428 back-end takes care of updating the @code{rng-schema-locating-files}.
13430 @c end opendocument
13433 @section Org export
13436 @code{org} export back-end creates a normalized version of the Org document
13437 in current buffer. The exporter evaluates Babel code (@pxref{Evaluating code
13438 blocks}) and removes content specific to other back-ends.
13440 @subheading Org export commands
13443 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O o,org-org-export-to-org}
13444 Export as an Org file with a @file{.org} extension. For @file{myfile.org},
13445 Org exports to @file{myfile.org.org}, overwriting without warning.
13447 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O O,org-org-export-as-org}
13448 Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file.
13450 Export to an Org file, then open it.
13453 @node Texinfo export
13454 @section Texinfo export
13455 @cindex Texinfo export
13457 The @samp{texinfo} export back-end generates documents with Texinfo code that
13458 can compile to Info format.
13461 * Texinfo export commands:: Invoking commands.
13462 * Texinfo specific export settings:: Setting the environment.
13463 * Texinfo file header:: Generating the header.
13464 * Texinfo title and copyright page:: Creating preamble pages.
13465 * Info directory file:: Installing a manual in Info file hierarchy.
13466 * Headings and sectioning structure:: Building document structure.
13467 * Indices:: Creating indices.
13468 * Quoting Texinfo code:: Incorporating literal Texinfo code.
13469 * Plain lists in Texinfo export:: List attributes.
13470 * Tables in Texinfo export:: Table attributes.
13471 * Images in Texinfo export:: Image attributes.
13472 * Special blocks in Texinfo export:: Special block attributes.
13473 * A Texinfo example:: Processing Org to Texinfo.
13476 @node Texinfo export commands
13477 @subsection Texinfo export commands
13479 @vindex org-texinfo-info-process
13481 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i t,org-texinfo-export-to-texinfo}
13482 Export as a Texinfo file with @file{.texi} extension. For @file{myfile.org},
13483 Org exports to @file{myfile.texi}, overwriting without warning.
13484 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i i,org-texinfo-export-to-info}
13485 Export to Texinfo format first and then process it to make an Info file. To
13486 generate other formats, such as DocBook, customize the
13487 @code{org-texinfo-info-process} variable.
13490 @node Texinfo specific export settings
13491 @subsection Texinfo specific export settings
13492 The Texinfo export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing
13493 Texinfo output. Setting these keywords works similar to the general options
13494 (@pxref{Export settings}).
13499 @cindex #+SUBTITLE (Texinfo)
13500 The document subtitle.
13503 @cindex #+SUBAUTHOR
13504 The document subauthor.
13506 @item TEXINFO_FILENAME
13507 @cindex #+TEXINFO_FILENAME
13508 The Texinfo filename.
13510 @item TEXINFO_CLASS
13511 @cindex #+TEXINFO_CLASS
13512 @vindex org-texinfo-default-class
13513 The default document class (@code{org-texinfo-default-class}), which must be
13514 a member of @code{org-texinfo-classes}.
13516 @item TEXINFO_HEADER
13517 @cindex #+TEXINFO_HEADER
13518 Arbitrary lines inserted at the end of the header.
13520 @item TEXINFO_POST_HEADER
13521 @cindex #+TEXINFO_POST_HEADER
13522 Arbitrary lines inserted after the end of the header.
13524 @item TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY
13525 @cindex #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY
13526 The directory category of the document.
13528 @item TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE
13529 @cindex #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE
13530 The directory title of the document.
13532 @item TEXINFO_DIR_DESC
13533 @cindex #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC
13534 The directory description of the document.
13536 @item TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE
13537 @cindex #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE
13538 The printed title of the document.
13541 @node Texinfo file header
13542 @subsection Texinfo file header
13544 @cindex #+TEXINFO_FILENAME
13545 After creating the header for a Texinfo file, the Texinfo back-end
13546 automatically generates a name and destination path for the Info file. To
13547 override this default with a more sensible path and name, specify the
13548 @code{#+TEXINFO_FILENAME} keyword.
13550 @vindex org-texinfo-coding-system
13551 @vindex org-texinfo-classes
13552 @cindex #+TEXINFO_HEADER
13553 @cindex #+TEXINFO_CLASS
13554 Along with the output's file name, the Texinfo header also contains language
13555 details (@pxref{Export settings}) and encoding system as set in the
13556 @code{org-texinfo-coding-system} variable. Insert @code{#+TEXINFO_HEADER}
13557 keywords for each additional command in the header, for example:
13558 @@code@{@@synindex@}.
13560 Instead of repeatedly installing the same set of commands, define a class in
13561 @code{org-texinfo-classes} once, and then activate it in the document by
13562 setting the @code{#+TEXINFO_CLASS} keyword to that class.
13564 @node Texinfo title and copyright page
13565 @subsection Texinfo title and copyright page
13567 @cindex #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE
13568 The default template for hard copy output has a title page with
13569 @code{#+TITLE} and @code{#+AUTHOR} (@pxref{Export settings}). To replace the
13570 regular @code{#+TITLE} with something different for the printed version, use
13571 the @code{#+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE} and @code{#+SUBTITLE} keywords. Both
13572 expect raw Texinfo code for setting their values.
13574 @cindex #+SUBAUTHOR
13575 If one @code{#+AUTHOR} is not sufficient, add multiple @code{#+SUBAUTHOR}
13576 keywords. They have to be set in raw Texinfo code.
13579 #+AUTHOR: Jane Smith
13580 #+SUBAUTHOR: John Doe
13581 #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: This Long Title@@inlinefmt@{tex,@@*@} Is Broken in @@TeX@{@}
13584 @cindex property, COPYING
13585 Copying material is defined in a dedicated headline with a non-@code{nil}
13586 @code{:COPYING:} property. The back-end inserts the contents within a
13587 @code{@@copying} command at the beginning of the document. The heading
13588 itself does not appear in the structure of the document.
13590 Copyright information is printed on the back of the title page.
13598 This is a short example of a complete Texinfo file, version 1.0.
13600 Copyright \copy 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13603 @node Info directory file
13604 @subsection Info directory file
13605 @cindex @samp{dir} file, in Texinfo export
13606 @cindex Texinfo export, @samp{dir} file
13607 @cindex Info directory file, in Texinfo export
13608 @cindex Texinfo export, Info directory file
13609 @cindex @code{install-info} parameters, in Texinfo export
13610 @cindex Texinfo export, @code{install-info} parameters
13612 @cindex #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY
13613 @cindex #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE
13614 @cindex #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC
13615 The end result of the Texinfo export process is the creation of an Info file.
13616 This Info file's metadata has variables for category, title, and description:
13617 @code{#+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY}, @code{#+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE}, and
13618 @code{#+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC} that establish where in the Info hierarchy the file
13621 Here is an example that writes to the Info directory file:
13624 #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Emacs
13625 #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: Org Mode: (org)
13626 #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Outline-based notes management and organizer
13629 @node Headings and sectioning structure
13630 @subsection Headings and sectioning structure
13632 @vindex org-texinfo-classes
13633 @vindex org-texinfo-default-class
13634 @cindex #+TEXINFO_CLASS
13635 The Texinfo export back-end uses a pre-defined scheme to convert Org
13636 headlines to an equivalent Texinfo structuring commands. A scheme like this
13637 maps top-level headlines to numbered chapters tagged as @code{@@chapter} and
13638 lower-level headlines to unnumbered chapters tagged as @code{@@unnumbered}.
13639 To override such mappings to introduce @code{@@part} or other Texinfo
13640 structuring commands, define a new class in @code{org-texinfo-classes}.
13641 Activate the new class with the @code{#+TEXINFO_CLASS} keyword. When no new
13642 class is defined and activated, the Texinfo export back-end defaults to the
13643 @code{org-texinfo-default-class}.
13645 If an Org headline's level has no associated Texinfo structuring command, or
13646 is below a certain threshold (@pxref{Export settings}), then the Texinfo
13647 export back-end makes it into a list item.
13649 @cindex property, APPENDIX
13650 The Texinfo export back-end makes any headline with a non-@code{nil}
13651 @code{:APPENDIX:} property into an appendix. This happens independent of the
13652 Org headline level or the @code{#+TEXINFO_CLASS}.
13654 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
13655 The Texinfo export back-end creates a menu entry after the Org headline for
13656 each regular sectioning structure. To override this with a shorter menu
13657 entry, use the @code{:ALT_TITLE:} property (@pxref{Table of contents}).
13658 Texinfo menu entries also have an option for a longer @code{:DESCRIPTION:}
13659 property. Here's an example that uses both to override the default menu
13663 * Controlling Screen Display
13665 :ALT_TITLE: Display
13666 :DESCRIPTION: Controlling Screen Display
13670 @cindex The Top node, in Texinfo export
13671 @cindex Texinfo export, Top node
13672 The text before the first headline belongs to the @samp{Top} node, i.e., the
13673 node in which a reader enters an Info manual. As such, it is expected not to
13674 appear in printed output generated from the @file{.texi} file. @inforef{The
13675 Top Node,,texinfo}, for more information.
13678 @subsection Indices
13681 @cindex concept index, in Texinfo export
13682 @cindex Texinfo export, index, concept
13684 @cindex function index, in Texinfo export
13685 @cindex Texinfo export, index, function
13687 @cindex keystroke index, in Texinfo export
13688 @cindex Texinfo export, keystroke index
13690 @cindex program index, in Texinfo export
13691 @cindex Texinfo export, program index
13693 @cindex data type index, in Texinfo export
13694 @cindex Texinfo export, data type index
13696 @cindex variable index, in Texinfo export
13697 @cindex Texinfo export, variable index
13698 The Texinfo export back-end recognizes these indexing keywords if used in the
13699 Org file: @code{#+CINDEX}, @code{#+FINDEX}, @code{#+KINDEX}, @code{#+PINDEX},
13700 @code{#+TINDEX}, and @code{#+VINDEX}. Write their value as verbatim Texinfo
13701 code; in particular, @samp{@{}, @samp{@}} and @samp{@@} characters need to be
13702 escaped with @samp{@@} if they not belong to a Texinfo command.
13705 #+CINDEX: Defining indexing entries
13708 @cindex property, INDEX
13709 For the back-end to generate an index entry for a headline, set the
13710 @code{:INDEX:} property to @samp{cp} or @samp{vr}. These abbreviations come
13711 from Texinfo that stand for concept index and variable index. The Texinfo
13712 manual has abbreviations for all other kinds of indexes. The back-end
13713 exports the headline as an unnumbered chapter or section command, and then
13714 inserts the index after its contents.
13723 @node Quoting Texinfo code
13724 @subsection Quoting Texinfo code
13726 Use any of the following three methods to insert or escape raw Texinfo code:
13729 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXPORT texinfo
13731 Richard @@@@texinfo:@@sc@{@@@@Stallman@@@@texinfo:@}@@@@ commence' GNU.
13733 #+TEXINFO: @@need800
13734 This paragraph is preceded by...
13736 #+BEGIN_EXPORT texinfo
13737 @@auindex Johnson, Mark
13738 @@auindex Lakoff, George
13742 @node Plain lists in Texinfo export
13743 @subsection Plain lists in Texinfo export
13744 @cindex #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in plain lists
13745 @cindex Two-column tables, in Texinfo export
13747 @cindex :table-type attribute, in Texinfo export
13748 The Texinfo export back-end by default converts description lists in the Org
13749 file using the default command @code{@@table}, which results in a table with
13750 two columns. To change this behavior, specify @code{:table-type} with
13751 @code{ftable} or @code{vtable} attributes. For more information,
13752 @inforef{Two-column Tables,,texinfo}.
13754 @vindex org-texinfo-table-default-markup
13755 @cindex :indic attribute, in Texinfo export
13756 The Texinfo export back-end by default also applies a text highlight based on
13757 the defaults stored in @code{org-texinfo-table-default-markup}. To override
13758 the default highlight command, specify another one with the @code{:indic}
13761 @cindex Multiple entries in two-column tables, in Texinfo export
13762 @cindex :sep attribute, in Texinfo export
13763 Org syntax is limited to one entry per list item. Nevertheless, the Texinfo
13764 export back-end can split that entry according to any text provided through
13765 the @code{:sep} attribute. Each part then becomes a new entry in the first
13766 column of the table.
13768 The following example illustrates all the attributes above:
13771 #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :table-type vtable :sep , :indic asis
13772 - foo, bar :: This is the common text for variables foo and bar.
13782 This is the common text for variables foo and bar.
13786 @node Tables in Texinfo export
13787 @subsection Tables in Texinfo export
13788 @cindex #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in tables
13790 When exporting tables, the Texinfo export back-end uses the widest cell width
13791 in each column. To override this and instead specify as fractions of line
13792 length, use the @code{:columns} attribute. See example below.
13795 #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :columns .5 .5
13796 | a cell | another cell |
13799 @node Images in Texinfo export
13800 @subsection Images in Texinfo export
13801 @cindex #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in images
13803 Insert a file link to the image in the Org file, and the Texinfo export
13804 back-end inserts the image. These links must have the usual supported image
13805 extensions and no descriptions. To scale the image, use @code{:width} and
13806 @code{:height} attributes. For alternate text, use @code{:alt} and specify
13807 the text using Texinfo code, as shown in the example:
13810 #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :width 1in :alt Alternate @@i@{text@}
13814 @node Special blocks in Texinfo export
13815 @subsection Special blocks
13816 @cindex #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in special blocks
13818 The Texinfo export back-end converts special blocks to commands with the same
13819 name. It also adds any @code{:options} attributes to the end of the command,
13820 as shown in this example:
13823 #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :options org-org-export-to-org ...
13825 A somewhat obsessive function.
13833 @@defun org-org-export-to-org ...
13834 A somewhat obsessive function.
13838 @node A Texinfo example
13839 @subsection A Texinfo example
13841 Here is a more detailed example Org file. @inforef{GNU Sample
13842 Texts,,texinfo} for an equivalent example using Texinfo code.
13845 #+TITLE: GNU Sample @{@{@{version@}@}@}
13846 #+SUBTITLE: for version @{@{@{version@}@}@}, @{@{@{updated@}@}@}
13847 #+AUTHOR: A.U. Thor
13848 #+EMAIL: bug-sample@@gnu.org
13850 #+OPTIONS: ':t toc:t author:t email:t
13853 #+MACRO: version 2.0
13854 #+MACRO: updated last updated 4 March 2014
13856 #+TEXINFO_FILENAME: sample.info
13857 #+TEXINFO_HEADER: @@syncodeindex pg cp
13859 #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Texinfo documentation system
13860 #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: sample: (sample)
13861 #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Invoking sample
13863 #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: GNU Sample
13865 This manual is for GNU Sample (version @{@{@{version@}@}@},
13866 @{@{@{updated@}@}@}).
13873 This manual is for GNU Sample (version @{@{@{version@}@}@},
13874 @{@{@{updated@}@}@}), which is an example in the Texinfo documentation.
13876 Copyright \copy 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13879 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this
13880 document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License,
13881 Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software
13882 Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts,
13883 and with no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in
13884 the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License".
13890 #+CINDEX: invoking @@command@{sample@}
13892 This is a sample manual. There is no sample program to invoke, but
13893 if there were, you could see its basic usage and command line
13896 * GNU Free Documentation License
13901 #+TEXINFO: @@include fdl.texi
13909 @node iCalendar export
13910 @section iCalendar export
13911 @cindex iCalendar export
13913 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
13914 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
13915 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
13916 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
13917 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
13918 A large part of Org mode's inter-operability success is its ability to easily
13919 export to or import from external applications. The iCalendar export
13920 back-end takes calendar data from Org files and exports to the standard
13923 The iCalendar export back-end can also incorporate TODO entries based on the
13924 configuration of the @code{org-icalendar-include-todo} variable. The
13925 back-end exports plain timestamps as VEVENT, TODO items as VTODO, and also
13926 create events from deadlines that are in non-TODO items. The back-end uses
13927 the deadlines and scheduling dates in Org TODO items for setting the start
13928 and due dates for the iCalendar TODO entry. Consult the
13929 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}
13930 variables for more details.
13932 For tags on the headline, the iCalendar export back-end makes them into
13933 iCalendar categories. To tweak the inheritance of tags and TODO states,
13934 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}. To assign clock
13935 alarms based on time, configure the @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} variable.
13937 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
13938 @cindex property, ID
13939 The iCalendar format standard requires globally unique identifier---UID---for
13940 each entry. The iCalendar export back-end creates UIDs during export. To
13941 save a copy of the UID in the Org file set the variable
13942 @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}. The back-end looks for the @code{:ID:}
13943 property of the entry for re-using the same UID for subsequent exports.
13945 Since a single Org entry can result in multiple iCalendar entries---as
13946 timestamp, deadline, scheduled item, or TODO item---Org adds prefixes to the
13947 UID, depending on which part of the Org entry triggered the creation of the
13948 iCalendar entry. Prefixing ensures UIDs remains unique, yet enable
13949 synchronization programs trace the connections.
13952 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c f,org-icalendar-export-to-ics}
13953 Create iCalendar entries from the current Org buffer and store them in the
13954 same directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
13955 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c a, org-icalendar-export-agenda-files}
13956 @vindex org-agenda-files
13957 Create iCalendar entries from Org files in @code{org-agenda-files} and store
13958 in a separate iCalendar file for each Org file.
13959 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c c,org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
13960 @vindex org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file
13961 Create a combined iCalendar file from Org files in @code{org-agenda-files}
13962 and write it to @code{org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file} file name.
13965 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13966 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
13967 @cindex property, SUMMARY
13968 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
13969 @cindex property, LOCATION
13970 The iCalendar export back-end includes SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION
13971 properties from the Org entries when exporting. To force the back-end to
13972 inherit the LOCATION property, configure the
13973 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} variable.
13975 When Org entries do not have SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION properties,
13976 the iCalendar export back-end derives the summary from the headline, and
13977 derives the description from the body of the Org item. The
13978 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} variable limits the maximum number of
13979 characters of the content are turned into its description.
13981 Exporting to iCalendar format depends in large part on the capabilities of
13982 the destination application. Some are more lenient than others. Consult the
13983 Org mode FAQ for advice on specific applications.
13985 @node Other built-in back-ends
13986 @section Other built-in back-ends
13987 @cindex export back-ends, built-in
13988 @vindex org-export-backends
13990 Other export back-ends included with Org are:
13993 @item @file{ox-man.el}: export to a man page.
13996 To activate such back-ends, either customize @code{org-export-backends} or
13997 load directly with @code{(require 'ox-man)}. On successful load, the
13998 back-end adds new keys in the export dispatcher (@pxref{The export
14001 Follow the comment section of such files, for example, @file{ox-man.el}, for
14002 usage and configuration details.
14004 @node Advanced configuration
14005 @section Advanced configuration
14009 @vindex org-export-before-processing-hook
14010 @vindex org-export-before-parsing-hook
14011 The export process executes two hooks before the actual exporting begins.
14012 The first hook, @code{org-export-before-processing-hook}, runs before any
14013 expansions of macros, Babel code, and include keywords in the buffer. The
14014 second hook, @code{org-export-before-parsing-hook}, runs before the buffer is
14015 parsed. Both hooks are specified as functions, see example below. Their main
14016 use is for heavy duty structural modifications of the Org content. For
14017 example, removing every headline in the buffer during export:
14021 (defun my-headline-removal (backend)
14022 "Remove all headlines in the current buffer.
14023 BACKEND is the export back-end being used, as a symbol."
14025 (lambda () (delete-region (point) (progn (forward-line) (point))))))
14027 (add-hook 'org-export-before-parsing-hook 'my-headline-removal)
14031 Note that the hook function must have a mandatory argument that is a symbol
14034 @subheading Filters
14036 @cindex Filters, exporting
14037 The Org export process relies on filters to process specific parts of
14038 conversion process. Filters are just lists of functions to be applied to
14039 certain parts for a given back-end. The output from the first function in
14040 the filter is passed on to the next function in the filter. The final output
14041 is the output from the final function in the filter.
14043 The Org export process has many filter sets applicable to different types of
14044 objects, plain text, parse trees, export options, and final output formats.
14045 The filters are named after the element type or object type:
14046 @code{org-export-filter-TYPE-functions}, where @code{TYPE} is the type
14047 targeted by the filter. Valid types are:
14049 @multitable @columnfractions .33 .33 .33
14062 @item export-snippet
14065 @item footnote-definition
14066 @tab footnote-reference
14068 @item horizontal-rule
14069 @tab inline-babel-call
14070 @tab inline-src-block
14075 @tab latex-environment
14076 @tab latex-fragment
14086 @item property-drawer
14092 @item statistics-cookie
14093 @tab strike-through
14106 Here is an example filter that replaces non-breaking spaces @code{~} in the
14107 Org buffer with @code{_} for the @LaTeX{} back-end.
14111 (defun my-latex-filter-nobreaks (text backend info)
14112 "Ensure \"_\" are properly handled in LaTeX export."
14113 (when (org-export-derived-backend-p backend 'latex)
14114 (replace-regexp-in-string "_" "~" text)))
14116 (add-to-list 'org-export-filter-plain-text-functions
14117 'my-latex-filter-nobreaks)
14121 A filter requires three arguments: the code to be transformed, the name of
14122 the back-end, and some optional information about the export process. The
14123 third argument can be safely ignored. Note the use of
14124 @code{org-export-derived-backend-p} predicate that tests for @code{latex}
14125 back-end or any other back-end, such as @code{beamer}, derived from
14128 @subheading Defining filters for individual files
14130 The Org export can filter not just for back-ends, but also for specific files
14131 through the @code{#+BIND} keyword. Here is an example with two filters; one
14132 removes brackets from time stamps, and the other removes strike-through text.
14133 The filter functions are defined in a @samp{src} code block in the same Org
14134 file, which is a handy location for debugging.
14137 #+BIND: org-export-filter-timestamp-functions (tmp-f-timestamp)
14138 #+BIND: org-export-filter-strike-through-functions (tmp-f-strike-through)
14139 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :exports results :results none
14140 (defun tmp-f-timestamp (s backend info)
14141 (replace-regexp-in-string "&[lg]t;\\|[][]" "" s))
14142 (defun tmp-f-strike-through (s backend info) "")
14146 @subheading Extending an existing back-end
14148 Some parts of the conversion process can be extended for certain elements so
14149 as to introduce a new or revised translation. That is how the HTML export
14150 back-end was extended to handle Markdown format. The extensions work
14151 seamlessly so any aspect of filtering not done by the extended back-end is
14152 handled by the original back-end. Of all the export customization in Org,
14153 extending is very powerful as it operates at the parser level.
14155 For this example, make the @code{ascii} back-end display the language used in
14156 a source code block. Also make it display only when some attribute is
14157 non-@code{nil}, like the following:
14160 #+ATTR_ASCII: :language t
14163 Then extend @code{ascii} back-end with a custom @code{my-ascii} back-end.
14167 (defun my-ascii-src-block (src-block contents info)
14168 "Transcode a SRC-BLOCK element from Org to ASCII.
14169 CONTENTS is nil. INFO is a plist used as a communication
14171 (if (not (org-export-read-attribute :attr_ascii src-block :language))
14172 (org-export-with-backend 'ascii src-block contents info)
14174 (format ",--[ %s ]--\n%s`----"
14175 (org-element-property :language src-block)
14176 (replace-regexp-in-string
14178 (org-element-normalize-string
14179 (org-export-format-code-default src-block info)))))))
14181 (org-export-define-derived-backend 'my-ascii 'ascii
14182 :translate-alist '((src-block . my-ascii-src-block)))
14186 The @code{my-ascii-src-block} function looks at the attribute above the
14187 current element. If not true, hands over to @code{ascii} back-end. If true,
14188 which it is in this example, it creates a box around the code and leaves room
14189 for the inserting a string for language. The last form creates the new
14190 back-end that springs to action only when translating @code{src-block} type
14193 To use the newly defined back-end, call the following from an Org buffer:
14196 (org-export-to-buffer 'my-ascii "*Org MY-ASCII Export*")
14199 Further steps to consider would be an interactive function, self-installing
14200 an item in the export dispatcher menu, and other user-friendly improvements.
14202 @node Export in foreign buffers
14203 @section Export in foreign buffers
14205 The export back-ends in Org often include commands to convert selected
14206 regions. A convenient feature of this in-place conversion is that the
14207 exported output replaces the original source. Here are such functions:
14210 @item org-html-convert-region-to-html
14211 Convert the selected region into HTML.
14212 @item org-latex-convert-region-to-latex
14213 Convert the selected region into @LaTeX{}.
14214 @item org-texinfo-convert-region-to-texinfo
14215 Convert the selected region into @code{Texinfo}.
14216 @item org-md-convert-region-to-md
14217 Convert the selected region into @code{MarkDown}.
14220 In-place conversions are particularly handy for quick conversion of tables
14221 and lists in foreign buffers. For example, turn on the minor mode @code{M-x
14222 orgstruct-mode} in an HTML buffer, then use the convenient Org keyboard
14223 commands to create a list, select it, and covert it to HTML with @code{M-x
14224 org-html-convert-region-to-html RET}.
14228 @chapter Publishing
14231 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
14232 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
14233 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
14234 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
14237 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
14238 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
14240 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
14243 * Configuration:: Defining projects
14244 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
14245 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
14246 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
14249 @node Configuration
14250 @section Configuration
14252 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
14253 and many other properties of a project.
14256 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
14257 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
14258 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
14259 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
14260 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
14261 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
14262 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
14263 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
14266 @node Project alist
14267 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
14268 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
14269 @cindex projects, for publishing
14271 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
14272 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
14273 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
14274 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
14277 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
14278 @r{i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
14280 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
14284 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
14285 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
14286 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
14287 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
14288 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
14289 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
14290 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
14293 @node Sources and destinations
14294 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
14295 @cindex directories, for publishing
14297 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
14298 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
14299 and where to put published files.
14301 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
14302 @item @code{:base-directory}
14303 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
14304 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
14305 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
14306 publish to a web server using a file name syntax appropriate for
14307 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
14308 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
14309 @item @code{:preparation-function}
14310 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
14311 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
14312 published. Each preparation function is called with a single argument, the
14313 project property list.
14314 @item @code{:completion-function}
14315 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
14316 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. Each
14317 completion function is called with a single argument, the project property
14322 @node Selecting files
14323 @subsection Selecting files
14324 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
14326 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
14327 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
14329 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14330 @item @code{:base-extension}
14331 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
14332 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
14333 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
14335 @item @code{:exclude}
14336 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
14337 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
14340 @item @code{:include}
14341 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
14342 and @code{:exclude}.
14344 @item @code{:recursive}
14345 @tab non-@code{nil} means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
14348 @node Publishing action
14349 @subsection Publishing action
14350 @cindex action, for publishing
14352 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
14353 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
14354 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
14355 @code{org-html-publish-to-html}, which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
14356 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
14357 @code{org-latex-publish-to-pdf} or as @code{ascii}, @code{Texinfo}, etc.,
14358 using the corresponding functions.
14360 If you want to publish the Org file as an @code{.org} file but with the
14361 @i{archived}, @i{commented} and @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use the
14362 function @code{org-org-publish-to-org}. This will produce @file{file.org}
14363 and put it in the publishing directory. If you want a htmlized version of
14364 this file, set the parameter @code{:htmlized-source} to @code{t}, it will
14365 produce @file{file.org.html} in the publishing directory@footnote{If the
14366 publishing directory is the same than the source directory, @file{file.org}
14367 will be exported as @file{file.org.org}, so probably don't want to do this.}.
14369 Other files like images only need to be copied to the publishing destination.
14370 For this you can use @code{org-publish-attachment}. For non-org files, you
14371 always need to specify the publishing function:
14373 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
14374 @item @code{:publishing-function}
14375 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
14376 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
14377 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
14378 @tab non-@code{nil} means, publish htmlized source.
14381 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
14382 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be published
14383 and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It should take
14384 the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any) and place the
14385 result into the destination folder.
14387 @node Publishing options
14388 @subsection Options for the exporters
14389 @cindex options, for publishing
14391 The property list can be used to set export options during the publishing
14392 process. In most cases, these properties correspond to user variables in
14393 Org. While some properties are available for all export back-ends, most of
14394 them are back-end specific. The following sections list properties along
14395 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string of these
14396 options for details.
14398 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
14399 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist}, its
14400 setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if any)
14401 during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export settings}),
14402 however, override everything.
14404 @subsubheading Generic properties
14406 @multitable {@code{:with-sub-superscript}} {@code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}}
14407 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
14408 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
14409 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
14410 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
14411 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
14412 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
14413 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
14414 @item @code{:with-author} @tab @code{org-export-with-author}
14415 @item @code{:with-broken-links} @tab @code{org-export-with-broken-links}
14416 @item @code{:with-clocks} @tab @code{org-export-with-clocks}
14417 @item @code{:with-creator} @tab @code{org-export-with-creator}
14418 @item @code{:with-date} @tab @code{org-export-with-date}
14419 @item @code{:with-drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
14420 @item @code{:with-email} @tab @code{org-export-with-email}
14421 @item @code{:with-emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
14422 @item @code{:with-fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
14423 @item @code{:with-footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
14424 @item @code{:with-latex} @tab @code{org-export-with-latex}
14425 @item @code{:with-planning} @tab @code{org-export-with-planning}
14426 @item @code{:with-priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
14427 @item @code{:with-properties} @tab @code{org-export-with-properties}
14428 @item @code{:with-special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
14429 @item @code{:with-sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
14430 @item @code{:with-tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
14431 @item @code{:with-tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
14432 @item @code{:with-tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
14433 @item @code{:with-timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
14434 @item @code{:with-title} @tab @code{org-export-with-title}
14435 @item @code{:with-toc} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
14436 @item @code{:with-todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
14439 @subsubheading ASCII specific properties
14441 @multitable {@code{:ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines}} {@code{org-ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines}}
14442 @item @code{:ascii-bullets} @tab @code{org-ascii-bullets}
14443 @item @code{:ascii-caption-above} @tab @code{org-ascii-caption-above}
14444 @item @code{:ascii-charset} @tab @code{org-ascii-charset}
14445 @item @code{:ascii-global-margin} @tab @code{org-ascii-global-margin}
14446 @item @code{:ascii-format-drawer-function} @tab @code{org-ascii-format-drawer-function}
14447 @item @code{:ascii-format-inlinetask-function} @tab @code{org-ascii-format-inlinetask-function}
14448 @item @code{:ascii-headline-spacing} @tab @code{org-ascii-headline-spacing}
14449 @item @code{:ascii-indented-line-width} @tab @code{org-ascii-indented-line-width}
14450 @item @code{:ascii-inlinetask-width} @tab @code{org-ascii-inlinetask-width}
14451 @item @code{:ascii-inner-margin} @tab @code{org-ascii-inner-margin}
14452 @item @code{:ascii-links-to-notes} @tab @code{org-ascii-links-to-notes}
14453 @item @code{:ascii-list-margin} @tab @code{org-ascii-list-margin}
14454 @item @code{:ascii-paragraph-spacing} @tab @code{org-ascii-paragraph-spacing}
14455 @item @code{:ascii-quote-margin} @tab @code{org-ascii-quote-margin}
14456 @item @code{:ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines} @tab @code{org-ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines}
14457 @item @code{:ascii-table-use-ascii-art} @tab @code{org-ascii-table-use-ascii-art}
14458 @item @code{:ascii-table-widen-columns} @tab @code{org-ascii-table-widen-columns}
14459 @item @code{:ascii-text-width} @tab @code{org-ascii-text-width}
14460 @item @code{:ascii-underline} @tab @code{org-ascii-underline}
14461 @item @code{:ascii-verbatim-format} @tab @code{org-ascii-verbatim-format}
14464 @subsubheading Beamer specific properties
14466 @multitable {@code{:beamer-frame-default-options}} {@code{org-beamer-frame-default-options}}
14467 @item @code{:beamer-theme} @tab @code{org-beamer-theme}
14468 @item @code{:beamer-column-view-format} @tab @code{org-beamer-column-view-format}
14469 @item @code{:beamer-environments-extra} @tab @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}
14470 @item @code{:beamer-frame-default-options} @tab @code{org-beamer-frame-default-options}
14471 @item @code{:beamer-outline-frame-options} @tab @code{org-beamer-outline-frame-options}
14472 @item @code{:beamer-outline-frame-title} @tab @code{org-beamer-outline-frame-title}
14473 @item @code{:beamer-subtitle-format} @tab @code{org-beamer-subtitle-format}
14476 @subsubheading HTML specific properties
14478 @multitable {@code{:html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column}} {@code{org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column}}
14479 @item @code{:html-allow-name-attribute-in-anchors} @tab @code{org-html-allow-name-attribute-in-anchors}
14480 @item @code{:html-checkbox-type} @tab @code{org-html-checkbox-type}
14481 @item @code{:html-container} @tab @code{org-html-container-element}
14482 @item @code{:html-divs} @tab @code{org-html-divs}
14483 @item @code{:html-doctype} @tab @code{org-html-doctype}
14484 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-html-extension}
14485 @item @code{:html-footnote-format} @tab @code{org-html-footnote-format}
14486 @item @code{:html-footnote-separator} @tab @code{org-html-footnote-separator}
14487 @item @code{:html-footnotes-section} @tab @code{org-html-footnotes-section}
14488 @item @code{:html-format-drawer-function} @tab @code{org-html-format-drawer-function}
14489 @item @code{:html-format-headline-function} @tab @code{org-html-format-headline-function}
14490 @item @code{:html-format-inlinetask-function} @tab @code{org-html-format-inlinetask-function}
14491 @item @code{:html-head-extra} @tab @code{org-html-head-extra}
14492 @item @code{:html-head-include-default-style} @tab @code{org-html-head-include-default-style}
14493 @item @code{:html-head-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-html-head-include-scripts}
14494 @item @code{:html-head} @tab @code{org-html-head}
14495 @item @code{:html-home/up-format} @tab @code{org-html-home/up-format}
14496 @item @code{:html-html5-fancy} @tab @code{org-html-html5-fancy}
14497 @item @code{:html-indent} @tab @code{org-html-indent}
14498 @item @code{:html-infojs-options} @tab @code{org-html-infojs-options}
14499 @item @code{:html-infojs-template} @tab @code{org-html-infojs-template}
14500 @item @code{:html-inline-image-rules} @tab @code{org-html-inline-image-rules}
14501 @item @code{:html-inline-images} @tab @code{org-html-inline-images}
14502 @item @code{:html-link-home} @tab @code{org-html-link-home}
14503 @item @code{:html-link-org-files-as-html} @tab @code{org-html-link-org-files-as-html}
14504 @item @code{:html-link-up} @tab @code{org-html-link-up}
14505 @item @code{:html-link-use-abs-url} @tab @code{org-html-link-use-abs-url}
14506 @item @code{:html-mathjax-options} @tab @code{org-html-mathjax-options}
14507 @item @code{:html-mathjax-template} @tab @code{org-html-mathjax-template}
14508 @item @code{:html-metadata-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-html-metadata-timestamp-format}
14509 @item @code{:html-postamble-format} @tab @code{org-html-postamble-format}
14510 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-html-postamble}
14511 @item @code{:html-preamble-format} @tab @code{org-html-preamble-format}
14512 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-html-preamble}
14513 @item @code{:html-table-align-individual-fields} @tab @code{org-html-table-align-individual-fields}
14514 @item @code{:html-table-attributes} @tab @code{org-html-table-default-attributes}
14515 @item @code{:html-table-caption-above} @tab @code{org-html-table-caption-above}
14516 @item @code{:html-table-data-tags} @tab @code{org-html-table-data-tags}
14517 @item @code{:html-table-header-tags} @tab @code{org-html-table-header-tags}
14518 @item @code{:html-table-row-tags} @tab @code{org-html-table-row-tags}
14519 @item @code{:html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column} @tab @code{org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column}
14520 @item @code{:html-tag-class-prefix} @tab @code{org-html-tag-class-prefix}
14521 @item @code{:html-text-markup-alist} @tab @code{org-html-text-markup-alist}
14522 @item @code{:html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} @tab @code{org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix}
14523 @item @code{:html-toplevel-hlevel} @tab @code{org-html-toplevel-hlevel}
14524 @item @code{:html-use-infojs} @tab @code{org-html-use-infojs}
14525 @item @code{:html-validation-link} @tab @code{org-html-validation-link}
14526 @item @code{:html-viewport} @tab @code{org-html-viewport}
14527 @item @code{:html-xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-html-xml-declaration}
14530 @subsubheading @LaTeX{} specific properties
14532 @multitable {@code{:latex-link-with-unknown-path-format}} {@code{org-latex-link-with-unknown-path-format}}
14533 @item @code{:latex-active-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-latex-active-timestamp-format}
14534 @item @code{:latex-caption-above} @tab @code{org-latex-caption-above}
14535 @item @code{:latex-classes} @tab @code{org-latex-classes}
14536 @item @code{:latex-class} @tab @code{org-latex-default-class}
14537 @item @code{:latex-compiler} @tab @code{org-latex-compiler}
14538 @item @code{:latex-default-figure-position} @tab @code{org-latex-default-figure-position}
14539 @item @code{:latex-default-table-environment} @tab @code{org-latex-default-table-environment}
14540 @item @code{:latex-default-table-mode} @tab @code{org-latex-default-table-mode}
14541 @item @code{:latex-diary-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-latex-diary-timestamp-format}
14542 @item @code{:latex-footnote-defined-format} @tab @code{org-latex-footnote-defined-format}
14543 @item @code{:latex-footnote-separator} @tab @code{org-latex-footnote-separator}
14544 @item @code{:latex-format-drawer-function} @tab @code{org-latex-format-drawer-function}
14545 @item @code{:latex-format-headline-function} @tab @code{org-latex-format-headline-function}
14546 @item @code{:latex-format-inlinetask-function} @tab @code{org-latex-format-inlinetask-function}
14547 @item @code{:latex-hyperref-template} @tab @code{org-latex-hyperref-template}
14548 @item @code{:latex-image-default-height} @tab @code{org-latex-image-default-height}
14549 @item @code{:latex-image-default-option} @tab @code{org-latex-image-default-option}
14550 @item @code{:latex-image-default-width} @tab @code{org-latex-image-default-width}
14551 @item @code{:latex-images-centered} @tab @code{org-latex-images-centered}
14552 @item @code{:latex-inactive-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-latex-inactive-timestamp-format}
14553 @item @code{:latex-inline-image-rules} @tab @code{org-latex-inline-image-rules}
14554 @item @code{:latex-link-with-unknown-path-format} @tab @code{org-latex-link-with-unknown-path-format}
14555 @item @code{:latex-listings-langs} @tab @code{org-latex-listings-langs}
14556 @item @code{:latex-listings-options} @tab @code{org-latex-listings-options}
14557 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-latex-listings}
14558 @item @code{:latex-minted-langs} @tab @code{org-latex-minted-langs}
14559 @item @code{:latex-minted-options} @tab @code{org-latex-minted-options}
14560 @item @code{:latex-prefer-user-labels} @tab @code{org-latex-prefer-user-labels}
14561 @item @code{:latex-subtitle-format} @tab @code{org-latex-subtitle-format}
14562 @item @code{:latex-subtitle-separate} @tab @code{org-latex-subtitle-separate}
14563 @item @code{:latex-table-scientific-notation} @tab @code{org-latex-table-scientific-notation}
14564 @item @code{:latex-tables-booktabs} @tab @code{org-latex-tables-booktabs}
14565 @item @code{:latex-tables-centered} @tab @code{org-latex-tables-centered}
14566 @item @code{:latex-text-markup-alist} @tab @code{org-latex-text-markup-alist}
14567 @item @code{:latex-title-command} @tab @code{org-latex-title-command}
14568 @item @code{:latex-toc-command} @tab @code{org-latex-toc-command}
14571 @subsubheading Markdown specific properties
14573 @multitable {@code{:md-footnotes-section}} {@code{org-md-footnotes-section}}
14574 @item @code{:md-footnote-format} @tab @code{org-md-footnote-format}
14575 @item @code{:md-footnotes-section} @tab @code{org-md-footnotes-section}
14576 @item @code{:md-headline-style} @tab @code{org-md-headline-style}
14579 @subsubheading ODT specific properties
14581 @multitable {@code{:odt-format-inlinetask-function}} {@code{org-odt-format-inlinetask-function}}
14582 @item @code{:odt-content-template-file} @tab @code{org-odt-content-template-file}
14583 @item @code{:odt-display-outline-level} @tab @code{org-odt-display-outline-level}
14584 @item @code{:odt-fontify-srcblocks} @tab @code{org-odt-fontify-srcblocks}
14585 @item @code{:odt-format-drawer-function} @tab @code{org-odt-format-drawer-function}
14586 @item @code{:odt-format-headline-function} @tab @code{org-odt-format-headline-function}
14587 @item @code{:odt-format-inlinetask-function} @tab @code{org-odt-format-inlinetask-function}
14588 @item @code{:odt-inline-formula-rules} @tab @code{org-odt-inline-formula-rules}
14589 @item @code{:odt-inline-image-rules} @tab @code{org-odt-inline-image-rules}
14590 @item @code{:odt-pixels-per-inch} @tab @code{org-odt-pixels-per-inch}
14591 @item @code{:odt-styles-file} @tab @code{org-odt-styles-file}
14592 @item @code{:odt-table-styles} @tab @code{org-odt-table-styles}
14593 @item @code{:odt-use-date-fields} @tab @code{org-odt-use-date-fields}
14596 @subsubheading Texinfo specific properties
14598 @multitable {@code{:texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format}} {@code{org-texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format}}
14599 @item @code{:texinfo-active-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-texinfo-active-timestamp-format}
14600 @item @code{:texinfo-classes} @tab @code{org-texinfo-classes}
14601 @item @code{:texinfo-class} @tab @code{org-texinfo-default-class}
14602 @item @code{:texinfo-table-default-markup} @tab @code{org-texinfo-table-default-markup}
14603 @item @code{:texinfo-diary-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-texinfo-diary-timestamp-format}
14604 @item @code{:texinfo-filename} @tab @code{org-texinfo-filename}
14605 @item @code{:texinfo-format-drawer-function} @tab @code{org-texinfo-format-drawer-function}
14606 @item @code{:texinfo-format-headline-function} @tab @code{org-texinfo-format-headline-function}
14607 @item @code{:texinfo-format-inlinetask-function} @tab @code{org-texinfo-format-inlinetask-function}
14608 @item @code{:texinfo-inactive-timestamp-format} @tab @code{org-texinfo-inactive-timestamp-format}
14609 @item @code{:texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format} @tab @code{org-texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format}
14610 @item @code{:texinfo-node-description-column} @tab @code{org-texinfo-node-description-column}
14611 @item @code{:texinfo-table-scientific-notation} @tab @code{org-texinfo-table-scientific-notation}
14612 @item @code{:texinfo-tables-verbatim} @tab @code{org-texinfo-tables-verbatim}
14613 @item @code{:texinfo-text-markup-alist} @tab @code{org-texinfo-text-markup-alist}
14616 @node Publishing links
14617 @subsection Links between published files
14618 @cindex links, publishing
14620 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use something like
14621 @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply @samp{file:foo.org}
14622 (@pxref{External links}). When published, this link becomes a link to
14623 @file{foo.html}. You can thus interlink the pages of your ``org web''
14624 project and the links will work as expected when you publish them to HTML.
14625 If you also publish the Org source file and want to link to it, use an
14626 @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link, because @code{file:} links
14627 are converted to link to the corresponding @file{html} file.
14629 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
14630 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
14631 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
14632 an example of this usage.
14634 Eventually, links between published documents can contain some search options
14635 (@pxref{Search options}), which will be resolved to the appropriate location
14636 in the linked file. For example, once published to HTML, the following links
14637 all point to a dedicated anchor in @file{foo.html}.
14640 [[file:foo.org::*heading]]
14641 [[file:foo.org::#custom-id]]
14642 [[file:foo.org::target]]
14646 @subsection Generating a sitemap
14647 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
14649 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
14650 a map of files for a given project.
14652 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
14653 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
14654 @tab When non-@code{nil}, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
14655 or @code{org-publish-all}.
14657 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
14658 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
14659 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
14661 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
14662 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
14664 @item @code{:sitemap-format-entry}
14665 @tab With this option one can tell how a site-map entry is formatted in the
14666 site-map. It is a function called with three arguments: the file or
14667 directory name relative to base directory of the project, the site-map style
14668 and the current project. It is expected to return a string. Default value
14669 turns file names into links and use document titles as descriptions. For
14670 specific formatting needs, one can use @code{org-publish-find-date},
14671 @code{org-publish-find-title} and @code{org-publish-find-property}, to
14672 retrieve additional information about published documents.
14674 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
14675 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap. It is called
14676 with two arguments: the title of the site-map and a representation of the
14677 files and directories involved in the project as a radio list (@pxref{Radio
14678 lists}). The latter can further be transformed using
14679 @code{org-list-to-generic}, @code{org-list-to-subtree} and alike. Default
14680 value generates a plain list of links to all files in the project.
14682 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
14683 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
14684 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last, respectively.
14685 When set to @code{ignore}, folders are ignored altogether. Any other value
14686 will mix files and folders. This variable has no effect when site-map style
14689 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
14690 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
14691 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
14692 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
14693 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
14694 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
14695 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
14697 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
14698 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
14700 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
14701 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
14702 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
14703 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
14707 @node Generating an index
14708 @subsection Generating an index
14709 @cindex index, in a publishing project
14711 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
14713 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14714 @item @code{:makeindex}
14715 @tab When non-@code{nil}, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
14716 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
14719 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
14720 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
14721 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
14722 a title, style information, etc.
14725 Index entries are specified with @code{#+INDEX} keyword. An entry that
14726 contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item.
14731 #+INDEX: Application!CV
14734 @node Uploading files
14735 @section Uploading files
14739 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
14740 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
14741 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
14742 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
14743 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
14746 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
14747 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
14748 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
14749 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
14750 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
14752 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
14753 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
14754 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
14755 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
14756 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
14757 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
14760 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
14761 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
14762 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
14763 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
14764 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
14765 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
14767 @node Sample configuration
14768 @section Sample configuration
14770 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
14771 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
14772 more complex, with a multi-component project.
14775 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
14776 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
14779 @node Simple example
14780 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
14782 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
14783 directory on the local machine.
14786 (setq org-publish-project-alist
14788 :base-directory "~/org/"
14789 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
14790 :section-numbers nil
14792 :html-head "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
14793 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
14794 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
14797 @node Complex example
14798 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
14800 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
14801 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
14802 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
14805 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
14806 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
14807 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
14808 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
14811 file:../images/myimage.png
14814 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
14815 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
14816 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
14819 (setq org-publish-project-alist
14821 :base-directory "~/org/"
14822 :base-extension "org"
14823 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
14824 :publishing-function org-html-publish-to-html
14825 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
14827 :section-numbers nil
14829 :html-head "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
14830 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
14834 :base-directory "~/images/"
14835 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
14836 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
14837 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
14840 :base-directory "~/other/"
14841 :base-extension "css\\|el"
14842 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
14843 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
14844 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
14847 @node Triggering publication
14848 @section Triggering publication
14850 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
14853 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P x,org-publish}
14854 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
14855 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P p,org-publish-current-project}
14856 Publish the project containing the current file.
14857 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P f,org-publish-current-file}
14858 Publish only the current file.
14859 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P a,org-publish-all}
14860 Publish every project.
14863 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
14864 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
14865 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
14866 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
14867 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
14868 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
14869 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
14872 @node Working with source code
14873 @chapter Working with source code
14874 @cindex Schulte, Eric
14875 @cindex Davison, Dan
14876 @cindex source code, working with
14878 Source code here refers to any code typed in Org mode documents. Org can
14879 manage source code in any Org file once such code is tagged with begin and
14880 end markers. Working with source code begins with tagging source code
14881 blocks. Tagged @samp{src} code blocks are not restricted to the preamble or
14882 the end of an Org document; they can go anywhere---with a few exceptions,
14883 such as not inside comments and fixed width areas. Here's a sample
14884 @samp{src} code block in emacs-lisp:
14887 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
14888 (defun org-xor (a b)
14894 Org can take the code in the block between the @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC} and
14895 @samp{#+END_SRC} tags, and format, compile, execute, and show the results.
14896 Org can simplify many housekeeping tasks essential to modern code
14897 maintenance. That's why these blocks in Org mode literature are sometimes
14898 referred to as @samp{live code} blocks (as compared to the static text and
14899 documentation around it). Users can control how @samp{live} they want each
14900 block by tweaking the headers for compiling, execution, extraction.
14902 Org's @samp{src} code block type is one of many block types, such as quote,
14903 export, verse, latex, example, and verbatim. This section pertains to
14904 @samp{src} code blocks between @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @samp{#+END_SRC}
14906 For editing @samp{src} code blocks, Org provides native Emacs major-modes.
14907 That leverages the latest Emacs features for that source code language mode.
14909 For exporting, Org can then extract @samp{src} code blocks into compilable
14910 source files (in a conversion process known as @dfn{tangling} in literate
14911 programming terminology).
14913 For publishing, Org's back-ends can handle the @samp{src} code blocks and the
14914 text for output to a variety of formats with native syntax highlighting.
14916 For executing the source code in the @samp{src} code blocks, Org provides
14917 facilities that glue the tasks of compiling, collecting the results of the
14918 execution, and inserting them back to the Org file. Besides text output,
14919 results may include links to other data types that Emacs can handle: audio,
14920 video, and graphics.
14922 An important feature of Org's execution of the @samp{src} code blocks is
14923 passing variables, functions, and results between @samp{src} blocks. Such
14924 interoperability uses a common syntax even if these @samp{src} blocks are in
14925 different source code languages. The integration extends to linking the
14926 debugger's error messages to the line in the @samp{src} code block in the Org
14927 file. That should partly explain why this functionality by the original
14928 contributors, Eric Schulte and Dan Davison, was called @samp{Org Babel}.
14930 In literate programming, the main appeal is code and documentation
14931 co-existing in one file. Org mode takes this several steps further. First
14932 by enabling execution, and then by inserting results of that execution back
14933 into the Org file. Along the way, Org provides extensive formatting
14934 features, including handling tables. Org handles multiple source code
14935 languages in one file, and provides a common syntax for passing variables,
14936 functions, and results between @samp{src} code blocks.
14938 Org mode fulfills the promise of easy verification and maintenance of
14939 publishing reproducible research by keeping all these in the same file: text,
14940 data, code, configuration settings of the execution environment, the results
14941 of the execution, and associated narratives, claims, references, and internal
14942 and external links.
14944 Details of Org's facilities for working with source code are shown next.
14947 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
14948 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
14949 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
14950 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
14951 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
14952 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
14953 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
14954 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
14955 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
14956 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
14957 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
14958 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
14962 @node Structure of code blocks
14963 @section Structure of code blocks
14964 @cindex code block, structure
14965 @cindex source code, block structure
14967 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
14969 Org offers two ways to structure source code in Org documents: in a
14970 @samp{src} block, and directly inline. Both specifications are shown below.
14972 A @samp{src} block conforms to this structure:
14976 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
14981 Org mode's templates system (@pxref{Easy templates}) speeds up creating
14982 @samp{src} code blocks with just three keystrokes. Do not be put-off by
14983 having to remember the source block syntax. Org also works with other
14984 completion systems in Emacs, some of which predate Org and have custom
14985 domain-specific languages for defining templates. Regular use of templates
14986 reduces errors, increases accuracy, and maintains consistency.
14988 @cindex source code, inline
14989 An inline code block conforms to this structure:
14992 src_<language>@{<body>@}
14998 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
15002 @item #+NAME: <name>
15003 Optional. Names the @samp{src} block so it can be called, like a function,
15004 from other @samp{src} blocks or inline blocks to evaluate or to capture the
15005 results. Code from other blocks, other files, and from table formulas
15006 (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) can use the name to reference a @samp{src} block.
15007 This naming serves the same purpose as naming Org tables. Org mode requires
15008 unique names. For duplicate names, Org mode's behavior is undefined.
15012 Mandatory. They mark the start and end of a block that Org requires. The
15013 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line takes additional arguments, as described next.
15014 @cindex begin block, end block
15016 Mandatory for live code blocks. It is the identifier of the source code
15017 language in the block. @xref{Languages}, for identifiers of supported
15019 @cindex source code, language
15021 Optional. Switches provide finer control of the code execution, export, and
15022 format (see the discussion of switches in @ref{Literal examples})
15023 @cindex source code, switches
15024 @item <header arguments>
15025 Optional. Heading arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
15026 tangling of code blocks (@pxref{Header arguments}). Using Org's properties
15027 feature, header arguments can be selectively applied to the entire buffer or
15028 specific sub-trees of the Org document.
15029 @item source code, header arguments
15031 Source code in the dialect of the specified language identifier.
15034 @node Editing source code
15035 @section Editing source code
15036 @cindex code block, editing
15037 @cindex source code, editing
15039 @vindex org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay
15040 @vindex org-edit-src-turn-on-auto-save
15042 @kbd{C-c '} for editing the current code block. It opens a new major-mode
15043 edit buffer containing the body of the @samp{src} code block, ready for any
15044 edits. @kbd{C-c '} again to close the buffer and return to the Org buffer.
15046 @key{C-x C-s} saves the buffer and updates the contents of the Org buffer.
15048 Set @code{org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay} to save the base buffer after
15049 a certain idle delay time.
15051 Set @code{org-edit-src-turn-on-auto-save} to auto-save this buffer into a
15052 separate file using @code{auto-save-mode}.
15054 @kbd{C-c '} to close the major-mode buffer and return back to the Org buffer.
15056 While editing the source code in the major-mode, the @code{org-src-mode}
15057 minor mode remains active. It provides these customization variables as
15058 described below. For even more variables, look in the customization
15059 group @code{org-edit-structure}.
15062 @item org-src-lang-modes
15063 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where @code{<lang>}
15064 is the language identifier from code block's header line, then the edit
15065 buffer uses that major-mode. Use this variable to arbitrarily map language
15066 identifiers to major modes.
15067 @item org-src-window-setup
15068 For specifying Emacs window arrangement when the new edit buffer is created.
15069 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
15070 @cindex indentation, in source blocks
15071 Default is @code{nil}. Source code is indented. This indentation applies
15072 during export or tangling, and depending on the context, may alter leading
15073 spaces and tabs. When non-@code{nil}, source code is aligned with the
15074 leftmost column. No lines are modified during export or tangling, which is
15075 very useful for white-space sensitive languages, such as Python.
15076 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
15077 When @code{nil}, Org returns to the edit buffer without further prompts. The
15078 default prompts for a confirmation.
15081 Set @code{org-src-fontify-natively} to non-@code{nil} to turn on native code
15082 fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer. Fontification of @samp{src} code
15083 blocks can give visual separation of text and code on the display page. To
15084 further customize the appearance of @code{org-block} for specific languages,
15085 customize @code{org-src-block-faces}. The following example shades the
15086 background of regular blocks, and colors source blocks only for Python and
15087 Emacs-Lisp languages.
15090 (set-face-attribute 'org-block nil :background
15092 (face-attribute 'default :background) 3))
15094 (setq org-src-block-faces '(("emacs-lisp" (:background "#EEE2FF"))
15095 ("python" (:background "#E5FFB8"))))
15098 @node Exporting code blocks
15099 @section Exporting code blocks
15100 @cindex code block, exporting
15101 @cindex source code, exporting
15103 Org can flexibly export just the @emph{code} from the code blocks, just the
15104 @emph{results} of evaluation of the code block, @emph{both} the code and the
15105 results of the code block evaluation, or @emph{none}. Org defaults to
15106 exporting @emph{code} for most languages. For some languages, such as
15107 @code{ditaa}, Org defaults to @emph{results}. To export just the body of
15108 code blocks, @pxref{Literal examples}. To selectively export sub-trees of
15109 an Org document, @pxref{Exporting}.
15111 The @code{:exports} header arguments control exporting code blocks only and
15114 @subsubheading Header arguments:
15117 @cindex @code{:exports}, src header argument
15118 @item :exports code
15119 This is the default for most languages where the body of the code block is
15120 exported. See @ref{Literal examples} for more.
15121 @item :exports results
15122 On export, Org includes only the results and not the code block. After each
15123 evaluation, Org inserts the results after the end of code block in the Org
15124 buffer. By default, Org replaces any previous results. Org can also append
15126 @item :exports both
15127 Org exports both the code block and the results.
15128 @item :exports none
15129 Org does not export the code block nor the results.
15132 @vindex org-export-use-babel
15133 To stop Org from evaluating code blocks to speed exports, use the header
15134 argument @code{:eval never-export} (@pxref{eval}). To stop Org from
15135 evaluating code blocks for greater security, set the
15136 @code{org-export-use-babel} variable to @code{nil}, but understand that
15137 header arguments will have no effect.
15139 Turning off evaluation comes in handy when batch processing. For example,
15140 markup languages for wikis, which have a high risk of untrusted code.
15141 Stopping code block evaluation also stops evaluation of all header arguments
15142 of the code block. This may not be desirable in some circumstances. So
15143 during export, to allow evaluation of just the header arguments but not any
15144 code evaluation in the source block, set @code{:eval never-export}
15147 To evaluate just the inline code blocks, set @code{org-export-babel-evaluate}
15148 to @code{inline-only}. Isolating the option to allow inline evaluations
15149 separate from @samp{src} code block evaluations during exports is not for
15150 security but for avoiding any delays due to recalculations, such as calls to
15153 Org never evaluates code blocks in commented sub-trees when exporting
15154 (@pxref{Comment lines}). On the other hand, Org does evaluate code blocks in
15155 sub-trees excluded from export (@pxref{Export settings}).
15157 @node Extracting source code
15158 @section Extracting source code
15160 @cindex source code, extracting
15161 @cindex code block, extracting source code
15163 Extracting source code from code blocks is a basic task in literate
15164 programming. Org has features to make this easy. In literate programming
15165 parlance, documents on creation are @emph{woven} with code and documentation,
15166 and on export, the code is @emph{tangled} for execution by a computer. Org
15167 facilitates weaving and tangling for producing, maintaining, sharing, and
15168 exporting literate programming documents. Org provides extensive
15169 customization options for extracting source code.
15171 When Org tangles @samp{src} code blocks, it expands, merges, and transforms
15172 them. Then Org recomposes them into one or more separate files, as
15173 configured through the options. During this @emph{tangling} process, Org
15174 expands variables in the source code, and resolves any Noweb style references
15175 (@pxref{Noweb reference syntax}).
15177 @subsubheading Header arguments
15180 @cindex @code{:tangle}, src header argument
15182 By default, Org does not tangle the @samp{src} code block on export.
15184 Org extracts the contents of the code block for the tangled output. By
15185 default, the output file name is the same as the Org file but with a file
15186 extension derived from the language identifier of the @samp{src} code block.
15187 @item :tangle filename
15188 Override the default file name with this one for the tangled output.
15192 @subsubheading Functions
15195 @item org-babel-tangle
15196 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
15198 With prefix argument only tangle the current @samp{src} code block.
15199 @item org-babel-tangle-file
15200 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
15203 @subsubheading Hooks
15206 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
15207 This hook runs from within code tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}, making it
15208 suitable for post-processing, compilation, and evaluation of code in the
15212 @subsubheading Jumping between code and Org
15214 Debuggers normally link errors and messages back to the source code. But for
15215 tangled files, we want to link back to the Org file, not to the tangled
15216 source file. To make this extra jump, Org uses
15217 @code{org-babel-tangle-jump-to-org} function with two additional source code
15218 block header arguments: One, set @code{padline} (@pxref{padline}) to true
15219 (the default setting). Two, set @code{comments} (@pxref{comments}) to
15220 @code{link}, which makes Org insert links to the Org file.
15222 @node Evaluating code blocks
15223 @section Evaluating code blocks
15224 @cindex code block, evaluating
15225 @cindex source code, evaluating
15228 A note about security: With code evaluation comes the risk of harm. Org
15229 safeguards by prompting for user's permission before executing any code in
15230 the source block. To customize this safeguard (or disable it) see @ref{Code
15231 evaluation security}.
15233 Org captures the results of the @samp{src} code block evaluation and inserts
15234 them in the Org file, right after the @samp{src} code block. The insertion
15235 point is after a newline and the @code{#+RESULTS} label. Org creates the
15236 @code{#+RESULTS} label if one is not already there.
15238 By default, Org enables only @code{emacs-lisp} @samp{src} code blocks for
15239 execution. See @ref{Languages} for identifiers to enable other languages.
15242 Org provides many ways to execute @samp{src} code blocks. @kbd{C-c C-c} or
15243 @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a @samp{src} code block@footnote{The option
15244 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} can be used to remove code
15245 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.} calls the
15246 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function, which executes the code in the
15247 block, collects the results, and inserts them in the buffer.
15250 By calling a named code block@footnote{Actually, the constructs call_<name>()
15251 and src_<lang>@{@} are not evaluated when they appear in a keyword line
15252 (i.e. lines starting with @code{#+KEYWORD:}, @pxref{In-buffer settings}).}
15253 from an Org mode buffer or a table. Org can call the named @samp{src} code
15254 blocks from the current Org mode buffer or from the ``Library of Babel''
15255 (@pxref{Library of Babel}). Whether inline syntax or the @code{#+CALL:}
15256 syntax is used, the result is wrapped based on the variable
15257 @code{org-babel-inline-result-wrap}, which by default is set to @code{"=%s="}
15258 to produce verbatim text suitable for markup.
15260 The syntax for @code{#+CALL:} is
15263 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
15264 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
15267 The syntax for inline named code block is
15270 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
15271 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
15276 This is the name of the code block to be evaluated (@pxref{Structure of
15279 Org passes arguments to the code block using standard function call syntax.
15280 For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes @samp{4} to a code block named
15281 @code{double}, which declares the header argument @code{:var n=2}, would be
15282 written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}. Note how this function call syntax is
15283 different from the header argument syntax.
15284 @item <inside header arguments>
15285 Org passes inside header arguments to the named @samp{src} code block using
15286 the header argument syntax. Inside header arguments apply to code block
15287 evaluation. For example, @code{[:results output]} collects results printed
15288 to @code{STDOUT} during code execution of that block. Note how this header
15289 argument syntax is different from the function call syntax.
15290 @item <end header arguments>
15291 End header arguments affect the results returned by the code block. For
15292 example, @code{:results html} wraps the results in a @code{BEGIN_EXPORT html}
15293 block before inserting the results in the Org buffer.
15295 For more examples of header arguments for @code{#+CALL:} lines,
15296 @pxref{Arguments in function calls}.
15299 @node Library of Babel
15300 @section Library of Babel
15301 @cindex babel, library of
15302 @cindex source code, library
15303 @cindex code block, library
15305 The ``Library of Babel'' is a collection of code blocks. Like a function
15306 library, these code blocks can be called from other Org files. This
15307 collection is in a repository file in Org mode format in the @samp{doc}
15308 directory of Org mode installation. For remote code block evaluation syntax,
15309 @pxref{Evaluating code blocks}.
15312 For any user to add code to the library, first save the code in regular
15313 @samp{src} code blocks of an Org file, and then load the Org file with
15314 @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}, which is bound to @kbd{C-c C-v i}.
15318 @cindex babel, languages
15319 @cindex source code, languages
15320 @cindex code block, languages
15322 Org supports the following languages for the @samp{src} code blocks:
15324 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25
15325 @headitem @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
15326 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
15327 @item C @tab C @tab C++ @tab C++
15328 @item Clojure @tab clojure @tab CSS @tab css
15329 @item D @tab d @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
15330 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Calc @tab calc
15331 @item Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp @tab Fortran @tab fortran
15332 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
15333 @item Java @tab java @tab Javascript @tab js
15334 @item LaTeX @tab latex @tab Ledger @tab ledger
15335 @item Lisp @tab lisp @tab Lilypond @tab lilypond
15336 @item Lua @tab lua @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
15337 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
15338 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
15339 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
15340 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Processing.js @tab processing
15341 @item Python @tab python @tab R @tab R
15342 @item Ruby @tab ruby @tab Sass @tab sass
15343 @item Scheme @tab scheme @tab GNU Screen @tab screen
15344 @item Sed @tab sed @tab shell @tab sh
15345 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
15348 Additional documentation for some languages are at
15349 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
15351 By default, only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled for evaluation. To enable or
15352 disable other languages, customize the @code{org-babel-load-languages}
15353 variable either through the Emacs customization interface, or by adding code
15354 to the init file as shown next:
15356 In this example, evaluation is disabled for @code{emacs-lisp}, and enabled
15360 (org-babel-do-load-languages
15361 'org-babel-load-languages
15362 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
15366 Note that this is not the only way to enable a language. Org also enables
15367 languages when loaded with @code{require} statement. For example, the
15368 following enables execution of @code{clojure} code blocks:
15371 (require 'ob-clojure)
15374 @node Header arguments
15375 @section Header arguments
15376 @cindex code block, header arguments
15377 @cindex source code, block header arguments
15379 Details of configuring header arguments are shown here.
15382 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
15383 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
15386 @node Using header arguments
15387 @subsection Using header arguments
15389 Since header arguments can be set in several ways, Org prioritizes them in
15390 case of overlaps or conflicts by giving local settings a higher priority.
15391 Header values in function calls, for example, override header values from
15394 * System-wide header arguments:: Set globally, language-specific
15395 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set in the Org file's headers
15396 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set in the Org file
15397 * Language-specific mode properties::
15398 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most commonly used method
15399 * Arguments in function calls:: The most specific level, takes highest priority
15403 @node System-wide header arguments
15404 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
15405 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
15406 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by adapting the
15407 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
15409 @cindex @code{:session}, src header argument
15410 @cindex @code{:results}, src header argument
15411 @cindex @code{:exports}, src header argument
15412 @cindex @code{:cache}, src header argument
15413 @cindex @code{:noweb}, src header argument
15416 :results => "replace"
15422 This example sets @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}, which makes
15423 Org expand @code{:noweb} references by default.
15426 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
15427 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
15428 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
15431 @node Language-specific header arguments
15432 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
15433 Each language can have separate default header arguments by customizing the
15434 variable @code{org-babel-default-header-args:<lang>}, where @code{<lang>} is
15435 the name of the language. For details, see the language-specific online
15436 documentation at @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
15438 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties
15439 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
15441 For header arguments applicable to the buffer, use @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines
15442 anywhere in the Org mode file (@pxref{Property syntax}).
15444 The following example sets only for @samp{R} code blocks to @code{session},
15445 making all the @samp{R} code blocks execute in the same session. Setting
15446 @code{results} to @code{silent} ignores the results of executions for all
15447 blocks, not just @samp{R} code blocks; no results inserted for any block.
15450 #+PROPERTY: header-args:R :session *R*
15451 #+PROPERTY: header-args :results silent
15454 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
15455 Header arguments set through Org's property drawers (@pxref{Property syntax})
15456 apply at the sub-tree level on down. Since these property drawers can appear
15457 anywhere in the file hierarchy, Org uses outermost call or source block to
15458 resolve the values. Org ignores @code{org-use-property-inheritance} setting.
15460 In this example, @code{:cache} defaults to @code{yes} for all code blocks in
15461 the sub-tree starting with @samp{sample header}.
15466 :header-args: :cache yes
15471 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
15472 Properties defined through @code{org-set-property} function, bound to
15473 @kbd{C-c C-x p}, apply to all active languages. They override properties set
15474 in @code{org-babel-default-header-args}.
15476 @node Language-specific mode properties
15477 @subsubheading Language-specific mode properties
15479 Language-specific header arguments are also read from properties
15480 @code{header-args:<lang>} where @code{<lang>} is the language identifier.
15486 :header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-1*
15487 :header-args:R: :session *R*
15491 :header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-2*
15495 would force separate sessions for clojure blocks in Heading and Subheading,
15496 but use the same session for all @samp{R} blocks. Blocks in Subheading
15497 inherit settings from Heading.
15499 @node Code block specific header arguments
15500 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
15502 Header arguments are most commonly set at the @samp{src} code block level, on
15503 the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Arguments set at this level take precedence
15504 over those set in the @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable, and also
15505 those set as header properties.
15507 In the following example, setting @code{results} to @code{silent} makes it
15508 ignore results of the code execution. Setting @code{:exports} to @code{code}
15509 exports only the body of the @samp{src} code block to HTML or @LaTeX{}.:
15513 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
15515 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
15519 The same header arguments in an inline @samp{src} code block:
15522 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
15525 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} on
15526 each line. Note that Org currently accepts the plural spelling of
15527 @code{#+HEADER:} only as a convenience for backward-compatibility. It may be
15528 removed at some point.
15532 Multi-line header arguments on an unnamed @samp{src} code block:
15535 #+HEADER: :var data1=1
15536 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
15537 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
15544 Multi-line header arguments on a named @samp{src} code block:
15547 #+NAME: named-block
15548 #+HEADER: :var data=2
15549 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
15550 (message "data:%S" data)
15553 #+RESULTS: named-block
15557 @node Arguments in function calls
15558 @subsubheading Arguments in function calls
15560 Header arguments in function calls are the most specific and override all
15561 other settings in case of an overlap. They get the highest priority. Two
15562 @code{#+CALL:} examples are shown below. For the complete syntax of
15563 @code{#+CALL:} lines, see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}.
15565 In this example, @code{:exports results} header argument is applied to the
15566 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
15569 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
15572 In this example, @code{:session special} header argument is applied to the
15573 evaluation of @code{factorial} code block.
15576 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
15579 @node Specific header arguments
15580 @subsection Specific header arguments
15581 Org comes with many header arguments common to all languages. New header
15582 arguments are added for specific languages as they become available for use
15583 in @samp{src} code blocks. A header argument is specified with an initial
15584 colon followed by the argument's name in lowercase. Common header arguments
15588 * var:: Pass arguments to @samp{src} code blocks
15589 * results:: Specify results type; how to collect
15590 * file:: Specify a path for output file
15591 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
15592 * file-ext:: Specify an extension for file output
15593 * output-dir:: Specify a directory for output file
15594 * dir:: Specify the default directory for code block execution
15595 * exports:: Specify exporting code, results, both, none
15596 * tangle:: Toggle tangling; or specify file name
15597 * mkdirp:: Toggle for parent directory creation for target files during tangling
15598 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled code files
15599 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled code files
15600 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb expansion during tangling
15601 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
15602 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
15603 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
15604 * noweb-sep:: String to separate noweb references
15605 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
15606 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
15607 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
15608 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
15609 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
15610 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
15611 * tangle-mode:: Set permission of tangled files
15612 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
15613 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
15614 * post:: Post processing of results of code block evaluation
15615 * prologue:: Text to prepend to body of code block
15616 * epilogue:: Text to append to body of code block
15619 For language-specific header arguments, see @ref{Languages}.
15622 @subsubsection @code{:var}
15623 @cindex @code{:var}, src header argument
15624 Use @code{:var} for passing arguments to @samp{src} code blocks. The
15625 specifics of variables in @samp{src} code blocks vary by the source language
15626 and are covered in the language-specific documentation. The syntax for
15627 @code{:var}, however, is the same for all languages. This includes declaring
15628 a variable, and assigning a default value.
15630 Arguments can take values as literals, or as references, or even as Emacs
15631 Lisp code (@pxref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References are
15632 names from the Org file from the lines @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+RESULTS:}.
15633 References can also refer to tables, lists, @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks,
15634 other types of @samp{src} code blocks, or the results of execution of
15635 @samp{src} code blocks.
15637 For better performance, Org can cache results of evaluations. But caching
15638 comes with severe limitations (@pxref{cache}).
15640 Argument values are indexed like arrays (@pxref{var, Indexable variable
15643 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to @samp{src} code blocks
15644 using the @code{:var} header argument.
15650 The @code{assign} is a literal value, such as a string @samp{"string"}, a
15651 number @samp{9}, a reference to a table, a list, a literal example, another
15652 code block (with or without arguments), or the results from evaluating a code
15655 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
15660 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} line
15663 #+NAME: example-table
15669 #+NAME: table-length
15670 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
15674 #+RESULTS: table-length
15679 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line. Note that only the top level
15680 list items are passed along. Nested list items are ignored.
15683 #+NAME: example-list
15689 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
15697 @item code block without arguments
15698 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
15699 optionally followed by parentheses
15702 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
15710 @item code block with arguments
15711 a @samp{src} code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by
15712 parentheses and optional arguments passed within the parentheses following
15713 the @samp{src} code block name using standard function call syntax
15717 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
15725 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=2)
15733 @item literal example
15734 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
15737 #+NAME: literal-example
15743 #+NAME: read-literal-example
15744 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
15745 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
15748 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
15749 : A literal example
15750 : on two lines for you.
15756 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
15757 Indexing variable values enables referencing portions of a variable. Indexes
15758 are 0 based with negative values counting backwards from the end. If an
15759 index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section will index as
15760 the next dimension. Note that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other
15761 table-related header arguments are applied, such as @code{:hlines},
15762 @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames}. The following example assigns the
15763 last cell of the first row the table @code{example-table} to the variable
15767 #+NAME: example-table
15773 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
15781 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
15782 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
15783 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
15787 #+NAME: example-table
15794 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
15804 To pick the entire range, use an empty index, or the single character
15805 @code{*}. @code{0:-1} does the same thing. Example below shows how to
15806 reference the first column only.
15809 #+NAME: example-table
15815 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
15823 Index referencing can be used for tables and code blocks. Index referencing
15824 can handle any number of dimensions. Commas delimit multiple dimensions, as
15829 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
15830 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
15831 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
15832 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
15835 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
15843 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
15845 Emacs lisp code can set the values for variables. To differentiate a value
15846 from lisp code, Org interprets any value starting with @code{(}, @code{[},
15847 @code{'} or @code{`} as Emacs Lisp code. The result of evaluating that code
15848 is then assigned to the value of that variable. The following example shows
15849 how to reliably query and pass file name of the Org mode buffer to a code
15850 block using headers. We need reliability here because the file's name could
15851 change once the code in the block starts executing.
15854 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
15859 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be mistakenly evaluated
15860 as Emacs Lisp code, as illustrated in the following example.
15866 #+HEADER: :var data=table[0,0]
15876 @subsubsection @code{:results}
15877 @cindex @code{:results}, src header argument
15879 There are four classes of @code{:results} header arguments. Each @samp{src}
15880 code block can take only one option per class.
15884 @b{collection} for how the results should be collected from the @samp{src}
15887 @b{type} for which type of result the code block will return; affects how Org
15888 processes and inserts results in the Org buffer
15890 @b{format} for the result; affects how Org processes and inserts results in
15893 @b{handling} for processing results after evaluation of the @samp{src} code
15897 @subsubheading Collection
15898 Collection options specify the results. Choose one of the options; they are
15899 mutually exclusive.
15903 Default. Functional mode. Result is the value returned by the last
15904 statement in the @samp{src} code block. Languages like Python may require an
15905 explicit @code{return} statement in the @samp{src} code block. Usage
15906 example: @code{:results value}.
15907 @item @code{output}
15908 Scripting mode. Result is collected from STDOUT during execution of the code
15909 in the @samp{src} code block. Usage example: @code{:results output}.
15912 @subsubheading Type
15913 Type tells what result types to expect from the execution of the code
15914 block. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. The default
15915 behavior is to automatically determine the result type.
15918 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
15919 Interpret the results as an Org table. If the result is a single value,
15920 create a table with one row and one column. Usage example: @code{:results
15923 Interpret the results as an Org list. If the result is a single value,
15924 create a list of one element.
15925 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
15926 Interpret literally and insert as quoted text. Do not create a table. Usage
15927 example: @code{:results value verbatim}.
15929 Interpret as path to a file. Inserts a link to the file. Usage example:
15930 @code{:results value file}.
15933 @subsubheading Format
15934 Format pertains to the type of the result returned by the @samp{src} code
15935 block. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. The default
15936 follows from the type specified above.
15940 Interpreted as raw Org mode. Inserted directly into the buffer. Aligned if
15941 it is a table. Usage example: @code{:results value raw}.
15943 Results enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_SRC org} block. For comma-escape, either
15944 @kbd{TAB} in the block, or export the file. Usage example: @code{:results
15947 Results enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_EXPORT html} block. Usage example:
15948 @code{:results value html}.
15950 Results enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_EXPORT latex} block. Usage example:
15951 @code{:results value latex}.
15953 Result enclosed in a @samp{src} code block. Useful for parsing. Usage
15954 example: @code{:results value code}.
15956 Result converted to pretty-print source code. Enclosed in a @samp{src} code
15957 block. Languages supported: Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. Usage example:
15958 @code{:results value pp}.
15959 @item @code{drawer}
15960 Result wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. Useful for containing @code{raw} or
15961 @code{org} results for later scripting and automated processing. Usage
15962 example: @code{:results value drawer}.
15965 @subsubheading Handling
15966 Handling options after collecting the results.
15969 @item @code{silent}
15970 Do not insert results in the Org mode buffer, but echo them in the
15971 minibuffer. Usage example: @code{:results output silent}.
15972 @item @code{replace}
15973 Default. Insert results in the Org buffer. Remove previous results. Usage
15974 example: @code{:results output replace}.
15975 @item @code{append}
15976 Append results to the Org buffer. Latest results are at the bottom. Does
15977 not remove previous results. Usage example: @code{:results output append}.
15978 @item @code{prepend}
15979 Prepend results to the Org buffer. Latest results are at the top. Does not
15980 remove previous results. Usage example: @code{:results output prepend}.
15984 @subsubsection @code{:file}
15985 @cindex @code{:file}, src header argument
15987 An external @code{:file} that saves the results of execution of the code
15988 block. The @code{:file} is either a file name or two strings, where the
15989 first is the file name and the second is the description. A link to the file
15990 is inserted. It uses an Org mode style @code{[[file:]]} link (@pxref{Link
15991 format}). Some languages, such as @samp{R}, @samp{dot}, @samp{ditaa}, and
15992 @samp{gnuplot}, automatically wrap the source code in additional boilerplate
15993 code. Such code wrapping helps recreate the output, especially graphics
15994 output, by executing just the @code{:file} contents.
15997 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
15999 A description of the results file. Org uses this description for the link
16000 (see @ref{Link format}) it inserts in the Org file. If the @code{:file-desc}
16001 has no value, Org will use file name for both the ``link'' and the
16002 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
16005 @subsubsection @code{:file-ext}
16006 @cindex @code{:file-ext}, src header argument
16008 File name extension for the output file. Org generates the file's complete
16009 name, and extension by combining @code{:file-ext}, @code{#+NAME:} of the
16010 source block, and the @ref{output-dir} header argument. To override this
16011 auto generated file name, use the @code{:file} header argument.
16014 @subsubsection @code{:output-dir}
16015 @cindex @code{:output-dir}, src header argument
16017 Specifies the @code{:output-dir} for the results file. Org accepts an
16018 absolute path (beginning with @code{/}) or a relative directory (without
16019 @code{/}). The value can be combined with @code{#+NAME:} of the source block
16020 and @ref{file} or @ref{file-ext} header arguments.
16023 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
16024 @cindex @code{:dir}, src header argument
16026 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
16027 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during @samp{src}
16028 code block execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with
16029 the current buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path}
16030 temporarily has the same effect as changing the current directory with
16031 @kbd{M-x cd path RET}, and then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the
16032 surface, @code{:dir} simply sets the value of the Emacs variable
16033 @code{default-directory}.
16035 When using @code{:dir}, relative paths (for example, @code{:file myfile.jpg}
16036 or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) become relative to the default directory.
16038 For example, to save the plot file in the @samp{Work} folder of the home
16039 directory (notice tilde is expanded):
16042 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
16043 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
16047 @subsubheading Remote execution
16048 To evaluate the @samp{src} code block on a remote machine, supply a remote s
16049 directory name using @samp{Tramp} syntax. For example:
16052 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
16053 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
16057 Org first captures the text results as usual for insertion in the Org file.
16058 Then Org also inserts a link to the remote file, thanks to Emacs
16059 @samp{Tramp}. Org constructs the remote path to the file name from
16060 @code{:dir} and @code{default-directory}, as illustrated here:
16063 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
16067 @subsubheading Some more warnings
16071 When @code{:dir} is used with @code{:session}, Org sets the starting
16072 directory for a new session. But Org will not alter the directory of an
16073 already existing session.
16075 Do not use @code{:dir} with @code{:exports results} or with @code{:exports
16076 both} to avoid Org inserting incorrect links to remote files. That is because
16077 Org does not expand @code{default directory} to avoid some underlying
16078 portability issues.
16082 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
16083 @cindex @code{:exports}, src header argument
16085 The @code{:exports} header argument is to specify if that part of the Org
16086 file is exported to, say, HTML or @LaTeX{} formats. Note that
16087 @code{:exports} affects only @samp{src} code blocks and not inline code.
16091 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. Example:
16092 @code{:exports code}.
16093 @item @code{results}
16094 The results of evaluation of the code is included in the exported file.
16095 Example: @code{:exports results}.
16097 Both the code and results of evaluation are included in the exported file.
16098 Example: @code{:exports both}.
16100 Neither the code nor the results of evaluation is included in the exported
16101 file. Whether the code is evaluated at all depends on other
16102 options. Example: @code{:exports none}.
16106 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
16107 @cindex @code{:tangle}, src header argument
16109 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies if the @samp{src} code block is
16110 exported to source file(s).
16113 @item @code{tangle}
16114 Export the @samp{src} code block to source file. The file name for the
16115 source file is derived from the name of the Org file, and the file extension
16116 is derived from the source code language identifier. Example: @code{:tangle
16119 The default. Do not extract the code a source code file. Example:
16122 Export the @samp{src} code block to source file whose file name is derived
16123 from any string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument. Org derives
16124 the file name as being relative to the directory of the Org file's location.
16125 Example: @code{:tangle path}.
16129 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
16130 @cindex @code{:mkdirp}, src header argument
16132 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument creates parent directories for tangled
16133 files if the directory does not exist. @code{yes} enables directory creation
16134 and @code{no} inhibits directory creation.
16137 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
16138 @cindex @code{:comments}, src header argument
16139 Controls inserting comments into tangled files. These are above and beyond
16140 whatever comments may already exist in the @samp{src} code block.
16144 The default. Do not insert any extra comments during tangling.
16146 Wrap the @samp{src} code block in comments. Include links pointing back to
16147 the place in the Org file from where the code was tangled.
16149 Kept for backward compatibility; same as ``link''.
16151 Nearest headline text from Org file is inserted as comment. The exact text
16152 that is inserted is picked from the leading context of the source block.
16154 Includes both ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
16156 Includes ``link'' comment option, expands noweb references, and wraps them in
16157 link comments inside the body of the @samp{src} code block.
16161 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
16162 @cindex @code{:padline}, src header argument
16163 Control insertion of newlines to pad @samp{src} code blocks in the tangled
16167 Default. Insert a newline before and after each @samp{src} code block in the
16170 Do not insert newlines to pad the tangled @samp{src} code blocks.
16174 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
16175 @cindex @code{:no-expand}, src header argument
16177 By default Org expands @samp{src} code blocks during tangling. The
16178 @code{:no-expand} header argument turns off such expansions. Note that one
16179 side-effect of expansion by @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} also assigns
16180 values to @code{:var} (@pxref{var}) variables. Expansions also replace Noweb
16181 references with their targets (@pxref{Noweb reference syntax}). Some of
16182 these expansions may cause premature assignment, hence this option. This
16183 option makes a difference only for tangling. It has no effect when exporting
16184 since @samp{src} code blocks for execution have to be expanded anyway.
16187 @subsubsection @code{:session}
16188 @cindex @code{:session}, src header argument
16190 The @code{:session} header argument is for running multiple source code
16191 blocks under one session. Org runs @samp{src} code blocks with the same
16192 session name in the same interpreter process.
16196 Default. Each @samp{src} code block gets a new interpreter process to
16197 execute. The process terminates once the block is evaluated.
16199 Any string besides @code{none} turns that string into the name of that
16200 session. For example, @code{:session mysession} names it @samp{mysession}.
16201 If @code{:session} has no argument, then the session name is derived from the
16202 source language identifier. Subsequent blocks with the same source code
16203 language use the same session. Depending on the language, state variables,
16204 code from other blocks, and the overall interpreted environment may be
16205 shared. Some interpreted languages support concurrent sessions when
16206 subsequent source code language blocks change session names.
16210 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
16211 @cindex @code{:noweb}, src header argument
16213 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of Noweb syntax
16214 references (@pxref{Noweb reference syntax}). Expansions occur when source
16215 code blocks are evaluated, tangled, or exported.
16219 Default. No expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the code
16220 when evaluating, tangling, or exporting.
16222 Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the @samp{src} code block
16223 when evaluating, tangling, or exporting.
16224 @item @code{tangle}
16225 Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the @samp{src} code block
16226 when tangling. No expansion when evaluating or exporting.
16227 @item @code{no-export}
16228 Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the @samp{src} code block
16229 when evaluating or tangling. No expansion when exporting.
16230 @item @code{strip-export}
16231 Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the @samp{src} code block
16232 when expanding prior to evaluating or tangling. Removes Noweb syntax
16233 references when exporting.
16235 Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the @samp{src} code block
16236 only before evaluating.
16239 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
16240 Noweb insertions now honor prefix characters that appear before the Noweb
16243 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
16244 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
16245 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
16253 multi-line body of example
16257 this @samp{src} code block:
16260 #+BEGIN_SRC sql :noweb yes
16269 -- multi-line body of example
16272 Since this change will not affect noweb replacement text without newlines in
16273 them, inline noweb references are acceptable.
16275 This feature can also be used for management of indentation in exported code snippets.
16281 #+BEGIN_SRC python :exports none
16282 print('Do things when True')
16286 #+BEGIN_SRC python :exports none
16287 print('Do things when False')
16291 this @samp{src} code block:
16294 #+BEGIN_SRC python :noweb yes :results output
16306 print('Do things when True')
16308 print('Do things when False')
16314 Do things when True
16318 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
16319 @cindex @code{:noweb-ref}, src header argument
16321 When expanding Noweb style references, Org concatenates @samp{src} code
16322 blocks by matching the reference name to either the code block name or the
16323 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument.
16325 For simple concatenation, set this @code{:noweb-ref} header argument at the
16326 sub-tree or file level. In the example Org file shown next, the body of the
16327 source code in each block is extracted for concatenation to a pure code file
16331 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
16334 * the mount point of the fullest disk
16336 :header-args: :noweb-ref fullest-disk
16339 ** query all mounted disks
16344 ** strip the header row
16349 ** output mount point of fullest disk
16351 |awk '@{if (u < +$5) @{u = +$5; m = $6@}@} END @{print m@}'
16356 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
16357 @cindex @code{:noweb-sep}, src header argument
16359 By default a newline separates each noweb reference concatenation. To change
16360 this newline separator, edit the @code{:noweb-sep} (@pxref{noweb-sep}) header
16364 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
16365 @cindex @code{:cache}, src header argument
16367 The @code{:cache} header argument is for caching results of evaluating code
16368 blocks. Caching results can avoid re-evaluating @samp{src} code blocks that
16369 have not changed since the previous run. To benefit from the cache and avoid
16370 redundant evaluations, the source block must have a result already present in
16371 the buffer, and neither the header arguments (including the value of
16372 @code{:var} references) nor the text of the block itself has changed since
16373 the result was last computed. This feature greatly helps avoid long-running
16374 calculations. For some edge cases, however, the cached results may not be
16377 The caching feature is best for when @samp{src} blocks are pure functions,
16378 that is functions that return the same value for the same input arguments
16379 (@pxref{var}), and that do not have side effects, and do not rely on external
16380 variables other than the input arguments. Functions that depend on a timer,
16381 file system objects, and random number generators are clearly unsuitable for
16384 A note of warning: when @code{:cache} is used for a @code{:session}, caching
16385 may cause unexpected results.
16387 When the caching mechanism tests for any source code changes, it will not
16388 expand Noweb style references (@pxref{Noweb reference syntax}). For reasons
16389 why, see @uref{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.emacs.orgmode/79046}.
16391 The @code{:cache} header argument can have one of two values: @code{yes} or
16396 Default. No caching of results; @samp{src} code block evaluated every time.
16398 Whether to run the code or return the cached results is determined by
16399 comparing the SHA1 hash value of the combined @samp{src} code block and
16400 arguments passed to it. This hash value is packed on the @code{#+RESULTS:}
16401 line from previous evaluation. When hash values match, Org does not evaluate
16402 the @samp{src} code block. When hash values mismatch, Org evaluates the
16403 @samp{src} code block, inserts the results, recalculates the hash value, and
16404 updates @code{#+RESULTS:} line.
16407 In this example, both functions are cached. But @code{caller} runs only if
16408 the result from @code{random} has changed since the last run.
16412 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
16416 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
16420 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
16424 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
16429 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
16430 @cindex @code{:sep}, src header argument
16432 The @code{:sep} header argument is the delimiter for saving results as tables
16433 to files (@pxref{file}) external to Org mode. Org defaults to tab delimited
16434 output. The function, @code{org-open-at-point}, which is bound to @kbd{C-c
16435 C-o}, also uses @code{:sep} for opening tabular results.
16438 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
16439 @cindex @code{:hlines}, src header argument
16441 In-between each table row or below the table headings, sometimes results have
16442 horizontal lines, which are also known as hlines. The @code{:hlines}
16443 argument with the value @code{yes} accepts such lines. The default is
16448 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. For most code, this is
16449 desirable, or else those @code{hline} symbols raise unbound variable errors.
16451 The default is @code{:hlines no}. The example shows hlines removed from the
16463 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
16467 #+RESULTS: echo-table
16474 For @code{:hlines yes}, the example shows hlines unchanged.
16485 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
16489 #+RESULTS: echo-table
16499 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
16500 @cindex @code{:colnames}, src header argument
16502 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts @code{yes}, @code{no}, or
16503 @code{nil} values. The default value is @code{nil}, which is unassigned.
16504 But this header argument behaves differently depending on the source code
16509 If an input table has column names (because the second row is an hline), then
16510 Org removes the column names, processes the table, puts back the column
16511 names, and then writes the table to the results block.
16520 #+NAME: echo-table-again
16521 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
16522 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
16525 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
16532 Note that column names have to accounted for when using variable indexing
16533 (@pxref{var, Indexable variable values}) because column names are not removed
16537 Do not pre-process column names.
16540 For an input table that has no hlines, process it like the @code{nil}
16541 value. That is, Org removes the column names, processes the table, puts back
16542 the column names, and then writes the table to the results block.
16546 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
16547 @cindex @code{:rownames}, src header argument
16549 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on values @code{yes} or
16550 @code{no} values. The default is @code{no}. Note that @code{emacs-lisp}
16551 code blocks ignore @code{:rownames} header argument because of the ease of
16552 table-handling in Emacs.
16556 Org will not pre-process row names.
16559 If an input table has row names, then Org removes the row names, processes
16560 the table, puts back the row names, and then writes the table to the results
16564 #+NAME: with-rownames
16565 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
16566 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
16568 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
16569 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
16570 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
16573 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
16574 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
16575 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
16578 Note that row names have to accounted for when using variable indexing
16579 (@pxref{var, Indexable variable values}) because row names are not removed
16585 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
16586 @cindex @code{:shebang}, src header argument
16588 This header argument can turn results into executable script files. By
16589 setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value (for example,
16590 @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}), Org inserts that string as the first line of
16591 the tangled file that the @samp{src} code block is extracted to. Org then
16592 turns on the tangled file's executable permission.
16595 @subsubsection @code{:tangle-mode}
16596 @cindex @code{:tangle-mode}, src header argument
16598 The @code{tangle-mode} header argument specifies what permissions to set for
16599 tangled files by @code{set-file-modes}. For example, to make read-only
16600 tangled file, use @code{:tangle-mode (identity #o444)}. To make it
16601 executable, use @code{:tangle-mode (identity #o755)}.
16603 On @samp{src} code blocks with @code{shebang} (@pxref{shebang}) header
16604 argument, Org will automatically set the tangled file to executable
16605 permissions. But this can be overridden with custom permissions using
16606 @code{tangle-mode} header argument.
16608 When multiple @samp{src} code blocks tangle to a single file with different
16609 and conflicting @code{tangle-mode} header arguments, Org's behavior is
16613 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
16614 @cindex @code{:eval}, src header argument
16615 The @code{:eval} header argument can limit evaluation of specific code
16616 blocks. It is useful for protection against evaluating untrusted @samp{src}
16617 code blocks by prompting for a confirmation. This protection is independent
16618 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} setting.
16622 Org will never evaluate this @samp{src} code block.
16624 Org prompts the user for permission to evaluate this @samp{src} code block.
16625 @item never-export or no-export
16626 Org will not evaluate this @samp{src} code block when exporting, yet the user
16627 can evaluate this source block interactively.
16629 Org prompts the user for permission to export this @samp{src} code block.
16632 If @code{:eval} header argument is not set for a source block, then Org
16633 determines whether to evaluate from the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate}
16634 variable (@pxref{Code evaluation security}).
16637 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
16638 @cindex @code{:wrap}, src header argument
16639 The @code{:wrap} header argument marks the results block by appending strings
16640 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}. If no string is specified, Org wraps
16641 the results in a @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
16644 @subsubsection @code{:post}
16645 @cindex @code{:post}, src header argument
16646 The @code{:post} header argument is for post-processing results from
16647 @samp{src} block evaluation. When @code{:post} has any value, Org binds the
16648 results to @code{*this*} variable for easy passing to @ref{var} header
16649 argument specifications. That makes results available to other @samp{src}
16650 code blocks, or for even direct Emacs Lisp code execution.
16652 The following two examples illustrate @code{:post} header argument in action.
16653 The first one shows how to attach @code{#+ATTR_LATEX:} line using
16658 #+begin_src sh :var data="" :var width="\\textwidth" :results output
16659 echo "#+ATTR_LATEX: :width $width"
16663 #+header: :file /tmp/it.png
16664 #+begin_src dot :post attr_wrap(width="5cm", data=*this*) :results drawer
16674 #+ATTR_LATEX :width 5cm
16675 [[file:/tmp/it.png]]
16679 The second example shows use of @code{:colnames} in @code{:post} to pass
16680 data between @samp{src} code blocks.
16684 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var tbl="" fmt="%.3f"
16685 (mapcar (lambda (row)
16686 (mapcar (lambda (cell)
16694 #+begin_src R :colnames yes :post round-tbl[:colnames yes](*this*)
16696 data.frame(foo=rnorm(1))
16706 @subsubsection @code{:prologue}
16707 @cindex @code{:prologue}, src header argument
16708 The @code{prologue} header argument is for appending to the top of the code
16709 block for execution. For example, a clear or reset code at the start of new
16710 execution of a @samp{src} code block. A @code{reset} for @samp{gnuplot}:
16711 @code{:prologue "reset"}. See also @ref{epilogue}.
16714 (add-to-list 'org-babel-default-header-args:gnuplot
16715 '((:prologue . "reset")))
16719 @subsubsection @code{:epilogue}
16720 @cindex @code{:epilogue}, src header argument
16721 The value of the @code{epilogue} header argument is for appending to the end
16722 of the code block for execution. See also @ref{prologue}.
16724 @node Results of evaluation
16725 @section Results of evaluation
16726 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
16727 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
16729 How Org handles results of a code block execution depends on many header
16730 arguments working together. Here is only a summary of these. For an
16731 enumeration of all the header arguments that affect results, see
16734 The primary determinant is the execution context. Is it in a @code{:session}
16735 or not? Orthogonal to that is if the expected result is a @code{:results
16736 value} or @code{:results output}, which is a concatenation of output from
16737 start to finish of the @samp{src} code block's evaluation.
16739 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
16740 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
16741 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
16742 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
16745 For @code{:session} and non-session, the @code{:results value} turns the
16746 results into an Org mode table format. Single values are wrapped in a one
16747 dimensional vector. Rows and columns of a table are wrapped in a
16748 two-dimensional vector.
16750 @subsection Non-session
16751 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
16752 @cindex @code{:results}, src header argument
16753 Default. Org gets the value by wrapping the code in a function definition in
16754 the language of the @samp{src} block. That is why when using @code{:results
16755 value}, code should execute like a function and return a value. For
16756 languages like Python, an explicit @code{return} statement is mandatory when
16757 using @code{:results value}.
16759 This is one of four evaluation contexts where Org automatically wraps the
16760 code in a function definition.
16762 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
16763 @cindex @code{:results}, src header argument
16764 For @code{:results output}, the code is passed to an external process running
16765 the interpreter. Org returns the contents of the standard output stream as
16768 @subsection Session
16769 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
16770 @cindex @code{:results}, src header argument
16771 For @code{:results value} from a @code{:session}, Org passes the code to an
16772 interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior process. So only
16773 languages that provide interactive evaluation can have session support. Not
16774 all languages provide this support, such as @samp{C} and @samp{ditaa}. Even
16775 those that do support, such as @samp{Python} and @samp{Haskell}, they impose
16776 limitations on allowable language constructs that can run interactively. Org
16777 inherits those limitations for those @samp{src} code blocks running in a
16780 Org gets the value from the source code interpreter's last statement
16781 output. Org has to use language-specific methods to obtain the value. For
16782 example, from the variable @code{_} in @samp{Python} and @samp{Ruby}, and the
16783 value of @code{.Last.value} in @samp{R}).
16785 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
16786 @cindex @code{:results}, src header argument
16787 For @code{:results output}, Org passes the code to the interpreter running as
16788 an interactive Emacs inferior process. Org concatenates whatever text output
16789 emitted by the interpreter to return the collection as a result. Note that
16790 this collection is not the same as collected from @code{STDOUT} of a
16791 non-interactive interpreter running as an external process. Compare for
16792 example these two blocks:
16795 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
16806 In the above non-session mode, the ``2'' is not printed; so does not appear
16810 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
16822 In the above @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives and
16823 prints ``2''. Results show that.
16825 @node Noweb reference syntax
16826 @section Noweb reference syntax
16827 @cindex code block, noweb reference
16828 @cindex syntax, noweb
16829 @cindex source code, noweb reference
16831 Org supports named blocks in Noweb style syntax. For Noweb literate
16832 programming details, see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}).
16835 <<code-block-name>>
16838 For the header argument @code{:noweb yes}, Org expands Noweb style references
16839 in the @samp{src} code block before evaluation.
16841 For the header argument @code{:noweb no}, Org does not expand Noweb style
16842 references in the @samp{src} code block before evaluation.
16844 The default is @code{:noweb no}. Org defaults to @code{:noweb no} so as not
16845 to cause errors in languages where Noweb syntax is ambiguous. Change Org's
16846 default to @code{:noweb yes} for languages where there is no risk of
16849 Org offers a more flexible way to resolve Noweb style references
16850 (@pxref{noweb-ref}).
16852 Org can include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than its body. To
16853 that effect, append parentheses, possibly including arguments, to the code
16854 block name, as show below.
16857 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
16860 Note that when using the above approach to a code block's results, the code
16861 block name set by @code{#+NAME} keyword is required; the reference set by
16862 @code{:noweb-ref} will not work.
16864 Here is an example that demonstrates how the exported content changes when
16865 Noweb style references are used with parentheses versus without.
16871 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var num=0 :results output :exports none
16879 #+BEGIN_SRC text :noweb yes
16890 Below, a similar Noweb style reference is used, but with parentheses, while
16891 setting a variable @code{num} to 10:
16894 #+BEGIN_SRC text :noweb yes
16895 <<some-code(num=10)>>
16899 Note that now the expansion contains the @emph{results} of the code block
16900 @code{some-code}, not the code block itself:
16906 For faster tangling of large Org mode files, set
16907 @code{org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion} variable to @code{t}.
16908 The speedup comes at the expense of not correctly resolving inherited values
16909 of the @code{:noweb-ref} header argument.
16912 @node Key bindings and useful functions
16913 @section Key bindings and useful functions
16914 @cindex code block, key bindings
16916 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on the context.
16918 Active key bindings in code blocks:
16920 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
16922 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
16924 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
16926 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
16928 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
16931 Active key bindings in Org mode buffer:
16933 @multitable @columnfractions 0.5 0.5
16935 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
16936 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
16938 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
16939 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
16941 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
16942 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
16944 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
16945 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
16947 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
16948 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
16950 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
16951 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
16953 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
16954 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
16956 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
16957 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
16959 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
16960 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
16962 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
16963 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
16965 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
16966 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
16968 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
16969 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
16971 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
16972 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
16974 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
16975 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
16977 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
16978 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
16980 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
16981 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
16983 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
16984 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
16986 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
16987 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
16989 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
16990 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
16992 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
16993 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
16995 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
16996 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
16998 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
16999 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
17002 @c Extended key bindings when control key is kept pressed:
17004 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
17005 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
17006 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
17007 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
17008 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
17009 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
17010 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
17011 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
17012 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
17015 @node Batch execution
17016 @section Batch execution
17017 @cindex code block, batch execution
17018 @cindex source code, batch execution
17020 Org mode features, including working with source code facilities can be
17021 invoked from the command line. This enables building shell scripts for batch
17022 processing, running automated system tasks, and expanding Org mode's
17025 The sample script shows batch processing of multiple files using
17026 @code{org-babel-tangle}.
17030 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
17032 # tangle files with org-mode
17037 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
17039 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
17044 (require 'org)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
17045 (mapc (lambda (file)
17046 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
17048 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep -i tangled
17051 @node Miscellaneous
17052 @chapter Miscellaneous
17055 * Completion:: M-TAB guesses completions
17056 * Easy templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
17057 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
17058 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
17059 * Customization:: Adapting Org to changing tastes
17060 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
17061 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
17062 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
17063 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
17064 * Interaction:: With other Emacs packages
17065 * org-crypt:: Encrypting Org files
17070 @section Completion
17071 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
17072 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
17073 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
17074 @cindex completion, of option keywords
17075 @cindex completion, of tags
17076 @cindex completion, of property keys
17077 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
17078 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
17079 @cindex TODO keywords completion
17080 @cindex dictionary word completion
17081 @cindex option keyword completion
17082 @cindex tag completion
17083 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
17085 Org has in-buffer completions. Unlike minibuffer completions, which are
17086 useful for quick command interactions, Org's in-buffer completions are more
17087 suitable for content creation in Org documents. Type one or more letters and
17088 invoke the hot key to complete the text in-place. Depending on the context
17089 and the keys, Org will offer different types of completions. No minibuffer
17090 is involved. Such mode-specific hot keys have become an integral part of
17091 Emacs and Org provides several shortcuts.
17094 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
17096 Complete word at point
17099 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
17101 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
17103 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
17104 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
17106 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
17107 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
17108 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
17109 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
17111 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
17112 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
17115 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
17117 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
17118 file-specific @samp{OPTIONS}. After option keyword is complete, pressing
17119 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again will insert example settings for that option.
17121 After @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords.
17123 When the point is anywhere else, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
17126 If your desktop intercepts the combo @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to switch windows, use
17127 @kbd{C-M-i} or @kbd{@key{ESC} @key{TAB}} as an alternative or customize your
17131 @node Easy templates
17132 @section Easy templates
17133 @cindex template insertion
17134 @cindex insertion, of templates
17136 With just a few keystrokes, Org's easy templates inserts empty pairs of
17137 structural elements, such as @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC}. Easy
17138 templates use an expansion mechanism, which is native to Org, in a process
17139 similar to @file{yasnippet} and other Emacs template expansion packages.
17141 @kbd{@key{<}} @kbd{@key{s}} @kbd{@key{TAB}} completes the @samp{src} code
17144 @kbd{<} @kbd{l} @kbd{@key{TAB}}
17148 #+BEGIN_EXPORT latex
17152 Org comes with these pre-defined easy templates:
17154 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
17155 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
17156 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
17157 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
17158 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
17159 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
17160 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXPORT latex ... #+END_EXPORT}
17161 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LATEX:}
17162 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXPORT html ... #+END_EXPORT}
17163 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
17164 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii ... #+END_EXPORT}
17165 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
17166 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
17167 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
17170 More templates can added by customizing the variable
17171 @code{org-structure-template-alist}, whose docstring has additional details.
17174 @section Speed keys
17177 Single keystrokes can execute custom commands in an Org file when the cursor
17178 is on a headline. Without the extra burden of a meta or modifier key, Speed
17179 Keys can speed navigation or execute custom commands. Besides faster
17180 navigation, Speed Keys may come in handy on small mobile devices that do not
17181 have full keyboards. Speed Keys may also work on TTY devices known for their
17182 problems when entering Emacs keychords.
17184 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
17185 By default, Org has Speed Keys disabled. To activate Speed Keys, set the
17186 variable @code{org-use-speed-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value. To trigger
17187 a Speed Key, the cursor must be at the beginning of an Org headline, before
17190 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
17191 @findex org-speed-command-help
17192 Org comes with a pre-defined list of Speed Keys. To add or modify Speed
17193 Keys, customize the variable, @code{org-speed-commands-user}. For more
17194 details, see the variable's docstring. With Speed Keys activated, @kbd{M-x
17195 org-speed-command-help}, or @kbd{?} when cursor is at the beginning of an Org
17196 headline, shows currently active Speed Keys, including the user-defined ones.
17199 @node Code evaluation security
17200 @section Code evaluation and security issues
17202 Unlike plain text, running code comes with risk. Each @samp{src} code block,
17203 in terms of risk, is equivalent to an executable file. Org therefore puts a
17204 few confirmation prompts by default. This is to alert the casual user from
17205 accidentally running untrusted code.
17207 For users who do not run code blocks or write code regularly, Org's default
17208 settings should suffice. However, some users may want to tweak the prompts
17209 for fewer interruptions. To weigh the risks of automatic execution of code
17210 blocks, here are some details about code evaluation.
17212 Org evaluates code in the following circumstances:
17215 @item Source code blocks
17216 Org evaluates @samp{src} code blocks in an Org file during export. Org also
17217 evaluates a @samp{src} code block with the @kbd{C-c C-c} key chord. Users
17218 exporting or running code blocks must load files only from trusted sources.
17219 Be weary of customizing variables that remove or alter default security
17222 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
17223 When @code{t}, Org prompts the user for confirmation before executing each
17224 code block. When @code{nil}, Org executes code blocks without prompting the
17225 user for confirmation. When this option is set to a custom function, Org
17226 invokes the function with these two arguments: the source code language and
17227 the body of the code block. The custom function must return either a
17228 @code{t} or @code{nil}, which determines if the user is prompted. Each
17229 source code language can be handled separately through this function
17233 For example, this function enables execution of @samp{ditaa} code +blocks
17237 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
17238 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
17239 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
17242 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
17243 Org has two link types that can also directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
17244 links}). Because such code is not visible, these links have a potential
17245 risk. Org therefore prompts the user when it encounters such links. The
17246 customization variables are:
17248 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
17249 Function that prompts the user before executing a shell link.
17251 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
17252 Function that prompts the user before executing an Emacs Lisp link.
17255 @item Formulas in tables
17256 Org executes formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) either through the
17257 @emph{calc} or the @emph{Emacs Lisp} interpreters.
17260 @node Customization
17261 @section Customization
17262 @cindex customization
17263 @cindex options, for customization
17264 @cindex variables, for customization
17266 Org has more than 500 variables for customization. They can be accessed
17267 through the usual @kbd{M-x org-customize RET} command. Or through the Org
17268 menu, @code{Org->Customization->Browse Org Group}. Org also has per-file
17269 settings for some variables (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
17271 @node In-buffer settings
17272 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
17273 @cindex in-buffer settings
17274 @cindex special keywords
17275 In-buffer settings start with @samp{#+}, followed by a keyword, a colon, and
17276 then a word for each setting. Org accepts multiple settings on the same
17277 line. Org also accepts multiple lines for a keyword. This manual describes
17278 these settings throughout. A summary follows here.
17280 @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any changes to the in-buffer settings. Closing and
17281 reopening the Org file in Emacs also activates the changes.
17283 @vindex org-archive-location
17285 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
17286 Sets the archive location of the agenda file. This location applies to the
17287 lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, if any, in the Org file. The
17288 first archive location in the Org file also applies to any entries before it.
17289 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
17291 Sets the category of the agenda file, which applies to the entire document.
17292 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM ...
17293 @cindex property, COLUMNS
17294 Sets the default format for columns view. Org uses this format for column
17295 views where there is no @code{COLUMNS} property.
17296 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
17297 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
17298 @vindex org-table-formula
17299 Set file-local values for constants that table formulas can use. This line
17300 sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}. The global
17301 version of this variable is @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
17302 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
17303 Set tags that all entries in the file will inherit from here, including the
17305 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
17306 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
17307 Each line specifies one abbreviation for one link. Use multiple
17308 @code{#+LINK:} lines for more, @pxref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding
17309 variable is @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
17310 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
17311 @vindex org-highest-priority
17312 @vindex org-lowest-priority
17313 @vindex org-default-priority
17314 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
17315 must be either letters A--Z or numbers 0--9. The highest priority must
17316 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
17317 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
17318 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
17319 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
17320 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
17321 @item #+SETUPFILE: file or URL
17322 The setup file or a URL pointing to such file is for additional in-buffer
17323 settings. Org loads this file and parses it for any settings in it only when
17324 Org opens the main file. If URL is specified, the contents are downloaded
17325 and stored in a temporary file cache. @kbd{C-c C-c} on the settings line
17326 will parse and load the file, and also reset the temporary file cache. Org
17327 also parses and loads the document during normal exporting process. Org
17328 parses the contents of this document as if it was included in the buffer. It
17329 can be another Org file. To visit the file (not a URL), @kbd{C-c '} while
17330 the cursor is on the line with the file name.
17333 Startup options Org uses when first visiting a file.
17335 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
17336 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
17337 @code{org-startup-folded} with a default value of @code{t}, which is the same
17338 as @code{overview}.
17340 @vindex org-startup-folded
17341 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
17342 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
17343 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
17344 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
17346 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
17347 content @r{all headlines}
17348 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
17349 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
17352 @vindex org-startup-indented
17353 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
17354 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
17355 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
17356 @code{org-startup-indented}
17358 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
17359 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
17362 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
17363 Aligns tables consistently upon visiting a file; useful for restoring
17364 narrowed table columns. The corresponding variable is
17365 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} with @code{nil} as default value.
17367 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
17368 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
17370 align @r{align all tables}
17371 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
17374 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
17375 Whether Org should automatically display inline images. The corresponding
17376 variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a default value
17377 @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
17378 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
17379 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
17381 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
17382 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
17385 @vindex org-startup-with-latex-preview
17386 Whether Org should automatically convert @LaTeX{} fragments to images. The
17387 variable @code{org-startup-with-latex-preview}, which controls this setting,
17388 is set to @code{nil} by default to avoid startup delays.
17389 @cindex @code{latexpreview}, STARTUP keyword
17390 @cindex @code{nolatexpreview}, STARTUP keyword
17392 latexpreview @r{preview @LaTeX{} fragments}
17393 nolatexpreview @r{don't preview @LaTeX{} fragments}
17396 @vindex org-log-done
17397 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
17398 @vindex org-log-repeat
17399 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
17400 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
17401 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
17402 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
17403 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
17404 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
17405 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
17406 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
17407 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
17408 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
17409 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
17410 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
17411 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
17412 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
17413 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
17414 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
17415 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
17416 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
17417 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
17418 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
17419 @cindex @code{logdrawer}, STARTUP keyword
17420 @cindex @code{nologdrawer}, STARTUP keyword
17421 @cindex @code{logstatesreversed}, STARTUP keyword
17422 @cindex @code{nologstatesreversed}, STARTUP keyword
17424 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
17425 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
17426 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
17427 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
17428 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
17429 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
17430 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
17431 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
17432 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
17433 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
17434 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
17435 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
17436 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
17437 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
17438 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
17439 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
17440 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
17441 logdrawer @r{store log into drawer}
17442 nologdrawer @r{store log outside of drawer}
17443 logstatesreversed @r{reverse the order of states notes}
17444 nologstatesreversed @r{do not reverse the order of states notes}
17447 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
17448 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
17449 These options hide leading stars in outline headings, and indent outlines.
17450 The corresponding variables are @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and
17451 @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a default setting of @code{nil}
17452 (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
17453 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
17454 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
17455 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
17456 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
17458 hidestars @r{hide all stars on the headline except one.}
17459 showstars @r{show all stars on the headline}
17460 indent @r{virtual indents according to the outline level}
17461 noindent @r{no virtual indents}
17462 odd @r{show odd outline levels only (1,3,...)}
17463 oddeven @r{show all outline levels}
17466 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
17467 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
17468 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
17469 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
17470 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
17471 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
17473 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
17476 @vindex constants-unit-system
17477 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
17478 @code{constants-unit-system}).
17479 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
17480 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
17482 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
17483 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
17486 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
17487 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
17488 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
17489 For footnote settings, use the following keywords. The corresponding
17490 variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
17491 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
17492 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
17493 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
17494 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
17495 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
17496 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
17497 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
17498 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
17499 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
17500 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
17502 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
17503 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
17504 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
17505 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
17506 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
17507 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
17508 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
17509 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
17510 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
17513 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
17514 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
17515 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
17516 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
17517 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
17519 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
17520 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
17523 @cindex org-pretty-entities
17524 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
17525 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
17526 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
17527 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
17529 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
17530 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
17533 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
17534 @vindex org-tag-alist
17535 These lines specify valid tags for this file. Org accepts multiple tags
17536 lines. Tags could correspond to the @emph{fast tag selection} keys. The
17537 corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
17540 This line is for formulas for the table directly above. A table can have
17541 multiple @samp{#+TBLFM:} lines. On table recalculation, Org applies only the
17542 first @samp{#+TBLFM:} line. For details see @ref{Using multiple #+TBLFM
17543 lines} in @ref{Editing and debugging formulas}.
17544 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+DATE:,
17545 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:,
17546 @itemx #+SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXCLUDE_TAGS:
17547 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
17548 @ref{Export settings}.
17549 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
17550 @vindex org-todo-keywords
17551 These lines set the TODO keywords and their significance to the current file.
17552 The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
17555 @node The very busy C-c C-c key
17556 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
17558 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
17560 The @kbd{C-c C-c} key in Org serves many purposes depending on the context.
17561 It is probably the most over-worked, multi-purpose key combination in Org.
17562 Its uses are well-documented through out this manual, but here is a
17563 consolidated list for easy reference.
17567 If any highlights shown in the buffer from the creation of a sparse tree, or
17568 from clock display, remove such highlights.
17570 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, scan the
17571 buffer for these lines and update the information. Also reset the Org file
17572 cache used to temporary store the contents of URLs used as values for
17573 keywords like @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
17575 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. The table realigns even
17576 if automatic table editor is turned off.
17578 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
17581 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it. With
17582 a prefix argument, also jump to the target location after saving the note.
17584 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
17585 corresponding links in this buffer.
17587 If the cursor is on a property line or at the start or end of a property
17588 drawer, offer property commands.
17590 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
17591 definition, and @emph{vice versa}.
17593 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
17595 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
17598 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
17601 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
17604 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
17608 @section A cleaner outline view
17609 @cindex hiding leading stars
17610 @cindex dynamic indentation
17611 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
17612 @cindex clean outline view
17614 Org's default outline with stars and no indents can become too cluttered for
17615 short documents. For @emph{book-like} long documents, the effect is not as
17616 noticeable. Org provides an alternate stars and indentation scheme, as shown
17617 on the right in the following table. It uses only one star and indents text
17618 to line with the heading:
17622 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
17623 ** Second level | * Second level
17624 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
17625 some text | some text
17626 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
17627 more text | more text
17628 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
17634 To turn this mode on, use the minor mode, @code{org-indent-mode}. Text lines
17635 that are not headlines are prefixed with spaces to vertically align with the
17636 headline text@footnote{The @code{org-indent-mode} also sets the
17637 @code{wrap-prefix} correctly for indenting and wrapping long lines of
17638 headlines or text. This minor mode handles @code{visual-line-mode} and
17639 directly applied settings through @code{word-wrap}.}.
17641 To make more horizontal space, the headlines are shifted by two stars. This
17642 can be configured by the @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level} variable.
17643 Only one star on each headline is visible, the rest are masked with the same
17644 font color as the background. This font face can be configured with the
17645 @code{org-hide} variable.
17647 Note that turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
17648 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
17649 @code{nil}; @samp{2.} below shows how this works.
17651 To globally turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files, customize the
17652 variable @code{org-startup-indented}.
17654 To turn on indenting for individual files, use @code{#+STARTUP} option as
17661 Indent on startup makes Org use hard spaces to align text with headings as
17662 shown in examples below.
17666 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
17667 Indent text to align with the headline.
17671 more text, now indented
17674 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
17675 Org adapts indentations with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
17676 editing@footnote{Also see the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.}.
17679 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
17680 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* Org can make leading stars invisible. For
17681 global preference, configure the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars}. For
17682 per-file preference, use these file @code{#+STARTUP} options:
17685 #+STARTUP: hidestars
17686 #+STARTUP: showstars
17689 With stars hidden, the tree is shown as:
17693 * Top level headline
17701 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
17702 Because Org makes the font color same as the background color to hide to
17703 stars, sometimes @code{org-hide} face may need tweaking to get the effect
17704 right. For some black and white combinations, @code{grey90} on a white
17705 background might mask the stars better.
17708 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
17709 Using stars for only odd levels, 1, 3, 5, @dots{}, can also clean up the
17710 clutter. This removes two stars from each level@footnote{Because
17711 @samp{LEVEL=2} has 3 stars, @samp{LEVEL=3} has 4 stars, and so on}. For Org
17712 to properly handle this cleaner structure during edits and exports, configure
17713 the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}. To set this per-file, use either
17714 one of the following lines:
17721 To switch between single and double stars layouts, use @kbd{M-x
17722 org-convert-to-odd-levels RET} and @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
17726 @section Using Org on a tty
17727 @cindex tty key bindings
17729 Org provides alternative key bindings for TTY and modern mobile devices that
17730 cannot handle cursor keys and complex modifier key chords. Some of these
17731 workarounds may be more cumbersome than necessary. Users should look into
17732 customizing these further based on their usage needs. For example, the
17733 normal @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} for editing timestamp might be better with
17736 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
17737 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
17738 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
17739 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
17740 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
17741 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
17742 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
17743 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
17744 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
17745 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
17746 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
17747 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
17748 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
17749 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
17750 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
17751 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
17752 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
17753 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
17754 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
17755 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
17760 @section Interaction with other packages
17761 @cindex packages, interaction with other
17762 Org's compatibility and the level of interaction with other Emacs packages
17763 are documented here.
17767 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
17768 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
17772 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
17775 @cindex @file{calc.el}
17776 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
17777 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
17778 Org uses the Calc package for tables to implement spreadsheet functionality
17779 (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org also uses Calc for embedded calculations.
17780 @xref{Embedded Mode, , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
17781 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
17782 @cindex @file{constants.el}
17783 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
17784 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
17785 Org can use names for constants in formulas in tables. Org can also use
17786 calculation suffixes for units, such as @samp{M} for @samp{Mega}. For a
17787 standard collection of such constants, install the @file{constants} package.
17788 Install version 2.0 of this package, available at
17789 @url{https://staff.fnwi.uva.nl/c.dominik/Tools/}. Org checks if the function
17790 @code{constants-get} has been autoloaded. Installation instructions are in
17791 the file, @file{constants.el}.
17792 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
17793 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
17794 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
17795 Org mode can use CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter @LaTeX{} fragments
17796 into Org files (@pxref{CDLaTeX mode}).
17797 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
17798 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
17799 Imenu creates dynamic menus based on an index of items in a file. Org mode
17800 supports Imenu menus. Enable it with a mode hook as follows:
17802 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
17803 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
17805 @vindex org-imenu-depth
17806 By default the Imenu index is two levels deep. Change the index depth using
17807 thes variable, @code{org-imenu-depth}.
17808 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
17809 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
17810 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
17811 Speedbar package creates a special Emacs frame for displaying files and index
17812 items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar; users can drill into Org files
17813 directly from the Speedbar. The @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame tweeks the
17814 agenda commands to that file or to a subtree.
17815 @cindex @file{table.el}
17816 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
17818 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
17819 @cindex @file{table.el}
17820 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
17822 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
17823 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota.
17824 Org mode recognizes such tables and export them properly. @kbd{C-c '} to
17825 edit these tables in a special buffer, much like Org's @samp{src} code
17826 blocks. Because of interference with other Org mode functionality, Takaaki
17827 Ota tables cannot be edited directly in the Org buffer.
17829 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
17830 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
17832 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
17833 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
17834 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
17835 format. See the documentation string of the command @code{org-convert-table}
17841 @subsection Packages that conflict with Org mode
17845 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
17846 @vindex org-support-shift-select
17847 In Emacs, @code{shift-selection-mode} combines cursor motions with shift key
17848 to enlarge regions. Emacs sets this mode by default. This conflicts with
17849 Org's use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands to change timestamps, TODO
17850 keywords, priorities, and item bullet types, etc. Since @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}
17851 commands outside of specific contexts don't do anything, Org offers the
17852 variable @code{org-support-shift-select} for customization. Org mode
17853 accommodates shift selection by (i) making it available outside of the
17854 special contexts where special commands apply, and (ii) extending an
17855 existing active region even if the cursor moves across a special context.
17857 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
17858 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
17859 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
17860 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
17861 Org key bindings conflict with @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode. For
17862 Org to relinquish these bindings to CUA mode, configure the variable
17863 @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set, Org moves the following key
17864 bindings in Org files, and in the agenda buffer (but not during date
17868 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
17869 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
17870 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
17873 @vindex org-disputed-keys
17874 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. To define a
17875 different replacement keys, look at the variable @code{org-disputed-keys}.
17877 @item @file{ecomplete.el} by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen @email{larsi@@gnus.org}
17878 @cindex @file{ecomplete.el}
17880 Ecomplete provides ``electric'' address completion in address header
17881 lines in message buffers. Sadly Orgtbl mode cuts ecompletes power
17882 supply: No completion happens when Orgtbl mode is enabled in message
17883 buffers while entering text in address header lines. If one wants to
17884 use ecomplete one should @emph{not} follow the advice to automagically
17885 turn on Orgtbl mode in message buffers (see @ref{Orgtbl mode}), but
17886 instead---after filling in the message headers---turn on Orgtbl mode
17887 manually when needed in the messages body.
17889 @item @file{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones
17890 @cindex @file{filladapt.el}
17892 Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and
17893 other elements. Many users reported problems using both @file{filladapt.el}
17894 and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable filladapt like this:
17897 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
17900 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
17901 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
17902 The way Org mode binds the @key{TAB} key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
17903 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
17904 fixed this problem:
17907 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
17909 (setq-local yas/trigger-key [tab])
17910 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
17913 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
17914 above code does not fix the conflict, first define the following function:
17917 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
17918 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
17921 Then tell Org mode to use that function:
17924 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
17926 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
17927 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
17928 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
17929 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
17932 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
17933 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
17934 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
17935 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
17936 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
17937 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
17941 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
17942 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
17943 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
17944 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
17945 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
17948 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
17949 @cindex @file{viper.el}
17951 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
17952 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
17953 another key for this command, or override the key in
17954 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
17957 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
17965 @section org-crypt.el
17966 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
17967 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
17969 Org crypt encrypts the text of an Org entry, but not the headline, or
17970 properties. Org crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt.
17972 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
17973 be encrypted when the file is saved. To use a different tag, customize the
17974 @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} variable.
17976 Suggested Org crypt settings in Emacs init file:
17979 (require 'org-crypt)
17980 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
17981 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
17983 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
17984 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
17985 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
17987 (setq auto-save-default nil)
17988 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
17989 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
17990 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
17993 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
17995 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
17998 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents encrypting previously
18005 This appendix covers some areas where users can extend the functionality of
18009 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
18010 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
18011 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
18012 * Adding export back-ends:: How to write new export back-ends
18013 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
18014 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
18015 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
18016 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
18017 * Speeding up your agendas:: Tips on how to speed up your agendas
18018 * Extracting agenda information:: Post-processing of agenda information
18019 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
18020 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
18027 Org has a large number of hook variables for adding functionality. This
18028 appendix illustrates using a few. A complete list of hooks with
18029 documentation is maintained by the Worg project at
18030 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/doc.html#hooks}.
18032 @node Add-on packages
18033 @section Add-on packages
18034 @cindex add-on packages
18036 Various authors wrote a large number of add-on packages for Org.
18038 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
18039 packages with the separate release available at @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
18040 See the @file{contrib/README} file in the source code directory for a list of
18041 contributed files. Worg page with more information is at:
18042 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
18044 @node Adding hyperlink types
18045 @section Adding hyperlink types
18046 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
18048 Org has many built-in hyperlink types (@pxref{Hyperlinks}), and an interface
18049 for adding new link types. The example file, @file{org-man.el}, shows the
18050 process of adding Org links to Unix man pages, which look like this:
18051 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]}:
18054 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
18058 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
18059 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
18061 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
18062 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
18064 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
18066 (defun org-man-open (path)
18067 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
18068 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
18069 (funcall org-man-command path))
18071 (defun org-man-store-link ()
18072 "Store a link to a manpage."
18073 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
18074 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
18075 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
18076 (link (concat "man:" page))
18077 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
18078 (org-store-link-props
18081 :description description))))
18083 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
18084 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
18085 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
18086 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
18087 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
18088 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
18092 ;;; org-man.el ends here
18096 To activate links to man pages in Org, enter this in the init file:
18103 A review of @file{org-man.el}:
18106 First, @code{(require 'org)} ensures @file{org.el} is loaded.
18108 The @code{org-add-link-type} defines a new link type with @samp{man} prefix.
18109 The call contains the function to call that follows the link type.
18111 @vindex org-store-link-functions
18112 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions} that records
18113 a useful link with the command @kbd{C-c l} in a buffer displaying a man page.
18116 The rest of the file defines necessary variables and functions. First is the
18117 customization variable @code{org-man-command}. It has two options,
18118 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Next is a function whose argument is the link
18119 path, which for man pages is the topic of the man command. To follow the
18120 link, the function calls the @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
18123 @kbd{C-c l} constructs and stores the link.
18125 @kbd{C-c l} calls the function @code{org-man-store-link}, which first checks
18126 if the @code{major-mode} is appropriate. If check fails, the function
18127 returns @code{nil}. Otherwise the function makes a link string by combining
18128 the @samp{man:} prefix with the man topic. The function then calls
18129 @code{org-store-link-props} with @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. A
18130 @code{:description} property is an optional string that is displayed when the
18131 function inserts the link in the Org buffer.
18133 @kbd{C-c C-l} inserts the stored link.
18135 To define new link types, define a function that implements completion
18136 support with @kbd{C-c C-l}. This function should not accept any arguments
18137 but return the appropriate prefix and complete link string.
18139 @node Adding export back-ends
18140 @section Adding export back-ends
18141 @cindex Export, writing back-ends
18143 Org's export engine makes it easy for writing new back-ends. The framework
18144 on which the engine was built makes it easy to derive new back-ends from
18147 The two main entry points to the export engine are:
18148 @code{org-export-define-backend} and
18149 @code{org-export-define-derived-backend}. To grok these functions, see
18150 @file{ox-latex.el} for an example of defining a new back-end from scratch,
18151 and @file{ox-beamer.el} for an example of deriving from an existing engine.
18153 For creating a new back-end from scratch, first set its name as a symbol in
18154 an alist consisting of elements and export functions. To make the back-end
18155 visible to the export dispatcher, set @code{:menu-entry} keyword. For export
18156 options specific to this back-end, set the @code{:options-alist}.
18158 For creating a new back-end from an existing one, set @code{:translate-alist}
18159 to an alist of export functions. This alist replaces the parent back-end
18162 For complete documentation, see
18163 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-export-reference.html, the Org Export
18164 Reference on Worg}.
18166 @node Context-sensitive commands
18167 @section Context-sensitive commands
18168 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
18169 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
18170 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
18172 Org has facilities for building context sensitive commands. Authors of Org
18173 add-ons can tap into this functionality.
18175 Some Org commands change depending on the context. The most important
18176 example of this behavior is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c
18177 key}). Other examples are @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor}.
18179 These context sensitive commands work by providing a function that detects
18180 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
18183 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax
18184 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
18185 @cindex tables, in other modes
18186 @cindex lists, in other modes
18187 @cindex Orgtbl mode
18189 Because of Org's success in handling tables with Orgtbl, a frequently asked
18190 feature is to Org's usability functions to other table formats native to
18191 other modem's, such as @LaTeX{}. This would be hard to do in a general way
18192 without complicated customization nightmares. Moreover, that would take Org
18193 away from its simplicity roots that Orgtbl has proven. There is, however, an
18194 alternate approach to accomplishing the same.
18196 This approach involves implementing a custom @emph{translate} function that
18197 operates on a native Org @emph{source table} to produce a table in another
18198 format. This strategy would keep the excellently working Orgtbl simple and
18199 isolate complications, if any, confined to the translate function. To add
18200 more alien table formats, we just add more translate functions. Also the
18201 burden of developing custom translate functions for new table formats will be
18202 in the hands of those who know those formats best.
18204 For an example of how this strategy works, see Orgstruct mode. In that mode,
18205 Bastien added the ability to use Org's facilities to edit and re-structure
18206 lists. He did by turning @code{orgstruct-mode} on, and then exporting the
18207 list locally to another format, such as HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.
18210 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
18211 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
18212 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
18213 * Radio lists:: Sending and receiving lists
18217 @subsection Radio tables
18218 @cindex radio tables
18220 Radio tables are target locations for translated tables that are not near
18221 their source. Org finds the target location and inserts the translated
18224 The key to finding the target location are the magic words @code{BEGIN/END
18225 RECEIVE ORGTBL}. They have to appear as comments in the current mode. If
18226 the mode is C, then:
18229 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
18230 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
18234 At the location of source, Org needs a special line to direct Orgtbl to
18235 translate and to find the target for inserting the translated table. For
18239 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments...
18243 @code{table_name} is the table's reference name, which is also used in the
18244 receiver lines, and the @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function that
18245 translates. This line, in addition, may also contain alternating key and
18246 value arguments at the end. The translation function gets these values as a
18247 property list. A few standard parameters are already recognized and acted
18248 upon before the translation function is called:
18252 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count; include them if they
18255 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
18256 List of columns to be skipped. First Org automatically discards columns with
18257 calculation marks and then sends the table to the translator function, which
18258 then skips columns as specified in @samp{skipcols}.
18262 To keep the source table intact in the buffer without being disturbed when
18263 the source file is compiled or otherwise being worked on, use one of these
18268 Place the table in a block comment. For example, in C mode you could wrap
18269 the table between @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
18271 Put the table after an @samp{END} statement. For example @samp{\bye} in
18272 @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}} in @LaTeX{}.
18274 Comment and uncomment each line of the table during edits. The @kbd{M-x
18275 orgtbl-toggle-comment RET} command makes toggling easy.
18278 @node A @LaTeX{} example
18279 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
18280 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
18282 To wrap a source table in @LaTeX{}, use the @code{comment} environment
18283 provided by @file{comment.sty}. To activate it, put
18284 @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} in the document header. Orgtbl mode inserts a
18285 radio table skeleton@footnote{By default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML,
18286 and Texinfo. Configure the variable @code{orgtbl-radio-table-templates} to
18287 install templates for other export formats.} with the command @kbd{M-x
18288 orgtbl-insert-radio-table RET}, which prompts for a table name. For example,
18289 if @samp{salesfigures} is the name, the template inserts:
18291 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
18293 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
18294 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
18296 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
18302 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
18303 The line @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
18304 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table to @LaTeX{} format, then insert
18305 the table at the target (receive) location named @code{salesfigures}. Now
18306 the table is ready for data entry. It can even use spreadsheet
18307 features@footnote{If the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar
18308 characters, this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As
18309 shown in the example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
18310 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar expressions.
18311 If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a much better
18312 solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the variable
18313 @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
18316 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
18317 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
18319 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
18320 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
18321 |-------+------+---------+---------|
18322 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
18323 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
18324 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
18325 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
18326 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
18331 After editing, @kbd{C-c C-c} inserts translated table at the target location,
18332 between the two marker lines.
18334 For hand-made custom tables, note that the translator needs to skip the first
18335 two lines of the source table. Also the command has to @emph{splice} out the
18336 target table without the header and footer.
18339 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
18340 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
18341 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
18342 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
18346 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
18347 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
18348 |-------+------+---------+---------|
18349 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
18350 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
18351 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
18352 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
18356 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
18357 Orgtbl mode and uses @code{tabular} environment by default to typeset the
18358 table and mark the horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. For additional
18359 parameters to control output, @pxref{Translator functions}:
18362 @item :splice nil/t
18363 When non-@code{nil}, returns only table body lines; not wrapped in tabular
18364 environment. Default is @code{nil}.
18367 Format to warp each field. It should contain @code{%s} for the original
18368 field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollar symbol, you
18369 could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. Format can also wrap a property list with
18370 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
18371 In place of a string, a function of one argument can be used; the function
18372 must return a formatted string.
18375 Format numbers as exponentials. The spec should have @code{%s} twice for
18376 inserting mantissa and exponent, for example @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}.
18377 This may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
18378 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
18379 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be applied.
18380 Functions with two arguments can be supplied instead of strings. By default,
18381 no special formatting is applied.
18384 @node Translator functions
18385 @subsection Translator functions
18386 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
18387 @cindex translator function
18389 Orgtbl mode has built-in translator functions: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
18390 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values),
18391 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo},
18392 @code{orgtbl-to-unicode} and @code{orgtbl-to-orgtbl}. They use the generic
18393 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}, which delegates translations to various
18396 Properties passed to the function through the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line take
18397 precedence over properties defined inside the function. For example, this
18398 overrides the default @LaTeX{} line endings, @samp{\\}, with @samp{\\[2mm]}:
18401 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
18404 For a new language translator, define a converter function. It can be a
18405 generic function, such as shown in this example. It marks a beginning and
18406 ending of a table with @samp{!BTBL!} and @samp{!ETBL!}; a beginning and
18407 ending of lines with @samp{!BL!} and @samp{!EL!}; and uses a TAB for a field
18411 (defun orgtbl-to-language (table params)
18412 "Convert the orgtbl-mode TABLE to language."
18415 (org-combine-plists
18416 '(:tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!" :lstart "!BL!" :lend "!EL!" :sep "\t")
18421 The documentation for the @code{orgtbl-to-generic} function shows a complete
18422 list of parameters, each of which can be passed through to
18423 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
18424 using that generic function.
18426 For complicated translations the generic translator function could be
18427 replaced by a custom translator function. Such a custom function must take
18428 two arguments and return a single string containing the formatted table. The
18429 first argument is the table whose lines are a list of fields or the symbol
18430 @code{hline}. The second argument is the property list consisting of
18431 parameters specified in the @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. Please share your
18432 translator functions by posting them to the Org users mailing list,
18433 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
18436 @subsection Radio lists
18437 @cindex radio lists
18438 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
18440 Call the @code{org-list-insert-radio-list} function to insert a radio list
18441 template in HTML, @LaTeX{}, and Texinfo mode documents. Sending and
18442 receiving radio lists works is the same as for radio tables (@pxref{Radio
18443 tables}) except for these differences:
18448 Orgstruct mode must be active.
18450 Use @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
18452 @kbd{C-c C-c} works only on the first list item.
18455 Built-in translators functions are: @code{org-list-to-latex},
18456 @code{org-list-to-html} and @code{org-list-to-texinfo}. They use the
18457 @code{org-list-to-generic} translator function. See its documentation for
18458 parameters for accurate customizations of lists. Here is a @LaTeX{} example:
18461 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
18462 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
18464 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
18473 @kbd{C-c C-c} on @samp{a new house} inserts the translated @LaTeX{} list
18474 in-between the BEGIN and END marker lines.
18476 @node Dynamic blocks
18477 @section Dynamic blocks
18478 @cindex dynamic blocks
18480 Org supports @emph{dynamic blocks} in Org documents. They are inserted with
18481 begin and end markers like any other @samp{src} code block, but the contents
18482 are updated automatically by a user function. For example, @kbd{C-c C-x C-r}
18483 inserts a dynamic table that updates the work time (@pxref{Clocking work
18486 Dynamic blocks can have names and function parameters. The syntax is similar
18487 to @samp{src} code block specifications:
18489 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
18491 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
18496 These command update dynamic blocks:
18499 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
18500 Update dynamic block at point.
18501 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
18502 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
18505 Before updating a dynamic block, Org removes content between the BEGIN and
18506 END markers. Org then reads the parameters on the BEGIN line for passing to
18507 the writer function. If the function expects to access the removed content,
18508 then Org expects an extra parameter, @code{:content}, on the BEGIN line.
18510 To syntax for calling a writer function with a named block, @code{myblock}
18511 is: @code{org-dblock-write:myblock}. Parameters come from the BEGIN line.
18513 The following is an example of a dynamic block and a block writer function
18514 that updates the time when the function was last run:
18517 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
18523 The dynamic block's writer function:
18526 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
18527 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
18528 (insert "Last block update at: "
18529 (format-time-string fmt))))
18532 To keep dynamic blocks up-to-date in an Org file, use the function,
18533 @code{org-update-all-dblocks} in hook, such as @code{before-save-hook}. The
18534 @code{org-update-all-dblocks} function does not run if the file is not in
18537 Dynamic blocks, like any other block, can be narrowed with
18538 @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
18540 @node Special agenda views
18541 @section Special agenda views
18542 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
18544 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
18545 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
18546 Org provides a special hook to further limit items in agenda views:
18547 @code{agenda}, @code{agenda*}@footnote{The @code{agenda*} view is the same as
18548 @code{agenda} except that it only considers @emph{appointments}, i.e.,
18549 scheduled and deadline items that have a time specification @samp{[h]h:mm} in
18550 their time-stamps.}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo}, @code{tags},
18551 @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. Specify a custom function that tests
18552 inclusion of every matched item in the view. This function can also
18553 skip as much as is needed.
18555 For a global condition applicable to agenda views, use the
18556 @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global} variable. Org uses a global condition
18557 with @code{org-agenda-skip-function} for custom searching.
18559 This example defines a function for a custom view showing TODO items with
18560 WAITING status. Manually this is a multi step search process, but with a
18561 custom view, this can be automated as follows:
18563 The custom function searches the subtree for the WAITING tag and returns
18564 @code{nil} on match. Otherwise it gives the location from where the search
18568 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
18569 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
18570 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
18571 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
18572 nil ; tag found, do not skip
18573 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
18576 To use this custom function in a custom agenda command:
18579 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
18580 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
18581 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
18582 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
18585 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
18586 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to a more
18587 meaningful string suitable for the agenda view.
18589 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
18590 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
18592 Search for entries with a limit set on levels for the custom search. This is
18593 a general appraoch to creating custom searches in Org. To include all
18594 levels, use @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, for
18595 @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a level number corresponds to order in the
18596 hierarchy, not to the number of stars.}. Then to selectively pick the
18597 matched entries, use @code{org-agenda-skip-function}, which also accepts Lisp
18598 forms, such as @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if} and
18599 @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if}. For example:
18602 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
18603 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
18604 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
18605 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
18606 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
18607 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
18608 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
18609 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
18610 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
18611 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
18612 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
18613 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
18614 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
18615 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
18616 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
18617 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
18618 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
18619 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
18620 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
18621 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
18622 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
18625 The following is an example of a search for @samp{WAITING} without the
18629 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
18630 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
18631 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
18632 'regexp ":waiting:"))
18633 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
18636 @node Speeding up your agendas
18637 @section Speeding up your agendas
18638 @cindex agenda views, optimization
18640 Some agenda commands slow down when the Org files grow in size or number.
18641 Here are tips to speed up:
18645 Reduce the number of Org agenda files to avoid slowdowns due to hard drive
18648 Reduce the number of @samp{DONE} and archived headlines so agenda operations
18649 that skip over these can finish faster.
18651 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
18652 Do not dim blocked tasks:
18654 (setq org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks nil)
18657 @vindex org-startup-folded
18658 @vindex org-agenda-inhibit-startup
18659 Stop preparing agenda buffers on startup:
18661 (setq org-agenda-inhibit-startup nil)
18664 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
18665 @vindex org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance
18666 Disable tag inheritance for agendas:
18668 (setq org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance nil)
18672 These options can be applied to selected agenda views. For more details
18673 about generation of agenda views, see the docstrings for the relevant
18674 variables, and this @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/agenda-optimization.html,
18675 dedicated Worg page} for agenda optimization.
18677 @node Extracting agenda information
18678 @section Extracting agenda information
18679 @cindex agenda, pipe
18680 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
18682 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
18683 Org provides commands to access agendas through Emacs batch mode. Through
18684 this command-line interface, agendas are automated for further processing or
18687 @code{org-batch-agenda} creates an agenda view in ASCII and outputs to
18688 STDOUT. This command takes one string parameter. When string length=1, Org
18689 uses it as a key to @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. These are the same
18690 ones available through @kbd{C-c a}.
18692 This example command line directly prints the TODO list to the printer:
18695 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
18698 When the string parameter length is two or more characters, Org matches it
18699 with tags/TODO strings. For example, this example command line prints items
18700 tagged with @samp{shop}, but excludes items tagged with @samp{NewYork}:
18703 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
18704 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
18708 An example showing on-the-fly parameter modifications:
18711 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
18712 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
18713 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
18714 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
18715 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
18720 which will produce an agenda for the next 30 days from just the
18721 @file{~/org/projects.org} file.
18723 For structured processing of agenda output, use @code{org-batch-agenda-csv}
18724 with the following fields:
18727 category @r{The category of the item}
18728 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
18729 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
18730 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
18731 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
18732 diary @r{imported from diary}
18733 deadline @r{a deadline}
18734 scheduled @r{scheduled}
18735 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
18736 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
18737 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
18738 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
18739 block @r{entry has date block including date}
18740 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
18741 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
18742 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
18743 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
18744 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
18745 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
18746 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
18750 If the selection of the agenda item was based on a timestamp, including those
18751 items with @samp{DEADLINE} and @samp{SCHEDULED} keywords, then Org includes
18752 date and time in the output.
18754 If the selection of the agenda item was based on a timestamp (or
18755 deadline/scheduled), then Org includes date and time in the output.
18757 Here is an example of a post-processing script in Perl. It takes the CSV
18758 output from Emacs and prints with a checkbox:
18763 # define the Emacs command to run
18764 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
18766 # run it and capture the output
18767 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
18769 # loop over all lines
18770 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
18771 # get the individual values
18772 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
18773 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
18774 # process and print
18775 print "[ ] $head\n";
18779 @node Using the property API
18780 @section Using the property API
18781 @cindex API, for properties
18782 @cindex properties, API
18784 Functions for working with properties.
18786 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
18787 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
18788 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
18789 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
18790 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
18791 if the property key was used several times.@*
18792 POM may also be @code{nil}, in which case the current entry is used.
18793 If WHICH is @code{nil} or @code{all}, get all properties. If WHICH is
18794 @code{special} or @code{standard}, only get that subclass.
18797 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
18798 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
18799 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
18800 Get value of @code{PROPERTY} for entry at point-or-marker @code{POM}@. By
18801 default, this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If
18802 @code{INHERIT} is non-@code{nil} and the entry does not have the property,
18803 then also check higher levels of the hierarchy. If @code{INHERIT} is the
18804 symbol @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
18805 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects @code{PROPERTY} for inheritance.
18808 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
18809 Delete the property @code{PROPERTY} from entry at point-or-marker POM.
18812 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
18813 Set @code{PROPERTY} to @code{VALUE} for entry at point-or-marker POM.
18816 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
18817 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
18820 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
18821 Insert a property drawer for the current entry.
18824 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
18825 Set @code{PROPERTY} at point-or-marker @code{POM} to @code{VALUES}@.
18826 @code{VALUES} should be a list of strings. They will be concatenated, with
18827 spaces as separators.
18830 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
18831 Treat the value of the property @code{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated
18832 list of values and return the values as a list of strings.
18835 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
18836 Treat the value of the property @code{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated
18837 list of values and make sure that @code{VALUE} is in this list.
18840 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
18841 Treat the value of the property @code{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated
18842 list of values and make sure that @code{VALUE} is @emph{not} in this list.
18845 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
18846 Treat the value of the property @code{PROPERTY} as a whitespace-separated
18847 list of values and check if @code{VALUE} is in this list.
18850 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
18851 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
18852 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
18853 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
18854 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
18855 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
18856 responsible for this property.
18859 @node Using the mapping API
18860 @section Using the mapping API
18861 @cindex API, for mapping
18862 @cindex mapping entries, API
18864 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities for finding entries. Org uses
18865 this functionality internally for generating agenda views. Org also exposes
18866 an API for executing arbitrary functions for each selected entry. The API's
18867 main entry point is:
18869 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
18870 Call @samp{FUNC} at each headline selected by @code{MATCH} in @code{SCOPE}.
18872 @samp{FUNC} is a function or a Lisp form. With the cursor positioned at the
18873 beginning of the headline, call the function without arguments. Org returns
18874 an alist of return values of calls to the function.
18876 To avoid preserving point, Org wraps the call to @code{FUNC} in
18877 save-excursion form. After evaluation, Org moves the cursor to the end of
18878 the line that was just processed. Search continues from that point forward.
18879 This may not always work as expected under some conditions, such as if the
18880 current sub-tree was removed by a previous archiving operation. In such rare
18881 circumstances, Org skips the next entry entirely when it should not. To stop
18882 Org from such skips, make @samp{FUNC} set the variable
18883 @code{org-map-continue-from} to a specific buffer position.
18885 @samp{MATCH} is a tags/property/TODO match. Org iterates only matched
18886 headlines. Org iterates over all headlines when @code{MATCH} is @code{nil}
18889 @samp{SCOPE} determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
18892 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
18893 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
18894 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
18895 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
18897 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
18898 agenda @r{all agenda files}
18899 agenda-with-archives
18900 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
18902 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
18905 The remaining args are treated as settings for the scanner's skipping
18906 facilities. Valid args are:
18908 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
18910 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
18911 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
18912 function or Lisp form
18913 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
18914 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
18915 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
18916 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
18920 The mapping routine can call any arbitrary function, even functions that
18921 change meta data or query the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}).
18922 Here are some handy functions:
18924 @defun org-todo &optional arg
18925 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
18926 the many possible values for the argument @code{ARG}.
18929 @defun org-priority &optional action
18930 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
18931 possible values for @code{ACTION}.
18934 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
18935 Toggle the tag @code{TAG} in the current entry. Setting @code{ONOFF} to
18936 either @code{on} or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is
18941 Promote the current entry.
18945 Demote the current entry.
18948 This example turns all entries tagged with @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries
18949 with keyword @code{UPCOMING}. Org ignores entries in comment trees and
18954 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
18955 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
18958 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
18959 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
18962 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
18966 @appendix MobileOrg
18970 MobileOrg is a companion mobile app that runs on iOS and Android devices.
18971 MobileOrg enables offline-views and capture support for an Org mode system
18972 that is rooted on a ``real'' computer. MobileOrg can record changes to
18975 The @uref{https://github.com/MobileOrg/, iOS implementation} for the
18976 @emph{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was started by Richard
18977 Moreland and is now in the hands Sean Escriva. Android users should check
18978 out @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg
18979 Android} by Matt Jones. Though the two implementations are not identical,
18980 they offer similar features.
18982 This appendix describes Org's support for agenda view formats compatible with
18983 MobileOrg. It also describes synchronizing changes, such as to notes,
18984 between MobileOrg and the computer.
18986 To change tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, first customize the variables
18987 @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tag-alist}. These should cover all
18988 the important tags and TODO keywords, even if Org files use only some of
18989 them. Though MobileOrg has in-buffer settings, it understands TODO states
18990 @emph{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @emph{mutually exclusive} tags
18991 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
18994 * Setting up the staging area:: For the mobile device
18995 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
18996 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
18999 @node Setting up the staging area
19000 @section Setting up the staging area
19002 MobileOrg needs access to a file directory on a server to interact with
19003 Emacs. With a public server, consider encrypting the files. MobileOrg
19004 version 1.5 supports encryption for the iPhone. Org also requires
19005 @file{openssl} installed on the local computer. To turn on encryption, set
19006 the same password in MobileOrg and in Emacs. Set the password in the
19007 variable @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If Emacs is configured for
19008 safe storing of passwords, then configure the variable,
19009 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}; please read the docstring of that
19010 variable.}. Note that even after MobileOrg encrypts the file contents, the
19011 file names will remain visible on the file systems of the local computer, the
19012 server, and the mobile device.
19014 For a server to host files, consider options like
19015 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{An alternative is to
19016 use webdav server. MobileOrg documentation has details of webdav server
19017 configuration. Additional help is at
19018 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
19019 On first connection, MobileOrg creates a directory @file{MobileOrg/} on
19020 Dropbox. Pass its location to Emacs through an init file variable as
19024 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
19027 Org copies files to the above directory for MobileOrg. Org also uses the
19028 same directory for sharing notes between Org and MobileOrg.
19030 @node Pushing to MobileOrg
19031 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
19033 Org pushes files listed in @code{org-mobile-files} to
19034 @code{org-mobile-directory}. Files include agenda files (as listed in
19035 @code{org-agenda-files}). Customize @code{org-mobile-files} to add other
19036 files. File names will be staged with paths relative to
19037 @code{org-directory}, so all files should be inside this
19038 directory@footnote{Symbolic links in @code{org-directory} should have the
19039 same name as their targets.}.
19041 Push creates a special Org file @file{agendas.org} with custom agenda views
19042 defined by the user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org mode will force
19043 ID properties on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be
19044 uniquely identified if MobileOrg flags them for further action. To avoid
19045 setting properties configure the variable
19046 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
19047 rely on outline paths, assuming they are unique.}.
19049 Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to other files.
19050 MobileOrg reads this file first from the server to determine what other files
19051 to download for agendas. For faster downloads, MobileOrg will read only
19052 those files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored automatically in
19053 the file @file{checksums.dat}.} have changed.
19055 @node Pulling from MobileOrg
19056 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
19058 When MobileOrg synchronizes with the server, it pulls the Org files for
19059 viewing. It then appends to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server the
19060 captured entries, pointers to flagged and changed entries. Org integrates
19061 its data in an inbox file format.
19065 Org moves all entries found in
19066 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
19067 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
19068 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
19069 is a top-level entry in the inbox file.
19071 After moving the entries, Org attempts changes to MobileOrg. Some changes
19072 are applied directly and without user interaction. Examples include changes
19073 to tags, TODO state, headline and body text. Entries for further action are
19074 tagged as @code{:FLAGGED:}. Org marks entries with problems with an error
19075 message in the inbox. They have to be resolved manually.
19077 Org generates an agenda view for flagged entries for user intervention to
19078 clean up. For notes stored in flagged entries, MobileOrg displays them in
19079 the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding agenda item.
19084 Pressing @kbd{?} displays the entire flagged note in another window. Org
19085 also pushes it to the kill ring. To store flagged note as a normal note, use
19086 @kbd{? z C-y C-c C-c}. Pressing @kbd{?} twice does these things: first it
19087 removes the @code{:FLAGGED:} tag; second, it removes the flagged note from
19088 the property drawer; third, it signals that manual editing of the flagged
19089 entry is now finished.
19094 @kbd{C-c a ?} returns to the agenda view to finish processing flagged
19095 entries. Note that these entries may not be the most recent since MobileOrg
19096 searches files that were last pulled. To get an updated agenda view with
19097 changes since the last pull, pull again.
19099 @node History and acknowledgments
19100 @appendix History and acknowledgments
19101 @cindex acknowledgments
19105 @section From Carsten
19107 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
19108 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
19109 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
19110 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
19111 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable. Also, when
19112 using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the tree,
19113 organizing it paralleling my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility cycling}
19114 and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the package
19115 @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general @file{org.el}.
19116 As this environment became comfortable for project planning, the next step
19117 was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and @emph{table
19118 support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org still has
19119 today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative and
19120 intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning functionality
19121 directly into a notes file.
19123 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
19124 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
19125 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
19126 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
19127 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
19128 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
19129 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
19132 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
19135 @item Bastien Guerry
19136 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
19137 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the
19138 plain list parser. His support during the early days was central to the
19139 success of this project. Bastien also invented Worg, helped establishing the
19140 Web presence of Org, and sponsored hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
19141 Bastien stepped in as maintainer of Org between 2011 and 2013, at a time when
19142 I desperately needed a break.
19143 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
19144 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
19145 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
19146 programming and reproducible research. This has become one of Org's killer
19147 features that define what Org is today.
19149 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
19150 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
19151 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
19152 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
19153 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
19154 of his great @file{remember.el}.
19155 @item Sebastian Rose
19156 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
19157 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
19158 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
19159 web pages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
19160 single-key navigation.
19163 @noindent See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please
19164 let me know what I am missing here!
19166 @section From Bastien
19168 I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org between 2011 and 2013. This appendix
19169 would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgments and thanks.
19171 I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
19172 maintainership of Org. His unremitting support is what really helped me
19173 getting more confident over time, with both the community and the code.
19175 When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
19176 collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more
19177 knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the
19178 persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers,
19179 either of the code or the community:
19183 Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away
19184 from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts.
19186 @item Nicolas Goaziou
19187 Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work
19188 on @file{org-element.el} and @file{ox.el} has been outstanding, and it opened
19189 the doors for many new ideas and features. He rewrote many of the old
19190 exporters to use the new export engine, and helped with documenting this
19191 major change. More importantly (if that's possible), he has been more than
19192 reliable during all the work done for Org 8.0, and always very reactive on
19196 Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools
19197 into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the
19198 many hiccups that such a change can create for users.
19201 The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who
19202 patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such
19203 a great help, and the list would not be so active without him.
19206 I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be
19207 fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not be
19208 complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
19210 @section List of contributions
19215 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
19217 @i{Suvayu Ali} has steadily helped on the mailing list, providing useful
19218 feedback on many features and several patches.
19220 @i{Luis Anaya} wrote @file{ox-man.el}.
19222 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
19224 @i{Michael Brand} helped by reporting many bugs and testing many features.
19225 He also implemented the distinction between empty fields and 0-value fields
19226 in Org's spreadsheets.
19228 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
19231 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
19233 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
19235 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
19237 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
19239 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
19240 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
19242 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
19245 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
19246 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
19247 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
19249 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner, and helped
19250 make Org pupular through her blog.
19252 @i{Toby S. Cubitt} contributed to the code for clock formats.
19254 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the first DocBook exporter. In Org 8.0, we go a
19255 different route: you can now export to Texinfo and export the @file{.texi}
19256 file to DocBook using @code{makeinfo}.
19258 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
19259 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
19262 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
19264 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
19265 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
19266 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
19268 @i{Jason Dunsmore} has been maintaining the Org-Mode server at Rackspace for
19269 several years now. He also sponsored the hosting costs until Rackspace
19270 started to host us for free.
19272 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
19273 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
19275 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
19276 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
19277 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}, which has been rewritten by Nicolas Goaziou as
19278 @file{ox-taskjuggler.el} for Org 8.0.
19280 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
19283 @i{Sean Escriva} took over MobileOrg development on the iPhone platform.
19285 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
19287 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
19289 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
19290 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
19292 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
19294 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
19296 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
19298 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
19301 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
19302 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
19304 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
19306 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code. He also wrote
19307 @file{org-element.el} and @file{org-export.el}, which was a huge step forward
19308 in implementing a clean framework for Org exporters.
19310 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
19312 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
19315 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
19316 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
19317 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
19319 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
19322 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
19324 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
19325 folded entries, and column view for properties.
19327 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
19329 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
19331 @i{Jonathan Leech-Pepin} wrote @file{ox-texinfo.el}.
19333 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
19334 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
19336 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
19337 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
19339 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
19340 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
19341 small fixes and patches.
19343 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
19345 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling and sticky agendas.
19347 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
19350 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
19353 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote MobileOrg for the iPhone.
19355 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
19356 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
19358 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
19360 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
19362 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
19363 file links, and TAGS.
19365 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
19366 version of the reference card.
19368 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
19371 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
19373 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
19374 links, among other things.
19376 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
19377 provided frequent feedback.
19379 @i{Francesco Pizzolante} provided patches that helped speeding up the agenda
19382 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
19383 into bundles of 20 for undo.
19385 @i{Rackspace.com} is hosting our website for free. Thank you Rackspace!
19387 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
19389 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
19392 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
19393 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
19395 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
19397 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
19398 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
19400 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
19403 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
19404 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
19406 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
19409 @i{Christopher Schmidt} reworked @code{orgstruct-mode} so that users can
19410 enjoy folding in non-org buffers by using Org headlines in comments.
19412 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
19414 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
19415 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
19417 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
19418 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
19420 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
19421 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
19423 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
19426 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
19428 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
19429 tweaks and features.
19431 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
19432 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
19434 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
19435 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
19437 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
19438 with links transformation to Org syntax.
19440 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
19441 chapter about publishing.
19443 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter and rewrote the HTML exporter.
19445 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
19446 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
19448 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
19449 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
19450 concept index for HTML export.
19452 @i{Jürgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
19455 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
19457 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
19460 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
19463 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
19466 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
19469 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
19470 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
19472 @i{Marco Wahl} wrote @file{org-eww.el}.
19476 @node GNU Free Documentation License
19477 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
19478 @include doclicense.texi
19482 @unnumbered Concept index
19487 @unnumbered Key index
19491 @node Command and Function Index
19492 @unnumbered Command and function index
19496 @node Variable Index
19497 @unnumbered Variable index
19499 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
19500 mentioned in the manual. For a complete list, use @kbd{M-x org-customize
19507 @c Local variables:
19509 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
19510 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
19511 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
19515 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre